]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/calc.texi
Merge from emacs-24; up to 2012-11-24T16:58:43Z!cyd@gnu.org
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @include emacsver.texi
11
12 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
13 @c @texline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
15 @c @infoline foo
16 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
17
18 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
19 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
20
21 @iftex
22 @macro texline
23 @end macro
24 @alias infoline=comment
25 @alias expr=math
26 @alias tfn=code
27 @alias mathit=expr
28 @alias summarykey=key
29 @macro cpi{}
30 @math{@pi{}}
31 @end macro
32 @macro cpiover{den}
33 @math{@pi/\den\}
34 @end macro
35 @end iftex
36
37 @ifnottex
38 @alias texline=comment
39 @macro infoline{stuff}
40 \stuff\
41 @end macro
42 @alias expr=samp
43 @alias tfn=t
44 @alias mathit=i
45 @macro summarykey{ky}
46 \ky\
47 @end macro
48 @macro cpi{}
49 @expr{pi}
50 @end macro
51 @macro cpiover{den}
52 @expr{pi/\den\}
53 @end macro
54 @end ifnottex
55
56
57 @tex
58 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
59 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
60 @end tex
61
62 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
63 @iftex
64 @finalout
65 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
66 @tex
67 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
68
69 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
70 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
71 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
72 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
73 @end tex
74 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
75 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
76 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
77 @ignore
78 @newcount@calcpageno
79 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
80 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
81 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
82 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
83 \r@ggedbottomtrue
84 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
85 @end ignore
86 @end iftex
87
88 @copying
89 @ifinfo
90 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
91 @end ifinfo
92 @ifnotinfo
93 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with
94 GNU Emacs @value{EMACSVER}.
95 @end ifnotinfo
96
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1990-1991, 2001-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 @quotation
100 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
101 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
102 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
103 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
104 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
105 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
106 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
107
108 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
109 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
110 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
111 @end quotation
112 @end copying
113
114 @dircategory Emacs misc features
115 @direntry
116 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
117 @end direntry
118
119 @titlepage
120 @sp 6
121 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
122 @sp 4
123 @center GNU Emacs Calc
124 @c [volume]
125 @sp 5
126 @center Dave Gillespie
127 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
128 @page
129
130 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
131 @insertcopying
132 @end titlepage
133
134
135 @summarycontents
136
137 @c [end]
138
139 @contents
140
141 @c [begin]
142 @ifnottex
143 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
144 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
145
146 @noindent
147 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
148 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
149
150 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
151 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
152 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
153 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
154 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
155 @end ifnottex
156
157 @ifinfo
158 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
159 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
160 longer Info tutorial.)
161 @end ifinfo
162
163 @insertcopying
164
165 @menu
166 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
167 @ifinfo
168 * Interactive Tutorial::
169 @end ifinfo
170 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
171
172 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
173 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
174 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
175 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
176 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
177 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
178 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
179 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
180 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
181 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
182 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
183 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
184 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
185 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
186 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
187
188 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
189 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
190 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
191 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
192
193 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
194
195 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
196 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
197 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
198 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
199 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
200 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
201 @end menu
202
203 @ifinfo
204 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
205 @end ifinfo
206 @ifnotinfo
207 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
208 @end ifnotinfo
209 @chapter Getting Started
210 @noindent
211 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
212 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
213 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
214
215 @menu
216 * What is Calc::
217 * About This Manual::
218 * Notations Used in This Manual::
219 * Demonstration of Calc::
220 * Using Calc::
221 * History and Acknowledgments::
222 @end menu
223
224 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
225 @section What is Calc?
226
227 @noindent
228 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
229 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
230 series of calculators, its many features include:
231
232 @itemize @bullet
233 @item
234 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
235
236 @item
237 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
238
239 @item
240 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
241 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
242 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
243 and algebraic formulas.
244
245 @item
246 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
247
248 @item
249 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
250
251 @item
252 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
253
254 @item
255 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
256 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
257
258 @item
259 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
260
261 @item
262 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
263
264 @item
265 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
266 inside any editing buffer.
267
268 @item
269 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
270
271 @item
272 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
273 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
274 @end itemize
275
276 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
277 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
278 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
279 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
280 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
281 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
282 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
283 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
284
285 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
286 @section About This Manual
287
288 @noindent
289 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
290 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
291 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
292 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
293 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
294 regularly.
295
296 This manual is divided into three major parts: the ``Getting
297 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial, and the Calc
298 reference manual.
299 @c [when-split]
300 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
301 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
302 @c chapter.
303
304 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
305 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
306 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
307 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
308 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
309
310 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
311 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
312 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
313 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
314 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
315 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
316 to use its features.
317
318 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
319 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
320 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
321 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
322 need to know.
323
324 @c @cindex Marginal notes
325 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
326 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
327 variables also have their own indices.
328 @c @texline Each
329 @c @infoline In the printed manual, each
330 @c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
331 @c in the margin with its index entry.
332
333 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
334 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
335 the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
336 @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
337 @kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
338 command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
339 necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
340 to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
341 manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
342 @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
343
344 @ifnottex
345 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
346 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
347 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
348 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
349 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
350 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
351 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
352 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
353 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
354 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
355 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
356 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
357 The result will be a device-independent output file called
358 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
359 for your system. On many systems, the command is
360
361 @example
362 lpr -d calc.dvi
363 @end example
364
365 @noindent
366 or
367
368 @example
369 dvips calc.dvi
370 @end example
371 @end ifnottex
372 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
373 @c Foundation.
374
375 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
376 @section Notations Used in This Manual
377
378 @noindent
379 This section describes the various notations that are used
380 throughout the Calc manual.
381
382 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
383 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
384 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
385 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
386 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
387 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
388 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
389 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
390 regularly using Emacs.
391
392 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
393 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
394 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
395 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
396 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
397
398 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
399 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
400 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
401
402 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
403 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
404 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
405 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
406
407 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
408 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
409 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
410 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
411 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
412
413 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
414 [@code{sincos}].
415
416 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
417 @section A Demonstration of Calc
418
419 @noindent
420 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
421 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
422 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
423 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
424 Tutorial.
425
426 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
427 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
428 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
429 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
430
431 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
432 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
433 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
434 Delete, and Space keys.
435
436 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
437 then the command to operate on the numbers.
438
439 @noindent
440 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
441 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
442 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
443
444 @noindent
445 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
446 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
447 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
448
449 @noindent
450 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
451
452 @noindent
453 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
454 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
455
456 @noindent
457 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
458
459 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
460 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
461 use the apostrophe key.
462
463 @noindent
464 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
465 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
466 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
467
468 @noindent
469 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
470 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
471 @infoline `pi' squared.
472 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
473
474 @noindent
475 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
476 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
477
478 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
479 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
480 the next section.)
481
482 @noindent
483 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
484 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
485
486 @noindent
487 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
488
489 @noindent
490 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
491
492 @noindent
493 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
494
495 @noindent
496 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
497 the Keypad Calculator off.
498
499 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
500 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
501 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
502 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
503 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
504 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
505 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
506
507 @example
508 @group
509 1.23 1.97
510 1.6 2
511 1.19 1.08
512 @end group
513 @end example
514
515 @noindent
516 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
517 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
518
519 @noindent
520 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
521 the product of the numbers.
522
523 @noindent
524 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
525 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
526 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
527
528 @noindent
529 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
530 @texline @math{3\times2}
531 @infoline 3x2
532 matrix into a
533 @texline @math{2\times3}
534 @infoline 2x3
535 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
536 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
537 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
538 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
539
540 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
541 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
542 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
543
544 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
545 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
546 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
547 many weeks have passed since then.
548
549 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
550 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
551 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
552 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
553 in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
554 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
555
556 @noindent
557 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
558 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
559 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
560 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the @LaTeX{} typesetting
561 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
562
563 @noindent
564 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
565 (That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
566
567 @ifnotinfo
568 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
569 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
570 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
571 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
572 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
573 @end ifnotinfo
574 @ifinfo
575 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
576 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
577 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
578 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
579 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
580 @end ifinfo
581
582 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
583 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
584
585 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgments, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
586 @section Using Calc
587
588 @noindent
589 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
590 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
591 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
592
593 @menu
594 * Starting Calc::
595 * The Standard Interface::
596 * Quick Mode Overview::
597 * Keypad Mode Overview::
598 * Standalone Operation::
599 * Embedded Mode Overview::
600 * Other C-x * Commands::
601 @end menu
602
603 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
604 @subsection Starting Calc
605
606 @noindent
607 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
608 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
609 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
610
611 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
612 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
613 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
614 which Calc interface you want to use.
615
616 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
617 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
618 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
619 a complete list.
620
621 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
622 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
623 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
624
625 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
626 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
627 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
628 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
629 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
630
631 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
632 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
633
634 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
635 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
636
637 @noindent
638 @cindex Standard user interface
639 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
640 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
641 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
642 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
643
644 @smallexample
645 @group
646
647 ...
648 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
649 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
650 2: 17.3 | 17.3
651 1: -5 | 3
652 . | 2
653 | 4
654 | * 8
655 | ->-5
656 |
657 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
658 @end group
659 @end smallexample
660
661 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
662 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
663 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
664 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
665 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
666 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
667 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
668 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
669 you do.
670
671 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
672 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
673 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
674 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
675 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
676
677 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
678 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
679 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
680
681 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
682 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
683 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
684 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
685 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
686 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
687 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
688
689 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
690 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
691 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
692 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
693 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
694 as Calc commands.
695
696 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
697 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
698 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
699 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
700 Calculator.
701
702 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
703 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
704 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
705 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
706 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
707 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
708 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
709
710 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
711
712 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
713 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
714 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
715 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
716 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
717 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
718 normal partial-screen mode.
719
720 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
721 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
722 editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
723 then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
724 switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
725 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
726 type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
727
728 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
729 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
730
731 @noindent
732 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
733 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
734 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
735
736 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
737 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
738 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
739 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
740 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
741 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
742 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
743 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
744
745 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
746 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
747
748 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
749 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
750
751 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
752 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
753
754 @noindent
755 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
756 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
757 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
758 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
759
760 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
761 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
762 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
763 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
764
765 @tex
766 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
767 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
768 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
769 \medskip
770 @end tex
771 @smallexample
772 @group
773 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
774 |2: 17.3
775 |1: -5
776 | .
777 |--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
778 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
779 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
780 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
781 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
782 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
783 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
784 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
785 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
786 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
787 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
788 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
789 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
790 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
791 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
792 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
793 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
794 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
795 @end group
796 @end smallexample
797
798 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
799 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
800 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
801 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
802 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
803 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
804
805 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
806 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
807 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
808 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
809 the stack).
810
811 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
812 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
813 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
814 numbers.
815
816 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
817 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
818 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
819 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
820 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
821
822 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
823 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
824 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
825
826 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
827 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
828
829 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
830 @subsection Standalone Operation
831
832 @noindent
833 @cindex Standalone Operation
834 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
835 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
836 can give the commands:
837
838 @example
839 emacs -f full-calc
840 @end example
841
842 @noindent
843 or
844
845 @example
846 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
847 @end example
848
849 @noindent
850 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
851 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
852 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
853 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
854 itself.
855
856 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
857 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
858
859 @noindent
860 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
861 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
862 document like this:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @group
866 The derivative of
867
868 ln(ln(x))
869
870 is
871 @end group
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
876 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
877 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
878 you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
879 formula:
880
881 @smallexample
882 @group
883 The derivative of
884
885 ln(ln(x))
886
887 is
888
889 ln(ln(x))
890 @end group
891 @end smallexample
892
893 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
894 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
895 how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
896 stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
897 the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
898 (in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
899 change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
900 @samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
901 buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
902 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
903 derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
904
905 @smallexample
906 @group
907 The derivative of
908
909 ln(ln(x))
910
911 is
912
913 1 / x ln(x)
914 @end group
915 @end smallexample
916
917 (Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
918 so that @samp{1 / x ln(x)} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (x ln(x))}.)
919
920 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
921 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
922
923 @smallexample
924 @group
925 The derivative of
926
927 ln(ln(x))
928
929 is
930 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
931 % [calc-mode: language: big]
932
933 1
934 -------
935 x ln(x)
936 @end group
937 @end smallexample
938
939 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
940 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
941 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
942 @LaTeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
943 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
944 out of the way.)
945
946 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
947 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
948
949 @smallexample
950 @group
951 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
952 % [calc-mode: language: big]
953 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
954
955 1
956 ------- (1)
957 ln(x) x
958 @end group
959 @end smallexample
960
961 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
962 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
963
964 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
965 generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
966 expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
967 Here's an example of its use (before you try this, remove the Calc
968 annotations or use a new buffer so that the extra settings in the
969 annotations don't take effect):
970
971 @smallexample
972 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
973 @end smallexample
974
975 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
976 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
977 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
978 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
979
980 @smallexample
981 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
982 @end smallexample
983
984 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
985 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
986
987 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
988 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
989
990 @noindent
991 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
992 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
993 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
994 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
995 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
996
997 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
998 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
999 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
1000 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
1001 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1002 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1003 formula.
1004
1005 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1006 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1007 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1008
1009 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1010 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1011 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1012 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1013 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1014 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1015 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1016 is something on the Calc stack.
1017
1018 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1019 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1020 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1021
1022 @noindent
1023 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1024
1025 @table @kbd
1026 @item *
1027 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1028
1029 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1030 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1031
1032 @item C
1033 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1034 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1035 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1036
1037 @item O
1038 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1039 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1040 move it out of that window.
1041
1042 @item B
1043 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1044
1045 @item Q
1046 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1047
1048 @item K
1049 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1050
1051 @item E
1052 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1053
1054 @item J
1055 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1056
1057 @item W
1058 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1059
1060 @item Z
1061 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1062
1063 @item X
1064 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1065 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1066 @end table
1067 @iftex
1068 @sp 2
1069 @end iftex
1070
1071 @noindent
1072 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1073
1074 @table @kbd
1075 @item G
1076 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1077
1078 @item R
1079 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1080
1081 @item :
1082 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1083
1084 @item _
1085 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1086
1087 @item Y
1088 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1089 @end table
1090 @iftex
1091 @sp 2
1092 @end iftex
1093
1094 @noindent
1095 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1096
1097 @table @kbd
1098 @item A
1099 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1100 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1101 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1102
1103 @item D
1104 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1105 the duplicate.
1106
1107 @item F
1108 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1109
1110 @item N
1111 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1112
1113 @item P
1114 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1115
1116 @item U
1117 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1118
1119 @item `
1120 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1121 @end table
1122 @iftex
1123 @sp 2
1124 @end iftex
1125
1126 @noindent
1127 Miscellaneous commands:
1128
1129 @table @kbd
1130 @item I
1131 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1132 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1133
1134 @item T
1135 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1136
1137 @item S
1138 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1139
1140 @item L
1141 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1142 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1143
1144 @item M
1145 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1146 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1147
1148 @item 0
1149 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1150 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1151 @end table
1152
1153 @node History and Acknowledgments, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1154 @section History and Acknowledgments
1155
1156 @noindent
1157 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1158 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1159 the value of
1160 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1161 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1162 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1163 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1164 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1165 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1166 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1167 all.
1168
1169 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1170 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1171 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1172 got too far out of hand.
1173
1174 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1175 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1176 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1177
1178 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1179 this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1180 only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so (at the time)---not
1181 enough for a decent calculator. So I had to write my own
1182 high-precision integer code as well, and once I had this I figured
1183 that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large integers.
1184 Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step. Also,
1185 since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1186 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it
1187 practical to support fractions as well as floats. All these features
1188 inspired me to look around for other data types that might be worth
1189 having.
1190
1191 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1192 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1193 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1194 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1195 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1196 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1197 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1198 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1199 implement what they needed for themselves.
1200
1201 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1202 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1203 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1204
1205 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1206 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1207 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1208
1209 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1210 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1211 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1212 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1213 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1214 algebra system for microcomputers.
1215
1216 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1217 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1218 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1219 rules, and many other algebra features;
1220 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1221 @infoline Francois
1222 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1223 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1224 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1225 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1226 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1227 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1228 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1229 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1230 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1231 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1232 well as many other things.
1233
1234 @cindex Bibliography
1235 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1236 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1237 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1238 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1239 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1240 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1241 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1242 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1243 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1244 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1245 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1246 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1247 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1248 Dan LaLiberte.
1249
1250 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1251 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1252 finished in two weeks.
1253
1254 @c [tutorial]
1255
1256 @ifinfo
1257 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1258 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1259 @chapter Tutorial
1260
1261 @noindent
1262 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1263
1264 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1265 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1266 for this).
1267
1268 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1269 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1270 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1271 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1272
1273 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1274 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1275 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1276 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1277 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1278
1279 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1280
1281 Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1282
1283 @menu
1284 * Tutorial::
1285 @end menu
1286
1287 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1288 @end ifinfo
1289 @ifnotinfo
1290 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1291 @end ifnotinfo
1292 @chapter Tutorial
1293
1294 @noindent
1295 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1296 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1297 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1298 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1299 @c [not-split]
1300 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1301 @c [when-split]
1302 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1303
1304 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1305 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1306 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1307 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1308 the Embedded mode interface.
1309
1310 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1311 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1312 @kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1313 current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1314 Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1315 window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1316 (If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1317 that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
1318
1319 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1320 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1321 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1322 general areas.
1323
1324 @ifnottex
1325 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1326 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1327 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1328 @end ifnottex
1329 @iftex
1330 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1331 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1332 Calc.
1333 @end iftex
1334
1335 @menu
1336 * Basic Tutorial::
1337 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1338 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1339 * Types Tutorial::
1340 * Algebra Tutorial::
1341 * Programming Tutorial::
1342
1343 * Answers to Exercises::
1344 @end menu
1345
1346 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1347 @section Basic Tutorial
1348
1349 @noindent
1350 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1351 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1352 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1353
1354 @menu
1355 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1356 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1357 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1358 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1359 @end menu
1360
1361 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1362 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1363
1364 @cindex RPN notation
1365 @noindent
1366 @ifnottex
1367 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1368 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1369 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1370 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1371 @end ifnottex
1372 @tex
1373 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1374 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1375 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1376 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1377 @end tex
1378
1379 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1380 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1381 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1382 from the top of the stack.
1383
1384 @cindex Operators
1385 @cindex Operands
1386 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1387 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1388 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1389 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1390 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1391 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1392
1393 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1394 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1395 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1396 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1397 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1398 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1399 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1400 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1401 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1402
1403 @smallexample
1404 @group
1405 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1406 . 1: 3 .
1407 .
1408
1409 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1410 @end group
1411 @end smallexample
1412
1413 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1414 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1415 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1416 less distracting in regular use.
1417
1418 @cindex Stack levels
1419 @cindex Levels of stack
1420 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1421 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1422 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1423 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1424 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1425 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1426 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1427
1428 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1429 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1430 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1431 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1432 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1433 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1434 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1435 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1436 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1437 if you are interested.
1438
1439 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1440 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1441 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1442 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1443 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1444
1445 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1446 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1447
1448 @smallexample
1449 @group
1450 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1451 . 1: 3 .
1452 .
1453
1454 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1455 @end group
1456 @end smallexample
1457
1458 @noindent
1459 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1460 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1461 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1462
1463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1464 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1465 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1466 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1467 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1468 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1469 return to where you were.)
1470
1471 @noindent
1472 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1473 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1474 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1475 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1476
1477 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1478 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.5) + {5\over4}}
1479 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1480 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1481
1482 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1483 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1484 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1485 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1486 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1487 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1488 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1489 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1490 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1491
1492 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1493 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1494 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1495
1496 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1497 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1498 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1499 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1500 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1501
1502 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1503 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1504 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1505
1506 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1507 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1508 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1509
1510 @smallexample
1511 @group
1512 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1513 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1514 . .
1515
1516 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1517 @end group
1518 @end smallexample
1519
1520 @noindent
1521 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1522 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1523
1524 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1525 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1526 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1527
1528 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1529 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1530 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1531 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1532 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1533
1534 @smallexample
1535 @group
1536 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1537 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1538 . .
1539
1540 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1541 @end group
1542 @end smallexample
1543
1544 @noindent
1545 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1546
1547 @smallexample
1548 @group
1549 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1550 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1551 . 1: 3 .
1552 .
1553
1554 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1555 @end group
1556 @end smallexample
1557
1558 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1559 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1560 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1561
1562 @smallexample
1563 @group
1564 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1565 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1566 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1567 . . .
1568
1569 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1570 @end group
1571 @end smallexample
1572
1573 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1574 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1575 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1576 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1577
1578 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1579 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1580 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1581 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1582
1583 @smallexample
1584 @group
1585 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1586 . . 1: 16 . .
1587 .
1588
1589 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1590 @end group
1591 @end smallexample
1592
1593 @noindent
1594 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1595 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1596
1597 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1598 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1599 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1600 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1601 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1602
1603 @smallexample
1604 @group
1605 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1606 . 1: 4 .
1607 .
1608
1609 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1610 @end group
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1614 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1615 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1616 prefix for you:
1617
1618 @smallexample
1619 @group
1620 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1621 . 1: 4 .
1622 .
1623
1624 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1625 @end group
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 @group
1632 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1633 . . .
1634
1635 4 @key{RET} n Q
1636 @end group
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent
1640 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1641 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1642 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1643 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1644
1645 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1646 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1647 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1648 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1649 complex result.)
1650
1651 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1652 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1653
1654 @smallexample
1655 @group
1656 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1657 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1658 . .
1659
1660 ( 2 , 3 )
1661 @end group
1662 @end smallexample
1663
1664 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1665 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1666
1667 @smallexample
1668 @group
1669 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1670 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1671 . 1: 3 . .
1672 .
1673 (error)
1674 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1675 @end group
1676 @end smallexample
1677
1678 @noindent
1679 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1680 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1681
1682 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1683 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1684
1685 @smallexample
1686 @group
1687 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1688 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1689 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1690 . . .
1691
1692 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1693 @end group
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 @noindent
1697 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1698 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1699 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1700 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1701
1702 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1703 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1704 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1705 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1706 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1707
1708 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1709 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1710 the tutorial.
1711
1712 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1713 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1714 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1715 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1716 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1717 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1718 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1719
1720 @smallexample
1721 @group
1722 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1723 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1724 . 1: 30 1: 30
1725 . .
1726
1727 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1728 @end group
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1732 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1733 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1734 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1735 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 @group
1739 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1740 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1741 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1742 . . 1: 20
1743 .
1744
1745 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1746 @end group
1747 @end smallexample
1748
1749 @cindex Clearing the stack
1750 @cindex Emptying the stack
1751 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1752 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1753 entire stack.)
1754
1755 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1756 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1757
1758 @noindent
1759 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1760 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1761 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1762 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1763
1764 @strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1765 that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1766 standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
1767
1768 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1769 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1770 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1771 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1772 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1773 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1774 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1775
1776 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1777 The result should be the number 9.
1778
1779 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1780 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1781 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1782 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1783 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1784
1785 @example
1786 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1787 @end example
1788
1789 @noindent
1790 is equivalent to
1791
1792 @example
1793 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1794 @end example
1795
1796 @noindent
1797 or, in large mathematical notation,
1798
1799 @ifnottex
1800 @example
1801 @group
1802 3 * 4 * 5
1803 2 + --------- - 9
1804 8
1805 6 * 7
1806 @end group
1807 @end example
1808 @end ifnottex
1809 @tex
1810 \beforedisplay
1811 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1812 \afterdisplay
1813 @end tex
1814
1815 @noindent
1816 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1817
1818 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1819 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1820 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1821 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1822
1823 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1824 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1825 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1826 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1827
1828 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1829 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1830 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1831 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1832 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1833
1834 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1835
1836 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1837 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1838 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1839 an algebraic entry.
1840
1841 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1842 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1843 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1844 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1845 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1846
1847 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1848 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1849
1850 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1851 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1852 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1853 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1854 rule to use!
1855
1856 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1857 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1858 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1859
1860 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1861
1862 @smallexample
1863 @group
1864 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1865 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1866 . .
1867
1868 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1869 @end group
1870 @end smallexample
1871
1872 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1873 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1874 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1875
1876 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1877 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1878 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1879 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1880 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1881 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1882 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1883
1884 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1885
1886 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1887 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1888 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1889 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1890 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1891 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1892 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1893 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1894 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1895 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1896 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1897 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1898 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1899
1900 @smallexample
1901 @group
1902 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1903 . . .
1904
1905 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1906 @end group
1907 @end smallexample
1908
1909 @noindent
1910 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1911 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1912
1913 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1914 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1915 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1916 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1917
1918 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1919 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1920
1921 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1922 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1923 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1924 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1925 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1926 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1927 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1928
1929 @smallexample
1930 @group
1931 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1932 . . .
1933
1934 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1935 @end group
1936 @end smallexample
1937
1938 @noindent
1939 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1940 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1941
1942 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1943 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1944 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 @group
1948 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1949 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1950 . 1: 2 .
1951 .
1952
1953 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1954 @end group
1955 @end smallexample
1956
1957 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1958 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1959 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1960 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1961 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1962 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1963
1964 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1965 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1966
1967 @smallexample
1968 @group
1969 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 2 b + 34
1970 . .
1971
1972 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1973 @end group
1974 @end smallexample
1975
1976 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1977 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1978
1979 @smallexample
1980 @group
1981 1: log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3) + 2
1982 .
1983
1984 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1985 @end group
1986 @end smallexample
1987
1988 @noindent
1989 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1990 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1991 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1992 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1993 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1994 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1995 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1996 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1997 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1998 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1999 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
2000 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
2001 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2002 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2003
2004 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2005 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2006 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2007 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2008 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2009
2010 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2011 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2012 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2013
2014 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2015 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2016 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2017 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2018 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2019 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2020 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2021 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2022
2023 @smallexample
2024 @group
2025 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2026 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2027 . .
2028
2029 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2030 @end group
2031 @end smallexample
2032
2033 @noindent
2034 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2035 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2036 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2037 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2038 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2039
2040 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2041
2042 @smallexample
2043 @group
2044 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2045 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2046 .
2047
2048 s u a @key{RET}
2049 @end group
2050 @end smallexample
2051
2052 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2053 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2054
2055 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2056 @subsection Undo and Redo
2057
2058 @noindent
2059 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2060 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2061 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2062 with a clean slate. Now:
2063
2064 @smallexample
2065 @group
2066 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2067 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2068 . .
2069
2070 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2071 @end group
2072 @end smallexample
2073
2074 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2075 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2076 above example, you could type:
2077
2078 @smallexample
2079 @group
2080 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2081 . 1: 3 .
2082 .
2083 (error)
2084 U U U U
2085 @end group
2086 @end smallexample
2087
2088 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2089 mistakenly.
2090
2091 @smallexample
2092 @group
2093 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2094 . 1: 3 . .
2095 .
2096 (error)
2097 D D D D
2098 @end group
2099 @end smallexample
2100
2101 @noindent
2102 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2103 by something other than an undo command.
2104
2105 @cindex Time travel
2106 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2107 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2108 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2109 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2110 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2111 was an earlier undo command.
2112
2113 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2114 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2115 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2116 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2117
2118 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2119 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2120 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2121 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2122 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2123 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2124 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2125 stack.
2126
2127 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2128 went into the trail.
2129
2130 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2131 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2132 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2133 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2134 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2135 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2136 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2137 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2138
2139 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2140 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2141 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2142 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2143 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2144
2145 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2146 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2147 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2148 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2149 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2150 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2151 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2152 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2153 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2154 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2155 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2156
2157 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2158
2159 @smallexample
2160 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2161 @end smallexample
2162
2163 @noindent
2164 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2165 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2166 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2167 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2168 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2169 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2170 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2171
2172 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2173 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2174 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2175 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2176 the prefix.
2177
2178 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2179 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2180 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2181 to edit a stack entry.
2182
2183 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2184 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2185 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2186 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2187 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2188 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2189 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2190 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2191
2192 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2193 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2194
2195 @noindent
2196 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2197 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2198 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2199 try some of the most common ones here.
2200
2201 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2202 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2203
2204 @smallexample
2205 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2206 @end smallexample
2207
2208 @noindent
2209 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2210 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2211 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2212 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2213 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2214 leading and trailing zeros.
2215
2216 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2217 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2218 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 @group
2222 1: 0.142857142857
2223 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2224 .
2225 @end group
2226 @end smallexample
2227
2228 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2229 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2230 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2231 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2232
2233 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2234 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2235
2236 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2237 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2238 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2239 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2240 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2241 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2242 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 @group
2246 1: 0.142857142857
2247 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2248 3: 1.14285714286
2249 .
2250 @end group
2251 @end smallexample
2252
2253 @noindent
2254 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2255 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2256
2257 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2258 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2259 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2260 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2261 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2262 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2263 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2264 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2265 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2266 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2267 arithmetic.
2268
2269 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2270 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2271 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2272
2273 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2274
2275 @smallexample
2276 @group
2277 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2278 . 1: 10000 .
2279 .
2280
2281 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2282 @end group
2283 @end smallexample
2284
2285 @noindent
2286 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2287 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2288 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2289 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2290 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2291
2292 @smallexample
2293 @group
2294 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2295 . 1: 10000. .
2296 .
2297
2298 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2299 @end group
2300 @end smallexample
2301
2302 @cindex Round-off errors
2303 @noindent
2304 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2305 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2306 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2307 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2308 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2309 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2310 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2311 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2312 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2313 out:
2314
2315 @smallexample
2316 @group
2317 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2318 . 1: 10000. .
2319 .
2320
2321 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2322 @end group
2323 @end smallexample
2324
2325 @noindent
2326 @cindex Guard digits
2327 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2328 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2329 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2330 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2331 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2332 last place.
2333
2334 @cindex Guard digits
2335 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2336 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2337 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2338 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2339 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2340 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2341 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2342
2343 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2344 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2345 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2346 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2347 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2348 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2349 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2350 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2351 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2352 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2353 numbers shown here:
2354
2355 @smallexample
2356 @group
2357 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2358 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2359 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2360 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2361 . . . . .
2362
2363 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2364 @end group
2365 @end smallexample
2366
2367 @noindent
2368 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2369 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2370 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2371 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2372 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2373 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2374
2375 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2376 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2377 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2378 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2379
2380 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2381 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2382 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2383 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2384 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2385
2386 @smallexample
2387 @group
2388 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2389 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2390 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2391 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2392 . . . . .
2393
2394 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2395 @end group
2396 @end smallexample
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2400 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2401 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2402 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2403 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2404 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2405 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2406
2407 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2408 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2409 displayed exactly.
2410
2411 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2412 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2413 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2414
2415 @example
2416 2417851639229258349412352
2417 @end example
2418
2419 @noindent
2420 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2421
2422 @example
2423 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2424 @end example
2425
2426 @noindent
2427 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2428 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2429 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2430
2431 @example
2432 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2433 @end example
2434
2435 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2436 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2437 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2438
2439 @example
2440 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2441 @end example
2442
2443 @noindent
2444 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2445 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2446
2447 @example
2448 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2449 @end example
2450
2451 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2452 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2453
2454 @example
2455 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2456 @end example
2457
2458 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2459 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2460 restore the default precision.
2461
2462 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2463 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2464 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2465 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2466
2467 @example
2468 16#200000000000000000000
2469 @end example
2470
2471 @noindent
2472 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2473 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2474 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2475 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2476 form:
2477
2478 @example
2479 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2480 @end example
2481
2482 @noindent
2483 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2484 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2485 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2486 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2487 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2488 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2489
2490 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2491 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2492 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2493 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2494 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2495
2496 @example
2497 2#101,1111,1110
2498 @end example
2499
2500 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2501 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2502 other radix.
2503
2504 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2505
2506 @example
2507 1,534
2508 @end example
2509
2510 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2511 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2512 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2513 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2514
2515 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2516 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2517 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2518 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2519 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2520 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2521 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2522 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2523 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2524
2525 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2526 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2527 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2528 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2529 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2530 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2531 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2532 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2533
2534 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2535 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2536 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2537 the way they are actually computed.
2538
2539 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2540 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2541 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2542 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2543
2544 @smallexample
2545 @group
2546 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2547 . . . .
2548
2549 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2550 @end group
2551 @end smallexample
2552
2553 @noindent
2554 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2555 of 45 degrees is
2556 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2557 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2558 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2559 roundoff error because the representation of
2560 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2561 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2562 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2563 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2564 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2565
2566 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2567 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2568 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2569 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2570 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2571
2572 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2573 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2574 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2575 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2576 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2577
2578 @smallexample
2579 @group
2580 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2581 . . .
2582
2583 P 4 / m r S
2584 @end group
2585 @end smallexample
2586
2587 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2588 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2589
2590 @smallexample
2591 @group
2592 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2593 . . .
2594
2595 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2596 @end group
2597 @end smallexample
2598
2599 @noindent
2600 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2601 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2602 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2603 first in radians, then in degrees.
2604
2605 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2606 and vice-versa.
2607
2608 @smallexample
2609 @group
2610 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2611 . . .
2612
2613 45 c r c d
2614 @end group
2615 @end smallexample
2616
2617 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2618 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2619 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2620 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2621 number, instead.
2622
2623 @smallexample
2624 @group
2625 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2626 1: 9 . .
2627 .
2628
2629 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2630 @end group
2631 @end smallexample
2632
2633 @noindent
2634 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2635 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2636
2637 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2638 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2639 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2640 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2641 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2642 what to do when dividing two integers.
2643
2644 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2645 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2646 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2647 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2648 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2649
2650 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2651 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2652 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2653 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2654 recompute for you.
2655
2656 @smallexample
2657 @group
2658 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2659 . . .
2660
2661 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2662 @end group
2663 @end smallexample
2664
2665 @noindent
2666 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2667 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2668 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2669 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2670 might affect their values.
2671
2672 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2673 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2674
2675 @noindent
2676 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2677 available in the Calculator.
2678
2679 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2680 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2681 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2682 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2683
2684 @smallexample
2685 @group
2686 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2687 . . . . .
2688
2689 5 & & n n
2690 @end group
2691 @end smallexample
2692
2693 @cindex Binary operators
2694 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2695 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2696 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2697 a negative prefix.
2698
2699 @smallexample
2700 @group
2701 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2702 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2703 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2704 . . 1: 10 .
2705 .
2706
2707 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2708 @end group
2709 @end smallexample
2710
2711 @cindex Unary operators
2712 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2713 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2714
2715 @smallexample
2716 @group
2717 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2718 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2719 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2720 . . .
2721
2722 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2723 @end group
2724 @end smallexample
2725
2726 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2727 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2728 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2729 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2730 integer.
2731
2732 @smallexample
2733 @group
2734 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2735 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2736 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2737 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2738 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2739 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2740 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2741 . . .
2742
2743 M-7 F U M-7 R
2744 @end group
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2748 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2749 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2750 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2751 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2752
2753 @smallexample
2754 @group
2755 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2756 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2757 . .
2758
2759 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2760 @end group
2761 @end smallexample
2762
2763 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2764
2765 @smallexample
2766 @group
2767 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2768 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2769 . .
2770
2771 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2772 @end group
2773 @end smallexample
2774
2775 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2776 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2777 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2778 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2779 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2780
2781 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2782 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2783 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2784 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2785 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2786
2787 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2788 identity
2789 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2790 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2791 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2792 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2793
2794 @smallexample
2795 @group
2796 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2797 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2798 . . . .
2799
2800 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2801 @end group
2802 @end smallexample
2803
2804 @noindent
2805 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2806 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2807
2808 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2809 of squares, command.
2810
2811 Another identity is
2812 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2813 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2814 @smallexample
2815 @group
2816
2817 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2818 1: 0.43837 . .
2819 .
2820
2821 U / I T
2822 @end group
2823 @end smallexample
2824
2825 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2826 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2827 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2828 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 @group
2832 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2833 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2834 . .
2835
2836 U U M-2 n / I T
2837 @end group
2838 @end smallexample
2839
2840 @noindent
2841 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2842 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2843 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2844 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2845 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2846 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2847 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2848
2849 @smallexample
2850 @group
2851 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2852 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2853 . 1: 0.43837 .
2854 .
2855
2856 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2857 @end group
2858 @end smallexample
2859
2860 @noindent
2861 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2862 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2863
2864 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2865 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2866 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2867 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2868 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2869 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2870 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2871 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2872
2873 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2874 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2875 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2876 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2877 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 @group
2881 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2882 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2883 . . . . .
2884
2885 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2886 @end group
2887 @end smallexample
2888
2889 @noindent
2890 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2891 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2892 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2893 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2894 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2895 error.
2896
2897 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2898 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2899 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2900 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2901
2902 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2903 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2904
2905 @cindex Common logarithm
2906 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2907 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2908 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2909 prefix.
2910
2911 @smallexample
2912 @group
2913 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2914 . . . .
2915
2916 1000 L U H L
2917 @end group
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 @noindent
2921 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2922 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2923
2924 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2925 value of @var{b}.
2926
2927 @smallexample
2928 @group
2929 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2930 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2931 . .
2932
2933 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2934 @end group
2935 @end smallexample
2936
2937 @noindent
2938 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2939 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2940 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2941 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2942 onto the stack.
2943
2944 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2945 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2946 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2947 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2948 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2949 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2950 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2951 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2952 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2953 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2954
2955 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2956 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2957 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2958
2959 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2960 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2961 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2962
2963 @smallexample
2964 @group
2965 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2966 . . . .
2967
2968 100 ! U c f !
2969 @end group
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2974 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2975 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2976 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2977 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2978 in this case).
2979
2980 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2981 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2982 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2983 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2984 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2985
2986 @smallexample
2987 @group
2988 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2989 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2990 1: 5. 1: 120.
2991 . .
2992
2993 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2994 @end group
2995 @end smallexample
2996
2997 @noindent
2998 Here we verify the identity
2999 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
3000 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
3001
3002 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3003 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3004 is defined by
3005 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3006 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3007 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3008 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3009 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3010 large intermediate values.
3011
3012 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3013 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3014 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3015
3016 @smallexample
3017 @group
3018 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3019 1: 20 . .
3020 .
3021
3022 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3023 @end group
3024 @end smallexample
3025
3026 @noindent
3027 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3028 together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3029 number, 30045015.
3030
3031 @cindex Hash tables
3032 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3033 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3034 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 @group
3038 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3039 . . .
3040
3041 10000 k n I k n
3042 @end group
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 @noindent
3046 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3047 10000.
3048
3049 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3050 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3051 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3052 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3053
3054 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3055 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3056 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3057
3058 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3059 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3063 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3064 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3065 a vector as a list of objects.
3066
3067 @menu
3068 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3069 * Matrix Tutorial::
3070 * List Tutorial::
3071 @end menu
3072
3073 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3074 @subsection Vector Analysis
3075
3076 @noindent
3077 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3078 elements, taken pairwise.
3079
3080 @smallexample
3081 @group
3082 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3083 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3084 .
3085
3086 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3087 @end group
3088 @end smallexample
3089
3090 @noindent
3091 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3092 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3093 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3094 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3095
3096 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3097 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3098 of the vectors.
3099
3100 @smallexample
3101 @group
3102 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3103 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3104 .
3105
3106 r 1 r 2 *
3107 @end group
3108 @end smallexample
3109
3110 @cindex Dot product
3111 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3112 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3113 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3114 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3115 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3116 vector.
3117
3118 @smallexample
3119 @group
3120 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3121 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3122 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3123 . .
3124
3125 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3126 @end group
3127 @end smallexample
3128
3129 @noindent
3130 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3131 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3132 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3133 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3134 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3135 is about 56 degrees.
3136
3137 @cindex Cross product
3138 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3139 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3140 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3141 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3142 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3143 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3144 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3145
3146 @smallexample
3147 @group
3148 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3149 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3150 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3151 .
3152
3153 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3154 @end group
3155 @end smallexample
3156
3157 @noindent
3158 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3159 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3160 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3161 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3162
3163 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3164 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3165 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3166 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3167 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3168 prefix keys have this property.)
3169
3170 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3171 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3172 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3173
3174 @smallexample
3175 @group
3176 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3177 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3178 . .
3179
3180 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3181 @end group
3182 @end smallexample
3183
3184 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3185 @cindex Unit vectors
3186 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3187 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3188 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3189 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3190
3191 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3192 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3193 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3194 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3195 Find the average position of the particle.
3196 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3197
3198 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3199 @subsection Matrices
3200
3201 @noindent
3202 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3203 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3204 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3205 both methods here:
3206
3207 @smallexample
3208 @group
3209 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3210 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3211 . .
3212
3213 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3214 @end group
3215 @end smallexample
3216
3217 @noindent
3218 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3219
3220 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3221 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3222 the second example.
3223
3224 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3225 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3226 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3227 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3228 of the right matrix.
3229
3230 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3231 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3232
3233 @smallexample
3234 @group
3235 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3236 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3237 .
3238
3239 @key{RET} *
3240 @end group
3241 @end smallexample
3242
3243 @noindent
3244 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3245 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3246 been left in symbolic form.
3247
3248 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 @group
3252 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3253 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3254 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3255 [ 2, 5 ] .
3256 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3257 .
3258
3259 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3260 @end group
3261 @end smallexample
3262
3263 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3264 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3265 matrix, as happened here!
3266
3267 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3268 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3269 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3270 as a row or column as appropriate.
3271
3272 @smallexample
3273 @group
3274 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3275 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3276 1: [1, 2, 3]
3277 .
3278
3279 r 4 r 1 *
3280 @end group
3281 @end smallexample
3282
3283 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3284 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3285 vector.
3286
3287 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3288 of the above
3289 @texline @math{2\times3}
3290 @infoline 2x3
3291 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3292 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3293 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3294
3295 @cindex Identity matrix
3296 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3297 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3298 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3299 the original matrix.
3300
3301 @smallexample
3302 @group
3303 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3304 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3305 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3306 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3307 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3308 .
3309
3310 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3311 @end group
3312 @end smallexample
3313
3314 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3315 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3316 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3317 inverse of a matrix.
3318
3319 @smallexample
3320 @group
3321 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3322 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3323 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3324 . .
3325
3326 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3327 @end group
3328 @end smallexample
3329
3330 @noindent
3331 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3332 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3333 our matrix to make it square.
3334
3335 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3336
3337 @smallexample
3338 @group
3339 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3340 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3341 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3342 . .
3343
3344 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3345 @end group
3346 @end smallexample
3347
3348 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3349 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3350 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3351 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3352
3353 @ifnottex
3354 @group
3355 @example
3356 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3357 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3358 7a + 6b = 3
3359 @end example
3360 @end group
3361 @end ifnottex
3362 @tex
3363 \beforedisplayh
3364 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3365 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3368 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3369 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3370 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3371 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3372 $$
3373 \afterdisplayh
3374 @end tex
3375
3376 @noindent
3377 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3378
3379 @ifnottex
3380 @group
3381 @example
3382 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3383 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3384 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3385 @end example
3386 @end group
3387 @end ifnottex
3388 @tex
3389 \beforedisplay
3390 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3391 \times
3392 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3393 $$
3394 \afterdisplay
3395 @end tex
3396
3397 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3398 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3399
3400 @smallexample
3401 @group
3402 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3403 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3404 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3405 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3406 .
3407
3408 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3409 @end group
3410 @end smallexample
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3414 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3415 inverse.)
3416
3417 Let's verify this solution:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 @group
3421 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3422 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3423 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3424 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3425 .
3426
3427 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3428 @end group
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3433 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3434 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3435 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3436 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3437 vectors, use explicit
3438 @texline @math{N\times1}
3439 @infoline Nx1
3440 or
3441 @texline @math{1\times N}
3442 @infoline 1xN
3443 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3444 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3445
3446 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3447 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3448 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3449 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3450
3451 @ifnottex
3452 @group
3453 @example
3454 x + a y = 6
3455 x + b y = 10
3456 @end example
3457 @end group
3458 @end ifnottex
3459 @tex
3460 \beforedisplay
3461 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3462 x &+ b y = 10}
3463 $$
3464 \afterdisplay
3465 @end tex
3466
3467 @noindent
3468 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3469
3470 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3471 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3472 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3473 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3474 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3475 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3476 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3477 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3478 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3479 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3480 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3481 @ifnottex
3482 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3483 @end ifnottex
3484 @tex
3485 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3486 @end tex
3487 Now
3488 @texline @math{A^T A}
3489 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3490 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3491 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3492 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3493 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3494 system:
3495
3496 @ifnottex
3497 @group
3498 @example
3499 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3500 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3501 7a + 6b = 3
3502 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3503 @end example
3504 @end group
3505 @end ifnottex
3506 @tex
3507 \beforedisplayh
3508 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3509 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3510 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3511 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3512 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3513 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3514 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3515 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3516 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3517 $$
3518 \afterdisplayh
3519 @end tex
3520
3521 @noindent
3522 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3523
3524 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3525 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3526
3527 @noindent
3528 @cindex Lists
3529 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3530 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3531 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3532 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3533 number.
3534
3535 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3536
3537 @smallexample
3538 @group
3539 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3540 2: 20 . 2: 20
3541 1: 30 1: 30
3542 . .
3543
3544 M-3 v p v u
3545 @end group
3546 @end smallexample
3547
3548 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3549 of many copies of a given value:
3550
3551 @smallexample
3552 @group
3553 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3554 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3555 . .
3556
3557 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3558 @end group
3559 @end smallexample
3560
3561 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3562 @dfn{map} command.
3563
3564 @smallexample
3565 @group
3566 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3567 . . .
3568
3569 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3570 @end group
3571 @end smallexample
3572
3573 @noindent
3574 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3575 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3576 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3577 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3578 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3579 of each element.
3580
3581 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3582 from
3583 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3584 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3585 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3586
3587 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3588 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3589 elements in the vector:
3590
3591 @smallexample
3592 @group
3593 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3594 . . .
3595
3596 123123 k f V R *
3597 @end group
3598 @end smallexample
3599
3600 @noindent
3601 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3602 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3603
3604 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3605 reduction:
3606
3607 @smallexample
3608 @group
3609 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3610 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3611 .
3612
3613 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3614 @end group
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @noindent
3618 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3619 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3620 for the dot product as before.
3621
3622 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3623 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3624 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3625
3626 @smallexample
3627 @group
3628 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3629 . .
3630
3631 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3632 @end group
3633 @end smallexample
3634
3635 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3636 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3637 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3638 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3639 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3640 vector size).
3641
3642 @smallexample
3643 @group
3644 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3645 . .
3646
3647 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3648 @end group
3649 @end smallexample
3650
3651 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3652 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3653 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3654
3655 @smallexample
3656 @group
3657 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3658 . .
3659
3660 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3661 @end group
3662 @end smallexample
3663
3664 @noindent
3665 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3666 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3667 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3668 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3669 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3670 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3671 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3672
3673 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3674 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3675 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3676
3677 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3678 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3679 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3680 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3681 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3682 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3683 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3684 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3685 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3686 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3687
3688 @smallexample
3689 x y
3690 --- ---
3691 1.34 0.234
3692 1.41 0.298
3693 1.49 0.402
3694 1.56 0.412
3695 1.64 0.466
3696 1.73 0.473
3697 1.82 0.601
3698 1.91 0.519
3699 2.01 0.603
3700 2.11 0.637
3701 2.22 0.645
3702 2.33 0.705
3703 2.45 0.917
3704 2.58 1.009
3705 2.71 0.971
3706 2.85 1.062
3707 3.00 1.148
3708 3.15 1.157
3709 3.32 1.354
3710 @end smallexample
3711
3712 @noindent
3713 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3714 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3715 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3716 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3717
3718 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3719 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3720 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3721 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3722 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3723 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3724 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3725 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3726
3727 @smallexample
3728 @group
3729 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3730 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3731 @dots{}
3732 @end group
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 @noindent
3736 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3737 large matrix.)
3738
3739 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3740 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3741 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3742 of row vectors on the stack.
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 @group
3746 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3747 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3748 . .
3749
3750 v t v u
3751 @end group
3752 @end smallexample
3753
3754 @noindent
3755 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3756
3757 @smallexample
3758 @group
3759 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3760 .
3761
3762 t 2 t 1
3763 @end group
3764 @end smallexample
3765
3766 @noindent
3767 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3768 stored value from the stack.)
3769
3770 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3771
3772 @ifnottex
3773 @example
3774 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3775 @end example
3776 @end ifnottex
3777 @tex
3778 \beforedisplay
3779 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3780 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3781 \afterdisplay
3782 @end tex
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 where
3786 @texline @math{\sum x}
3787 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3788 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3789 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3790 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3791 this formula uses.
3792
3793 @smallexample
3794 @group
3795 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3796 . .
3797
3798 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3799
3800 @end group
3801 @end smallexample
3802 @noindent
3803 @smallexample
3804 @group
3805 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3806 . .
3807
3808 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3809 @end group
3810 @end smallexample
3811
3812 @ifnottex
3813 @noindent
3814 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3815 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3816 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3817 @end ifnottex
3818 @tex
3819 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3820 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3821 $\sum x y$.)
3822 @end tex
3823
3824 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3825 the length of either of our lists.
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 @group
3829 1: 19
3830 .
3831
3832 r 1 v l t 7
3833 @end group
3834 @end smallexample
3835
3836 @noindent
3837 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3838
3839 Now we grind through the formula:
3840
3841 @smallexample
3842 @group
3843 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3844 . 1: 566.70919 .
3845 .
3846
3847 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3848
3849 @end group
3850 @end smallexample
3851 @noindent
3852 @smallexample
3853 @group
3854 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3855 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3856 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3857 .
3858
3859 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3860 @end group
3861 @end smallexample
3862
3863 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3864 be found with the simple formula,
3865
3866 @ifnottex
3867 @example
3868 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3869 @end example
3870 @end ifnottex
3871 @tex
3872 \beforedisplay
3873 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3874 \afterdisplay
3875 \vskip10pt
3876 @end tex
3877
3878 @smallexample
3879 @group
3880 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3881 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3882 .
3883
3884 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3885 @end group
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3889 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3890 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3891 and compare it with the original data.
3892
3893 @smallexample
3894 @group
3895 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3896 . .
3897
3898 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3899 @end group
3900 @end smallexample
3901
3902 @noindent
3903 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3904 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3905 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3906 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3907
3908 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3909 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3910
3911 @smallexample
3912 @group
3913 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3914 . . .
3915
3916 r 2 - V M A V R X
3917 @end group
3918 @end smallexample
3919
3920 @noindent
3921 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3922 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3923 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3924 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3925 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3926 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3927 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3928 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3929 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3930
3931 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3932 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3933 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3934 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3935 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3936
3937 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3938 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3939 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3940 plotting of data.
3941
3942 @smallexample
3943 @group
3944 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3945 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3946 .
3947
3948 r 1 r 2 g f
3949 @end group
3950 @end smallexample
3951
3952 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3953 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3954 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3955 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3956 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3957 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3958
3959 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3960 @ifinfo
3961 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3962 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3963 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3964 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3965 @end ifinfo
3966
3967 @smallexample
3968 @group
3969 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3970 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3971 .
3972
3973 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3974 @end group
3975 @end smallexample
3976
3977 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3978 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3979 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3980
3981 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3982 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3983 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3984 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3985 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3986 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3987
3988 @cindex Geometric mean
3989 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3990 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3991 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3992 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3993 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
3994 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
3995
3996 @example
3997 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
3998 15 14 7.5
3999 2.5
4000 @end example
4001
4002 @noindent
4003 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4004 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4005 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4006
4007 @ifnottex
4008 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4009 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4010 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4011 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4012 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4013 for @expr{n=6}.
4014 @end ifnottex
4015 @tex
4016 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4017 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4018 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4019 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4020 for \cite{n=6}.
4021 @end tex
4022
4023 @smallexample
4024 @group
4025 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4026 . .
4027
4028 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4029
4030 @end group
4031 @end smallexample
4032 @noindent
4033 @smallexample
4034 @group
4035 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4036 . .
4037
4038 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4039 @end group
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4043 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4044 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4045 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4046 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4047
4048 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4049 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4050 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4051 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4052 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4053 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4054
4055 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4056 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4057 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4058 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4059 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4060 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4061 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4062 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4063 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4064 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4065 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4066 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4067 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4068 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4069 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4070
4071 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4072 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4073 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4074 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4075
4076 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4077 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4078 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4079 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4080 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4081 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4082
4083 @cindex Divisor functions
4084 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4085 @tex
4086 $\sigma_k(n)$
4087 @end tex
4088 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4089 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4090 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4091 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4092 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4093
4094 @cindex Square-free numbers
4095 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4096 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4097 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4098 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4099 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4100 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4101 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4102 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4103
4104 @cindex Triangular lists
4105 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4106 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4107 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 @group
4111 1: [ [1],
4112 [1, 2],
4113 [1, 2, 3],
4114 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4115 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4116 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4117 @end group
4118 @end smallexample
4119
4120 @noindent
4121 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4122
4123 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4124
4125 @smallexample
4126 @group
4127 1: [ [0],
4128 [1, 2],
4129 [3, 4, 5],
4130 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4131 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4132 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4133 @end group
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4138
4139 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4140 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4141 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4142 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4143 @infoline @expr{J1}
4144 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4145 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4146 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4147 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4148 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4149 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4150 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4151
4152 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4153 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4154 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4155 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4156 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4157 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4158 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4159 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4160 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4161 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4162 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4163
4164 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4165 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4166 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4167
4168 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4169 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4170 @texline @math{2\times2}
4171 @infoline 2x2
4172 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4173 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4174 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4175 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4176 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4177 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4178 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4179 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4180 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4181 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4182
4183 @cindex Matchstick problem
4184 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4185 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4186 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4187 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4188 a line turns out to be
4189 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4190 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4191 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4192 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4193 one turns out to be
4194 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4195 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4196 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4197 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4198
4199 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4200 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4201 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4202 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4203 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4204 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4205 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4206 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4207 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4208 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4209 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4210 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4211 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4212 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4213 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4214 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4215 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4216 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4217
4218 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4219 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4220 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4221 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4222 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4223 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4224 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4225 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4226 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4227 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4228 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4229 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4230
4231 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4232 @section Types Tutorial
4233
4234 @noindent
4235 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4236 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4237
4238 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4239 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4240 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4241 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4242 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 @group
4246 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4247 . 1: 49 . . .
4248 .
4249
4250 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4251 @end group
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 @noindent
4255 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4256 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4257 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4258 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4259 fraction beginning with 49.
4260
4261 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4262 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4263
4264 @smallexample
4265 @group
4266 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4267 . .
4268
4269 c f c F
4270 @end group
4271 @end smallexample
4272
4273 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4274 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4275 same, to within the current precision.
4276
4277 @smallexample
4278 @group
4279 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4280 . . . .
4281
4282 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4283 @end group
4284 @end smallexample
4285
4286 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4287 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4288 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4289 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4290
4291 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4292
4293 @smallexample
4294 @group
4295 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4296 . . . . .
4297
4298 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4299 @end group
4300 @end smallexample
4301
4302 @noindent
4303 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4304 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4305 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4306 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4307
4308 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4309 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4310 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4311 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4312 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4313 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4314 algebraic entry.
4315
4316 @smallexample
4317 @group
4318 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4319 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4320 . . . .
4321
4322 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4323 @end group
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4328 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4329 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4330 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4331 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4332 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4333 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4334 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4335 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4336 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4337 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4338 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4339 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4340
4341 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4342 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4343 to turn on Infinite mode.
4344
4345 @smallexample
4346 @group
4347 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4348 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4349 1: 0 . . .
4350 .
4351
4352 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4353 @end group
4354 @end smallexample
4355
4356 @noindent
4357 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4358 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4359 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4360 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4361 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4362 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4363 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4364 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4365 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4366 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4367 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4368 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4369 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4370 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4371 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4372 that matter, with anything else.
4373
4374 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4375 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4376 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4377 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4378 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4379
4380 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4381 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4382 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4383 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4384
4385 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4386 seconds.
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 @group
4390 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4391 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4392 .
4393
4394 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4395 @end group
4396 @end smallexample
4397
4398 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4399 seconds.
4400
4401 @smallexample
4402 @group
4403 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4404 . . . .
4405
4406 0.5 I T c h S
4407 @end group
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 @noindent
4411 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4412 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4413 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4414
4415 @cindex Beatles
4416 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4417 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4418 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4419 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4420 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4421
4422 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4423 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4424 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4425
4426 @smallexample
4427 @group
4428 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4429 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4430 .
4431
4432 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4433 @end group
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 @noindent
4437 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4438 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4439 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4440 date form.
4441
4442 @smallexample
4443 @group
4444 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4445 . .
4446
4447 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4448 @end group
4449 @end smallexample
4450
4451 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4452 @noindent
4453 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4454 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4455 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4456 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4457 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4458 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4459
4460 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4461 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4462
4463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4464 between now and the year 10001 AD@? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4465
4466 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4467 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4468 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4469 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4470 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4471 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4472 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4473 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4474
4475 @smallexample
4476 @group
4477 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4478 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4479 .
4480
4481 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4482 @end group
4483 @end smallexample
4484
4485 @noindent
4486 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4487 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4488 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4489
4490 @cindex Torus, volume of
4491 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4492 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4493 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4494 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4495 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4496 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4497 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4498 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4499
4500 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4501 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4502 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4503 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4504 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 @group
4508 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4509 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4510 .
4511
4512 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4513 @end group
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 @noindent
4517 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4518 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4519
4520 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4521 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4522 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4523 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4524 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4525 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4526 the other.
4527
4528 @smallexample
4529 @group
4530 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4531 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4532 .
4533
4534 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4535 @end group
4536 @end smallexample
4537
4538 @noindent
4539 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4540 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4541 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4542 or both endpoints.
4543
4544 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4545 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4546 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4547 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4548 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4549
4550 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4551 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4552 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4553 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4554 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4555
4556 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4557 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4558 or 24 hours.
4559
4560 @smallexample
4561 @group
4562 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4563 . . . .
4564
4565 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4566 @end group
4567 @end smallexample
4568
4569 @noindent
4570 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4571 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4572 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4573 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4574 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 @group
4578 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4579 . . . .
4580
4581 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4582 @end group
4583 @end smallexample
4584
4585 @noindent
4586 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4587 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4588 that arises in the second one.
4589
4590 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4591 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4592 says that
4593 @texline @math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}
4594 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4595 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4596 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4597 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4598 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4599 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4600 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4601
4602 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4603 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4604 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4605 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4606
4607 @smallexample
4608 @group
4609 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4610 . .
4611
4612 x time @key{RET} n
4613 @end group
4614 @end smallexample
4615
4616 @noindent
4617 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4618
4619 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4620 is about
4621 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4622 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4623 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4624 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4625
4626 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4627 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4628 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4629 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4630 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4631 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4632
4633 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4634 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4635 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4636 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4637 like centimeters and inches.
4638
4639 @smallexample
4640 @group
4641 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4642 . . . .
4643
4644 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4645 @end group
4646 @end smallexample
4647
4648 @noindent
4649 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4650 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4651 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4652 which in this case means meters.
4653
4654 @smallexample
4655 @group
4656 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4657 . . . .
4658
4659 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4660
4661 @end group
4662 @end smallexample
4663 @noindent
4664 @smallexample
4665 @group
4666 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4667 . . .
4668
4669 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4670 @end group
4671 @end smallexample
4672
4673 @noindent
4674 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4675 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4676 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4677 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4678 being interpreted as unit names.
4679
4680 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4681 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4682 as its standard unit of length.
4683
4684 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4685
4686 @smallexample
4687 @group
4688 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4689 . . . .
4690
4691 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4692 @end group
4693 @end smallexample
4694
4695 @noindent
4696 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4697 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4698 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4699
4700 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4701 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4702 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4703 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4704 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4705 for them.
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 @group
4709 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4710 . . . .
4711
4712 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET}
4713 @end group
4714 @end smallexample
4715
4716 @noindent
4717 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4718 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4719 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius.
4720
4721 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4722 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4723 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4724 numbers are in which units:
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 @group
4728 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4729 . . .
4730
4731 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4732 @end group
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4736 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4737 at the units table.
4738
4739 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4740 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4741
4742 @cindex Speed of light
4743 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4744 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4745 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4746 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4747 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4748
4749 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4750 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4751 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4752 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4753 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4754
4755 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4756 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4757
4758 @noindent
4759 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4760 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4761 formulas.
4762
4763 @menu
4764 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4765 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4766 @end menu
4767
4768 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4769 @subsection Basic Algebra
4770
4771 @noindent
4772 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4773 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4774 formulas as regular data objects.
4775
4776 @smallexample
4777 @group
4778 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (3 x^2 + y) (6 - 2 x^2)
4779 . . .
4780
4781 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4782 @end group
4783 @end smallexample
4784
4785 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4786 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4787 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4788
4789 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4790 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4791
4792 @smallexample
4793 @group
4794 1: 18 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y - 2 y x^2 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4795 . .
4796
4797 a x a c x @key{RET}
4798 @end group
4799 @end smallexample
4800
4801 @noindent
4802 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4803 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4804
4805 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4806 is one-half.
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 @group
4810 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4811 . .
4812
4813 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4814 @end group
4815 @end smallexample
4816
4817 @noindent
4818 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4819 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4820 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4821 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4822 back to its original value, if any.
4823
4824 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4825 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4826 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4827 properly.)
4828
4829 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4830 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4831 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4832 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4833 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4834 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4835 the function has a local maximum there.
4836
4837 @smallexample
4838 @group
4839 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4840 . .
4841
4842 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4843 @end group
4844 @end smallexample
4845
4846 @noindent
4847 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4848 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4849
4850 @smallexample
4851 @group
4852 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4853 . .
4854
4855 ' x @key{RET} / a x
4856
4857 @end group
4858 @end smallexample
4859 @noindent
4860 @smallexample
4861 @group
4862 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023
4863 . .
4864
4865 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4866 @end group
4867 @end smallexample
4868
4869 @noindent
4870 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4871
4872 @smallexample
4873 @group
4874 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4875 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4876 . .
4877
4878 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4879 @end group
4880 @end smallexample
4881
4882 @noindent
4883 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4884 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4885 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4886 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4887
4888 @smallexample
4889 @group
4890 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4891 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4892 . .
4893
4894 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4895 @end group
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 @noindent
4899 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4900 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4901 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4902
4903 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4904 @expr{0.70588 x^2 = 1} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4905 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4906 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4907 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4908 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4909 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4910
4911 @smallexample
4912 @group
4913 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4914 . . .
4915
4916 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4917 @end group
4918 @end smallexample
4919
4920 @noindent
4921 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4922 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4923 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4924 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4925 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4926
4927 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4928 into the original formula.
4929
4930 @smallexample
4931 @group
4932 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4933 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4934 .
4935
4936 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4937 @end group
4938 @end smallexample
4939
4940 @noindent
4941 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4942 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4943 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4944
4945 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4946 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4947
4948 @smallexample
4949 @group
4950 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4951 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4952 .
4953
4954 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4955 @end group
4956 @end smallexample
4957
4958 @noindent
4959 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4960 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4961 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4962 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4963 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4964 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4965 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4966 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4967 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4968 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4969
4970 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4971 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4972
4973 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4974 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4975 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4976 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4977 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4978 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4979 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4980 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4981
4982 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4983 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4984 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4985 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4986 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4987 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4988
4989 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
4990 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
4991 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
4992 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
4993
4994 @smallexample
4995 @group
4996 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
4997 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
4998 . .
4999
5000 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5001 @end group
5002 @end smallexample
5003
5004 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5005
5006 @smallexample
5007 @group
5008 3
5009 2: 34 x - 24 x
5010
5011 ____ ____
5012 V 51 V 51
5013 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5014 6 -6
5015
5016 .
5017
5018 d B
5019 @end group
5020 @end smallexample
5021
5022 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5023 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5024 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5025 and @LaTeX{} mode.
5026
5027 @smallexample
5028 @group
5029 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5030 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5031 . .
5032
5033 d C d F
5034
5035 @end group
5036 @end smallexample
5037 @noindent
5038 @smallexample
5039 @group
5040 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5041 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5042 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5043 .
5044
5045 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5046 @end group
5047 @end smallexample
5048
5049 @noindent
5050 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5051 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5052 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5053 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5054
5055 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5056 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5057 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5058 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5059 correct.
5060
5061 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5062 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5063 are shown in normal mode.)
5064
5065 @cindex Area under a curve
5066 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5067 This is simply the integral of the function:
5068
5069 @smallexample
5070 @group
5071 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5072 . .
5073
5074 r 1 a i x
5075 @end group
5076 @end smallexample
5077
5078 @noindent
5079 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5080 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5081
5082 @smallexample
5083 @group
5084 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5085 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5086
5087 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5088 @end group
5089 @end smallexample
5090
5091 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5092 of
5093 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5094 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5095 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5096 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5097 3}. (@bullet{})
5098
5099 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5100 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5101 under the curve
5102 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5103 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5104 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5105 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5106 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5107 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5108
5109 @cindex Integration, numerical
5110 @cindex Numerical integration
5111 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5112 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5113 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5114 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5115
5116 @smallexample
5117 @group
5118 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5119 2: 1 .
5120 1: 0.1
5121 .
5122
5123 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5124 @end group
5125 @end smallexample
5126
5127 @noindent
5128 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5129 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 @group
5133 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5134 1: ln(x) sin(x) .
5135 .
5136
5137 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5138
5139 @end group
5140 @end smallexample
5141 @noindent
5142 @smallexample
5143 @group
5144 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5145 . .
5146
5147 V R + 0.1 *
5148 @end group
5149 @end smallexample
5150
5151 @noindent
5152 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5153 to Radians mode?)
5154
5155 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5156 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5157 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5158 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5159 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5160 is the same for every box.)
5161
5162 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5163 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5164
5165 @smallexample
5166 @group
5167 1: ln(x) sin(x) 1: 0.84147 x + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5168 . .
5169
5170 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5171 @end group
5172 @end smallexample
5173
5174 @noindent
5175 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5176 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5177 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5178
5179 @smallexample
5180 @group
5181 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5182 . . .
5183
5184 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5185 @end group
5186 @end smallexample
5187
5188 @noindent
5189 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5190 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5191 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5192 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5193 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5194 of @expr{x=1}.)
5195
5196 @cindex Simpson's rule
5197 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5198 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5199 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5200 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5201 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5202 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5203 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5204 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5205 down to the formula,
5206
5207 @ifnottex
5208 @example
5209 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5210 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5211 @end example
5212 @end ifnottex
5213 @tex
5214 \beforedisplay
5215 $$ \displaylines{
5216 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5217 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5218 } $$
5219 \afterdisplay
5220 @end tex
5221
5222 @noindent
5223 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5224 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5225 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5226 method:
5227
5228 @ifnottex
5229 @example
5230 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5231 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5232 @end example
5233 @end ifnottex
5234 @tex
5235 \beforedisplay
5236 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5237 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5238 \afterdisplay
5239 @end tex
5240
5241 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5242 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5243 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5244 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5245 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5246
5247 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5248 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5249 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5250 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5251
5252 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5253 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5254 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5255 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5256 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5257 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5258 details and examples.
5259
5260 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5261 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5262
5263 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5264 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5268 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5269 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5270 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5271
5272 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5273
5274 @smallexample
5275 @group
5276 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2
5277 .
5278
5279 ' 2sec(x)^2/tan(x)^2 - 2/tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s 1
5280 @end group
5281 @end smallexample
5282
5283 @noindent
5284 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably combine over the common
5285 denominator. The @kbd{a n} algebra command will do this, but we'll do
5286 it with a rewrite rule just for practice.
5287
5288 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5289
5290 @smallexample
5291 @group
5292 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2
5293 .
5294
5295 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5296 @end group
5297 @end smallexample
5298
5299 @noindent
5300 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5301 by itself the formula @samp{a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x} doesn't do anything,
5302 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5303 it as a rewrite rule.)
5304
5305 The lefthand side, @samp{a/x + b/x}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5306 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5307 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5308 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5309 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5310 the expression @samp{2 sec(x)^2}, the meta-variable @samp{b} matched
5311 the constant @samp{-2} and the meta-variable @samp{x} matched
5312 the expression @samp{tan(x)^2}.
5313
5314 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5315 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5316 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5317 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5318 denominators.
5319
5320 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5321 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5322 the subformula @samp{tan(x)^2}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5323 @samp{x}.
5324
5325 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5326 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5327 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5328 @samp{a = 2 sec(x)^2}, @samp{b = -2}, and @samp{x = tan(x)^2}.
5329
5330 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5331 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5332 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5333 @samp{(2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2}.
5334
5335 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5336 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5337 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5338 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5339 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5340 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5341
5342 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5343 @samp{tan(x)^2 + 1 = sec(x)^2}, but of course we must first rearrange
5344 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5345 would be @samp{@w{2 sec(x)^2 - 2} := 2 tan(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5346 that the rule @samp{sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2} will also work. The
5347 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5348 situations, too.
5349
5350 @smallexample
5351 @group
5352 1: 2
5353 .
5354
5355 a r sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET}
5356 @end group
5357 @end smallexample
5358
5359 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5360 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5361 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5362 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5363 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5364 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5365 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5366 having to retype it.
5367
5368 @smallexample
5369 @group
5370 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5371 ' sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s t secsqr @key{RET}
5372
5373 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5374 . .
5375
5376 r 1 a r merge @key{RET} a r secsqr @key{RET}
5377 @end group
5378 @end smallexample
5379
5380 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5381 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5382 the edited value back into the variable.
5383 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5384
5385 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5386 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5387 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5388 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5389 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5390 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5391 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5392 entering them on the fly.
5393
5394 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5395 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5396 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5397 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5398 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5399 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5400
5401 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5402 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5403
5404 @smallexample
5405 @group
5406 1: [merge, secsqr] 1: [a/x + b/x := (a + b)/x, ... ]
5407 . .
5408
5409 ' [merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5410
5411 @end group
5412 @end smallexample
5413 @noindent
5414 @smallexample
5415 @group
5416 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5417 . .
5418
5419 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET}
5420 @end group
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5424 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5425 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5426 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5427 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5428 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5429
5430 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5431 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5432 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5433 only one rewrite at a time.
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 @group
5437 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5438 . .
5439
5440 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5441 @end group
5442 @end smallexample
5443
5444 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5445 of rewrites that occur.
5446
5447 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5448 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5449
5450 @smallexample
5451 @group
5452 1: sin(x + 2 pi) + sin(x + 3 pi) + sin(x + 4 pi)
5453 .
5454
5455 ' sin(x+2pi) + sin(x+3pi) + sin(x+4pi) @key{RET}
5456
5457 @end group
5458 @end smallexample
5459 @noindent
5460 @smallexample
5461 @group
5462 1: sin(x + 3 pi) + 2 sin(x)
5463 .
5464
5465 a r sin(a + k pi) := sin(a) :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5466 @end group
5467 @end smallexample
5468
5469 @noindent
5470 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5471 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5472
5473 An interesting point is that the variable @samp{pi} was matched
5474 literally rather than acting as a meta-variable.
5475 This is because it is a special-constant variable. The special
5476 constants @samp{e}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5477 A common error with rewrite
5478 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5479 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5480 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5481
5482 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5483 @ignore
5484 @starindex
5485 @end ignore
5486 @tindex fib
5487 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5488 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5489 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5490 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5491 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5492
5493 @smallexample
5494 @group
5495 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5496
5497 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5498 . .
5499
5500 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5501 @end group
5502 @end smallexample
5503
5504 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5505 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5506 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5507 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5508 be used preferentially.
5509
5510 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5511 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5512 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5513 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5514 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5515 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5516 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5517
5518 @smallexample
5519 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5520 @end smallexample
5521
5522 @noindent
5523 Now:
5524
5525 @smallexample
5526 @group
5527 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: fib(x) + fib(0) + 8
5528 . .
5529
5530 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5531 @end group
5532 @end smallexample
5533
5534 @noindent
5535 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5536 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5537 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5538 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5539 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5540
5541 @smallexample
5542 @group
5543 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5544 . .
5545
5546 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5547 @end group
5548 @end smallexample
5549
5550 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5551 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5552 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5553
5554 @smallexample
5555 @group
5556 fib(6) =
5557 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5558 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5559 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5560 @end group
5561 @end smallexample
5562
5563 @noindent
5564 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5565 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5566 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5567 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5568 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5569 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5570
5571 @smallexample
5572 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5573 @end smallexample
5574
5575 @noindent
5576 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5577 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5578 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5579 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5580 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5581 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5582
5583 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5584 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5585
5586 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5587 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5588 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5589 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5590 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5591
5592 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5593 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5594 un-store the variable.
5595
5596 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5597 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5598 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5599 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5600 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5601 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5602 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5603 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5604 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5605
5606 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5607 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5608 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5609 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5610
5611 @example
5612 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5613 @end example
5614
5615 @noindent
5616 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5617 to 1.''
5618
5619 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5620 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5621 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5622 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5623 and one for @samp{b}.
5624
5625 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5626 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5627 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5628 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5629
5630 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5631 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5632 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5633 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5634 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5635 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5636 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5637 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5638 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5639 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5640 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5641 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5642 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5643 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5644
5645 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5646 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5647 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5648 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5649 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5650 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5651
5652 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5653 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5654 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5655
5656 @ifnottex
5657 @example
5658 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5659 @end example
5660 @end ifnottex
5661 @tex
5662 \beforedisplay
5663 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5664 \afterdisplay
5665 @end tex
5666
5667 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5668 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5669 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5670 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5671 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5672
5673 @ifnottex
5674 @example
5675 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5676 @end example
5677 @end ifnottex
5678 @tex
5679 \beforedisplay
5680 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5681 \afterdisplay
5682 @end tex
5683
5684 @noindent
5685 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5686 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5687
5688 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5689 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5690 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5691 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5692 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5693 rearranged. (This one is rather tricky; the solution at the end of
5694 this chapter uses 6 rewrite rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)}
5695 condition tests whether @samp{x} is a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer
5696 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5697
5698 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5699 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5700 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5701
5702 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5703
5704 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5705 @section Programming Tutorial
5706
5707 @noindent
5708 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5709 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5710 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5711 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5712 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5713 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5714
5715 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5716 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5717 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5718 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5719 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 @group
5723 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1
5724 . .
5725
5726 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5727 @end group
5728 @end smallexample
5729
5730 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5731 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5732 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5733 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5734 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5735 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5736 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5737 arguments?''
5738
5739 @smallexample
5740 @group
5741 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5742 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5743 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5744 .
5745
5746 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5747 @end group
5748 @end smallexample
5749
5750 @noindent
5751 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5752 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5753 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5754 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5755 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5756 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5757 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5758
5759 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5760 @ignore
5761 @starindex
5762 @end ignore
5763 @tindex Si
5764 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5765 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5766 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5767 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5768 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5769 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5770 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5771 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5772 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5773 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5774 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5775 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5776 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5777 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5778 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5779 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5780
5781 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5782 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5783 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5784 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5785 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5786
5787 @smallexample
5788 @group
5789 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5790 . .
5791
5792 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5793
5794 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 n1 pi
5795 . .
5796
5797 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5798 @end group
5799 @end smallexample
5800
5801 @noindent
5802 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5803 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5804 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5805 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5806 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5807
5808 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5809
5810 @smallexample
5811 @group
5812 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5813 . .
5814
5815 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5816 @end group
5817 @end smallexample
5818
5819 @noindent
5820 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5821 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5822
5823 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 @group
5827 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5828 . . . .
5829
5830 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5831 @end group
5832 @end smallexample
5833
5834 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5835 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5836 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5837
5838 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5839 the following functions:
5840
5841 @enumerate
5842 @item
5843 Compute
5844 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5845 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5846 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5847
5848 @item
5849 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5850 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5851
5852 @item
5853 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5854 the stack.
5855 @end enumerate
5856 @noindent
5857 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5858
5859 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5860 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5861 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5862
5863 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5864 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5865 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5866
5867 @smallexample
5868 @group
5869 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5870 . 1: 4 .
5871 .
5872
5873 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5874 @end group
5875 @end smallexample
5876
5877 @noindent
5878 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5879 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5880 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5881 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5882
5883 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5884 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5885
5886 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5887 Here's another example:
5888
5889 @smallexample
5890 @group
5891 3: 1 2: 10946
5892 2: 1 1: 17711
5893 1: 20 .
5894 .
5895
5896 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5897 @end group
5898 @end smallexample
5899
5900 @noindent
5901 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5902 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5903 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5904 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5905
5906 @cindex Golden ratio
5907 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5908 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5909 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5910 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5911 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5912 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5913 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5914 @infoline @expr{phi},
5915 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5916 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5917 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5918 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5919 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5920
5921 @smallexample
5922 @group
5923 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5924 . . . .
5925
5926 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5927 @end group
5928 @end smallexample
5929
5930 @cindex Continued fractions
5931 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5932 representation of
5933 @texline @math{\phi}
5934 @infoline @expr{phi}
5935 is
5936 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5937 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5938 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5939 and then replacing the innermost
5940 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5941 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5942 by 1. Approximate
5943 @texline @math{\phi}
5944 @infoline @expr{phi}
5945 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5946 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5947
5948 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5949 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5950 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5951 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5952 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5953 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5954 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5955
5956 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5957 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5958 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5959 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5960
5961 @smallexample
5962 @group
5963 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5964 2: 1 .
5965 1: 20
5966 .
5967
5968 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5969 @end group
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 @noindent
5973 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
5974 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
5975 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
5976 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
5977 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
5978 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
5979 uses a step of one.
5980
5981 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
5982 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
5983 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
5984
5985 @smallexample
5986 @group
5987 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
5988 . 1: 20 .
5989 .
5990
5991 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
5992 @end group
5993 @end smallexample
5994
5995 @noindent
5996 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
5997 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
5998
5999 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6000 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6001 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6002 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6003 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6004 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6005 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6006
6007 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6008 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6009 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6010
6011 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6012 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6013 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6014 fix, though:
6015
6016 @smallexample
6017 @group
6018 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6019 . . 2: 3.597739
6020 1: 0.6667
6021 .
6022
6023 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6024 @end group
6025 @end smallexample
6026
6027 @noindent
6028 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6029 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6030 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6031 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6032 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6033 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6034 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6035 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6036 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6037
6038 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6039 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6040 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6041 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6042 by the formula
6043 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6044 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6045 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6046 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6047 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6048 numbers are very large fractions.)
6049
6050 @smallexample
6051 @group
6052 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6053 . .
6054
6055 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6056 @end group
6057 @end smallexample
6058
6059 @noindent
6060 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6061 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6062 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6063 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6064 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6065 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6066 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6067
6068 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 @group
6072 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6073 2: 5:66 . . . .
6074 1: 0.0757575
6075 .
6076
6077 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6078 @end group
6079 @end smallexample
6080
6081 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6082 Bernoulli numbers.
6083
6084 @smallexample
6085 @group
6086 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6087 2: 2 .
6088 1: 30
6089 .
6090
6091 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6092 @end group
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 @noindent
6096 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6097 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6098 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6099 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6100 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6101 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6102 sequence of keystrokes.)
6103
6104 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6105 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6106 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6107 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6108 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6109
6110 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6111 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6112 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6113 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6118 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6119
6120 1 ;; calc digits
6121 RET ;; calc-enter
6122 2 ;; calc digits
6123 + ;; calc-plus
6124
6125 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6126 @end group
6127 @end smallexample
6128
6129 @noindent
6130 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6131 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6132 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6133 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6134 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6135 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6136 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6137 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6138 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6139 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6140
6141 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6142 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6143 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6144 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6145 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6146
6147 @smallexample
6148 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6149 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6150 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6151 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6152 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6153 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6154 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6155 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6156 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6157 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6158 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6159 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6160 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6161 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6162 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 @noindent
6166 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6167
6168 @smallexample
6169 @group
6170 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6171 . .
6172
6173 20 z h
6174 @end group
6175 @end smallexample
6176
6177 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6178 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6179 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6180 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6181 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6182 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6183 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6184
6185 @example
6186 @group
6187 Z ` 0 t 1
6188 1 TAB
6189 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6190 r 1
6191 Z '
6192 @end group
6193 @end example
6194
6195 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6196 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6197 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6198 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6199 this formula over and over:
6200
6201 @ifnottex
6202 @example
6203 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6204 @end example
6205 @end ifnottex
6206 @tex
6207 \beforedisplay
6208 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f^{\prime}(x)} $$
6209 \afterdisplay
6210 @end tex
6211
6212 @noindent
6213 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6214 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6215 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6216 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6217 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6218 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6219 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6220 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6221 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6222 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6223 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6224 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6225 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6226 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6227
6228 @cindex Digamma function
6229 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6230 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6231 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6232 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6233 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6234 is defined as the derivative of
6235 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6236 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6237 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6238
6239 @ifnottex
6240 @example
6241 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6242 @end example
6243 @end ifnottex
6244 @tex
6245 \beforedisplay
6246 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6247 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6248 $$
6249 \afterdisplay
6250 @end tex
6251
6252 @noindent
6253 where
6254 @texline @math{\sum}
6255 @infoline @expr{sum}
6256 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6257 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6258 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6259 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6260 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6261 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6262 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6263 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6264 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6265 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6266 Fortunately, we can compute
6267 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6268 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6269 from
6270 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6271 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6272 using the recurrence
6273 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6274 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6275 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6276 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6277 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6278 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6279 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6280 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6281 to compute
6282 @texline @math{\gamma}
6283 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6284 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6285 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6286 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6287
6288 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6289 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6290 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6291 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6292 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6293 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6294 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6295 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6296 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6297
6298 @cindex Recursion
6299 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6300 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6301
6302 @ifnottex
6303 @example
6304 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6305 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6306 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6307 @end example
6308 @end ifnottex
6309 @tex
6310 \beforedisplay
6311 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6312 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6313 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6314 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6315 $$
6316 \afterdisplay
6317 \vskip5pt
6318 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6319 @end tex
6320
6321 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6322 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6323 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6324 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6325 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6326 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6327 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6328 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6329 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6330 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6331 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6332 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6333 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6334 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6335 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6336 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6337 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6338 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6339
6340 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6341 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6342 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6343 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6344 program can:
6345
6346 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6347 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6348 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6349 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6350
6351 @example
6352
6353 @end example
6354 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6355 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6356 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6357 @c [not-split]
6358 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6359 @c [when-split]
6360 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6361
6362 @page
6363 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6364 @section Answers to Exercises
6365
6366 @noindent
6367 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6368
6369 @menu
6370 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6371 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6372 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6373 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6374 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6375 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6376 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6377 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6378 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6379 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6380 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6381 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6382 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6383 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6384 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6385 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6386 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6387 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6388 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6389 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6390 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6391 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6392 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6393 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6394 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6395 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6396 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6397 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6398 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6399 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6400 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6401 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6402 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6403 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6404 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6405 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6406 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6407 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6408 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6409 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6410 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6411 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6412 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6413 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6414 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6415 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6416 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6417 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6418 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6419 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6420 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6421 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6422 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6423 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6424 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6425 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6426 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6427 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6428 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6429 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6430 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6431 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6432 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6433 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6434 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6435 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6436 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6437 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6438 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6439 @end menu
6440
6441 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6442 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6443 @tex
6444 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6445 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6446 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6447 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6448 @end tex
6449
6450 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6451 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6452
6453 @noindent
6454 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6455
6456 The result is
6457 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6458 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6459
6460 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6461 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6462
6463 @noindent
6464 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6465 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6466
6467 After computing the intermediate term
6468 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6469 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6470 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6471 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6472 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6473
6474 @smallexample
6475 @group
6476 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6477 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6478 . 1: 9.5 .
6479 .
6480
6481 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6482
6483 @end group
6484 @end smallexample
6485 @noindent
6486 @smallexample
6487 @group
6488 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6489 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6490 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6491 1: 4 .
6492 .
6493
6494 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6495 @end group
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6499 with the third term.
6500
6501 @smallexample
6502 @group
6503 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6504 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6505 . 1: 4 .
6506 .
6507
6508 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6509 @end group
6510 @end smallexample
6511
6512 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6513 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6514 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6515 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6516
6517 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6518 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6519
6520 @noindent
6521 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6522
6523 @smallexample
6524 @group
6525 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6526 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6527 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6528 . . 1: 1 . .
6529 .
6530
6531 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6532 @end group
6533 @end smallexample
6534
6535 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6536
6537 @smallexample
6538 @group
6539 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6540 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6541 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6542 . . . . .
6543
6544 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6545 @end group
6546 @end smallexample
6547
6548 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6549 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6550
6551 @noindent
6552 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6553 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6554
6555 @smallexample
6556 @group
6557 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6558 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6559 . . .
6560
6561 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6562 @end group
6563 @end smallexample
6564
6565 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6566 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6567 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6568 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6569 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6570
6571 @smallexample
6572 @group
6573 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6574 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6575 . . .
6576
6577 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6578 @end group
6579 @end smallexample
6580
6581 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6582 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6583 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6584 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6585
6586 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6587 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6588
6589 @noindent
6590 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6591
6592 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6593 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6594
6595 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6596 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6597 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6598
6599 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6600 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6601
6602 @noindent
6603 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6604 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6605 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6606 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6607
6608 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6609 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6610
6611 @noindent
6612 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6613 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6614 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6615 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6616 times anything is zero.''
6617
6618 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6619 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6620 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6621 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6622 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6623 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6624
6625 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6626 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6627
6628 @noindent
6629 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6630 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6631 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6632 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6633 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6634 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6635
6636 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6637 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6638 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6639 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6640 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6641 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6642 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6643 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6644 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6645 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6646 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6647
6648 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6649 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6650 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6651 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6652 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6653 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6654 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6655 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6656 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6657 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6658
6659 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6660 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6661 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6662 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6663 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6664 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6665 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6666 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6667 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6668 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6669
6670 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6671 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6672 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6673 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6674 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6675 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6676 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6677 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6678 in decimal display mode.
6679
6680 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6681 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6682 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6683 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6684
6685 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6686 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6687
6688 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6689 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6690 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6691 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6692 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6693 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6694 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6695 way to enter this number.
6696
6697 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6698 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6699 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6700 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6701 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6702 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6703 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6704
6705 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6706 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6707
6708 @noindent
6709 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6710
6711 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6712 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6713 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6714 their inputs.
6715
6716 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6717 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6718 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6719 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6720 determining facts like this.
6721
6722 @smallexample
6723 @group
6724 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6725 . .
6726
6727 45 S 2 ^
6728
6729 @end group
6730 @end smallexample
6731 @noindent
6732 @smallexample
6733 @group
6734 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6735 . . .
6736
6737 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6738 @end group
6739 @end smallexample
6740
6741 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6742 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6743 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6744 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6745 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6746
6747 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6748 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6749
6750 @noindent
6751 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6752 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6753 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6754 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6755 of time.
6756
6757 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6758 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6759 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6760 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6761 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6762 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6763
6764 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6765 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6766 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6767
6768 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6769 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6770
6771 @noindent
6772 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6773 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6774 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6775 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6776 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6777 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6778 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6779 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6780
6781 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6782 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6783 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6784 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6785 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6786 format.
6787
6788 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6789 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6790
6791 @noindent
6792 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6793 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6794
6795 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6796 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6797 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6798 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6799
6800 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6801 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6802
6803 @noindent
6804 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6805 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6806
6807 @smallexample
6808 @group
6809 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6810 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6811 .
6812
6813 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6814 @end group
6815 @end smallexample
6816
6817 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6818 indeed have unit length.
6819
6820 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6821 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6822
6823 @noindent
6824 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6825 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6826 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6827 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6828
6829 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6830 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6831
6832 @noindent
6833 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6834 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6835
6836 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6837 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6838
6839 @ifnottex
6840 @example
6841 @group
6842 x + a y = 6
6843 x + b y = 10
6844 @end group
6845 @end example
6846 @end ifnottex
6847 @tex
6848 \beforedisplay
6849 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6850 x &+ b y = 10}
6851 $$
6852 \afterdisplay
6853 @end tex
6854
6855 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6856 matrix as usual.
6857
6858 @smallexample
6859 @group
6860 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [4 a / (a - b) + 6, 4 / (b - a) ]
6861 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6862 [ 1, b ] ]
6863 .
6864
6865 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6866 @end group
6867 @end smallexample
6868
6869 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6870 mode:
6871
6872 @smallexample
6873 @group
6874 4 a 4
6875 1: [----- + 6, -----]
6876 a - b b - a
6877 @end group
6878 @end smallexample
6879
6880 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6881
6882 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6883 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6884
6885 @noindent
6886 To solve
6887 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6888 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6889 first we compute
6890 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6891 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6892 and
6893 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6894 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6895 now, we have a system
6896 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6897 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6898 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6899
6900 @ifnottex
6901 @example
6902 @group
6903 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6904 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6905 7a + 6b = 3
6906 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6907 @end group
6908 @end example
6909 @end ifnottex
6910 @tex
6911 \beforedisplayh
6912 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6913 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6914 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6915 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6916 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6917 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6918 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6919 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6920 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6921 $$
6922 \afterdisplayh
6923 @end tex
6924
6925 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6926 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6927 @texline @math{B'}
6928 @infoline @expr{B2}
6929 vector.
6930
6931 @smallexample
6932 @group
6933 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6934 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6935 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6936 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6937 . .
6938
6939 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6940 @end group
6941 @end smallexample
6942
6943 @noindent
6944 Now we compute the matrix
6945 @texline @math{A'}
6946 @infoline @expr{A2}
6947 and divide.
6948
6949 @smallexample
6950 @group
6951 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6952 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6953 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6954 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6955 .
6956
6957 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6958 @end group
6959 @end smallexample
6960
6961 @noindent
6962 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6963 round-off error.)
6964
6965 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6966 @texline @math{3\times3}
6967 @infoline 3x3
6968 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
6969 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
6970 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
6971 answer since the
6972 @texline @math{4\times3}
6973 @infoline 4x3
6974 system would be equivalent to the original
6975 @texline @math{3\times3}
6976 @infoline 3x3
6977 system.)
6978
6979 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
6980 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
6981 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
6982
6983 @smallexample
6984 @group
6985 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
6986 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
6987 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
6988 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
6989 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
6990 .
6991
6992 r 7 @key{TAB} *
6993 @end group
6994 @end smallexample
6995
6996 @noindent
6997 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
6998 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
6999
7000 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7001 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7002
7003 @noindent
7004 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7005 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7006 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7007 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7008
7009 @smallexample
7010 @group
7011 2: 2 2: 2
7012 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7013 . .
7014
7015 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7016 @end group
7017 @end smallexample
7018
7019 @noindent
7020 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7021 vector.
7022
7023 @smallexample
7024 @group
7025 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7026 .
7027
7028 V M ^
7029 @end group
7030 @end smallexample
7031
7032 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7033 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7034
7035 @noindent
7036 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7037 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7038
7039 @ifnottex
7040 @example
7041 m*x + b*1 = y
7042 @end example
7043 @end ifnottex
7044 @tex
7045 \beforedisplay
7046 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7047 \afterdisplay
7048 @end tex
7049
7050 Thus we want a
7051 @texline @math{19\times2}
7052 @infoline 19x2
7053 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7054 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7055 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 @group
7059 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7060 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7061 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7062 @dots{}
7063
7064 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7065 @end group
7066 @end smallexample
7067
7068 @noindent
7069 Now we compute
7070 @texline @math{A^T y}
7071 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7072 and
7073 @texline @math{A^T A}
7074 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7075 and divide.
7076
7077 @smallexample
7078 @group
7079 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7080 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7081 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7082 .
7083
7084 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7085 @end group
7086 @end smallexample
7087
7088 @noindent
7089 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7090
7091 @smallexample
7092 @group
7093 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7094 .
7095
7096 /
7097 @end group
7098 @end smallexample
7099
7100 Since we were solving equations of the form
7101 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7102 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7103 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7104 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7105 @kbd{V R}!
7106
7107 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7108 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7109 arithmetic functions!
7110
7111 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7112 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7113 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7114
7115 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7116 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7117
7118 @noindent
7119 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7120 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7121 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7122
7123 @smallexample
7124 @group
7125 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7126 .
7127 @end group
7128 @end smallexample
7129
7130 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7131 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7132
7133 @smallexample
7134 @group
7135 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7136 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7137 . .
7138
7139 @key{RET} V R *
7140
7141 @end group
7142 @end smallexample
7143 @noindent
7144 @smallexample
7145 @group
7146 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7147 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7148 . .
7149
7150 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7151 @end group
7152 @end smallexample
7153
7154 @noindent
7155 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7156 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7157 then raise the number to that power.)
7158
7159 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7160 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7161
7162 @noindent
7163 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7164 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7165 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7166 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7167
7168 @smallexample
7169 @group
7170 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7171 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7172 . .
7173
7174 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7175 @end group
7176 @end smallexample
7177
7178 @noindent
7179 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7180
7181 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7182 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7183
7184 @smallexample
7185 @group
7186 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7187 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7188 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7189 .
7190
7191 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7192 @end group
7193 @end smallexample
7194
7195 @noindent
7196 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7197 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7198
7199 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7200 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7201
7202 @noindent
7203 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7204 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7205 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7206 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7207
7208 @smallexample
7209 @group
7210 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7211 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7212 . .
7213
7214 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7215
7216 @end group
7217 @end smallexample
7218 @noindent
7219 @smallexample
7220 @group
7221 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7222 . . .
7223
7224 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7225 @end group
7226 @end smallexample
7227
7228 @noindent
7229 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7230 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7231 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7232 the job is pretty straightforward.
7233
7234 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7235 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7236 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7237 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7238 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7239
7240 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7241 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7242
7243 @noindent
7244 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7245 to get a list of lists of integers!
7246
7247 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7248 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7249
7250 @noindent
7251 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7252 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7253
7254 @smallexample
7255 @group
7256 1: [ [0],
7257 [0, 1],
7258 [0, 1, 2],
7259 @dots{}
7260
7261 1 -
7262 @end group
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7266 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7267 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7268 can be computed directly by the formula
7269 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7270 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7271
7272 @smallexample
7273 @group
7274 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7275 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7276 . .
7277
7278 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7279 @end group
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7284 result:
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 @group
7288 1: [ [0],
7289 [1, 2],
7290 [3, 4, 5],
7291 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7292 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7293 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7294 .
7295
7296 V M +
7297 @end group
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7301 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7302 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7303 triangular list.
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 @group
7307 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7308 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7309 . .
7310
7311 @key{RET} V M V R +
7312 @end group
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 @noindent
7316 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7317 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7318 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7319
7320 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7321 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7322
7323 @noindent
7324 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7325
7326 @smallexample
7327 @group
7328 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7329 . . .
7330
7331 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7332 @end group
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7336
7337 @smallexample
7338 @group
7339 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7340 .
7341
7342 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7343 @end group
7344 @end smallexample
7345
7346 @noindent
7347 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7348
7349 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7350 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7351
7352 @smallexample
7353 @group
7354 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7355 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7356 . .
7357
7358 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7359 @end group
7360 @end smallexample
7361
7362 @noindent
7363 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7364 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7365 @texline @math{\sin x}
7366 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7367 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7368
7369 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7370 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7371 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7372
7373 @smallexample
7374 @group
7375 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7376 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7377 .
7378
7379 r 1 V M * V R +
7380 @end group
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7384 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7385 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7386 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7387 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7388 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7389
7390 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7391 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7392 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7393
7394 @smallexample
7395 @group
7396 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7397 1: [0 .. 5] .
7398 .
7399
7400 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7401 @end group
7402 @end smallexample
7403
7404 @noindent
7405 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7406 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7407 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7408
7409 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7410 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7411
7412 @noindent
7413 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7414
7415 @smallexample
7416 @group
7417 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7418 . 2: 10
7419 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7420 .
7421
7422 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7423
7424 @end group
7425 @end smallexample
7426 @noindent
7427 @smallexample
7428 @group
7429 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7430 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7431 .
7432
7433 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7434 @end group
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 @noindent
7438 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7439
7440 @smallexample
7441 @group
7442 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7443 .
7444
7445 10 V M % s 2
7446 @end group
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7450 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7451 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7452 the right of it are nines.
7453
7454 @smallexample
7455 @group
7456 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7457 . .
7458
7459 9 V M a = v v
7460
7461 @end group
7462 @end smallexample
7463 @noindent
7464 @smallexample
7465 @group
7466 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7467 . .
7468
7469 V U * v v 1 |
7470 @end group
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 @noindent
7474 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7475 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7476 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7477 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7478 rightmost digit.
7479
7480 @smallexample
7481 @group
7482 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7483 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7484 .
7485
7486 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7487 @end group
7488 @end smallexample
7489
7490 @noindent
7491 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7492 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7493 digits that generated them.
7494
7495 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7496
7497 @smallexample
7498 @group
7499 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7500 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7501 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7502 .
7503
7504 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7505
7506 @end group
7507 @end smallexample
7508 @noindent
7509 @smallexample
7510 @group
7511 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7512 . .
7513
7514 V M * V R +
7515 @end group
7516 @end smallexample
7517
7518 @noindent
7519 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7520 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7521
7522 @smallexample
7523 @group
7524 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7525 . .
7526
7527 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7528 @end group
7529 @end smallexample
7530
7531 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7532 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7536 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7537 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7538 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7539
7540 Here's a more correct method:
7541
7542 @smallexample
7543 @group
7544 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7545 . 1: 7
7546 .
7547
7548 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7549
7550 @end group
7551 @end smallexample
7552 @noindent
7553 @smallexample
7554 @group
7555 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7556 . .
7557
7558 V M a = V R *
7559 @end group
7560 @end smallexample
7561
7562 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7563 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7564
7565 @noindent
7566 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7567 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7568 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7569
7570 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7571 commands.
7572
7573 @smallexample
7574 @group
7575 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7576 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7577 . .
7578
7579 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7580
7581 @end group
7582 @end smallexample
7583 @noindent
7584 @smallexample
7585 @group
7586 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7587 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7588 . .
7589
7590 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7591 @end group
7592 @end smallexample
7593
7594 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7595 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7596
7597 @smallexample
7598 @group
7599 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7600 . . .
7601
7602 + 1 V M a < V R +
7603 @end group
7604 @end smallexample
7605
7606 @noindent
7607 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7608
7609 @smallexample
7610 @group
7611 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7612 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7613
7614 100 / 4 * P /
7615 @end group
7616 @end smallexample
7617
7618 @noindent
7619 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7620 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7621 not very efficient!
7622
7623 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7624 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7625
7626 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7627 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7628
7629 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7630 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7631
7632 @noindent
7633 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7634 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7635 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7636 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7637 @texline @math{\theta},
7638 @infoline @expr{theta},
7639 and see if @expr{x} and
7640 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7641 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7642 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7643 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7644 numbers surround an integer.
7645
7646 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7647 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7648 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7649 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7650 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7651
7652 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7653 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7654 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7655 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7656 Pick random @expr{x} and
7657 @texline @math{\theta},
7658 @infoline @expr{theta},
7659 compute
7660 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7661 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7662 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7663
7664 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7665 commands.
7666
7667 @smallexample
7668 @group
7669 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7670 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7671 .
7672
7673 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7674 @end group
7675 @end smallexample
7676
7677 @noindent
7678 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7679
7680 @smallexample
7681 @group
7682 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7683 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7684 .
7685
7686 m d V M C +
7687
7688 @end group
7689 @end smallexample
7690 @noindent
7691 @smallexample
7692 @group
7693 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7694 . . .
7695
7696 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7697 @end group
7698 @end smallexample
7699
7700 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7701 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7702 a random integer.
7703
7704 @smallexample
7705 @group
7706 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7707 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7708 . .
7709
7710 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7711
7712 @end group
7713 @end smallexample
7714 @noindent
7715 @smallexample
7716 @group
7717 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7718 . . .
7719
7720 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7721
7722 @end group
7723 @end smallexample
7724 @noindent
7725 @smallexample
7726 @group
7727 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7728 . .
7729
7730 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7731 @end group
7732 @end smallexample
7733
7734 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7735 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7736
7737 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7738 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7739
7740 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7741 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7742
7743 @noindent
7744 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7745
7746 @smallexample
7747 @group
7748 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7749 .
7750
7751 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7752 @end group
7753 @end smallexample
7754
7755 @noindent
7756 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7757 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7758 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7759 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7760
7761 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7762 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7763 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7764 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7765
7766 @smallexample
7767 @group
7768 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7769 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7770 . .
7771
7772 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7773
7774 @end group
7775 @end smallexample
7776 @noindent
7777 @smallexample
7778 @group
7779 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7780 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7781 .
7782
7783 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7784 @end group
7785 @end smallexample
7786
7787 @noindent
7788 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7789 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7790 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7791 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7792 plus its second argument.
7793
7794 @smallexample
7795 @group
7796 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7797 . .
7798
7799 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7800 @end group
7801 @end smallexample
7802
7803 @noindent
7804 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7805 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7806 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7807
7808 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7809 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7810 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7811 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7812 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7813 the operations are faster.
7814
7815 @smallexample
7816 @group
7817 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7818 . .
7819
7820 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7821 @end group
7822 @end smallexample
7823
7824 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7825 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7826 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7827 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7828
7829 @ifnottex
7830 @example
7831 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7832 @end example
7833 @end ifnottex
7834 @tex
7835 \beforedisplay
7836 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7837 \afterdisplay
7838 @end tex
7839
7840 @noindent
7841 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7842 the distributive law yields
7843
7844 @ifnottex
7845 @example
7846 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7847 @end example
7848 @end ifnottex
7849 @tex
7850 \beforedisplay
7851 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7852 \afterdisplay
7853 @end tex
7854
7855 @noindent
7856 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7857 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7858 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7859 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7860
7861 @ifnottex
7862 @example
7863 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7864 @end example
7865 @end ifnottex
7866 @tex
7867 \beforedisplay
7868 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n^{\prime} $$
7869 \afterdisplay
7870 @end tex
7871
7872 @noindent
7873 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7874 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7875
7876 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7877 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7878 modulo some value @var{m}.
7879
7880 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7881 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7882
7883 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7884 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7885 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7886
7887 @smallexample
7888 @group
7889 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7890 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7891 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7892 ...
7893
7894 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7895 @end group
7896 @end smallexample
7897
7898 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7899 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7900 before nesting even begins.
7901
7902 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7903 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7904 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7905
7906 @smallexample
7907 @group
7908 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7909 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7910 .
7911
7912 v t v u g f
7913 @end group
7914 @end smallexample
7915
7916 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7917 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7918 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7919
7920 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7921 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7922 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7923 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 @group
7927 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7928 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7929 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7930 ...
7931
7932 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7933 @end group
7934 @end smallexample
7935
7936 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7937
7938 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7939 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7940 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7941 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7942 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7943 Schwartz.)
7944
7945 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7946 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7947
7948 @noindent
7949 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7950 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7951
7952 @smallexample
7953 @group
7954 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7955 . . .
7956
7957 2 ^ P / c F
7958 @end group
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7963 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
7964 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
7965 irrational number to within 12 digits.
7966
7967 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
7968 precision slightly and try again:
7969
7970 @smallexample
7971 @group
7972 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
7973 . .
7974
7975 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
7976 @end group
7977 @end smallexample
7978
7979 @noindent
7980 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
7981 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
7982 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
7983 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
7984
7985 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
7986 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
7987 to the current precision before they begin.
7988
7989 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7990 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
7991
7992 @noindent
7993 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
7994 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
7995
7996 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
7997 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
7998 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are the same size.
7999 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8000 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8001 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8002
8003 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8004 the input is infinite.
8005
8006 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8007 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8008 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8009 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8010 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8011
8012 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8013 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8014 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8015 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8016
8017 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8018 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8019
8020 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8021 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8022 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8023 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8024
8025 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8026 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8027
8028 @noindent
8029 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8030 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8031 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8032 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8033 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8034 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8035
8036 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8037 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8038 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8039 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8040
8041 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8042 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8043 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8044 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8045 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8046
8047 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8048 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8049
8050 @smallexample
8051 @group
8052 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8053 1: 17 .
8054 .
8055
8056 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8057 @end group
8058 @end smallexample
8059
8060 @noindent
8061 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8062
8063 @smallexample
8064 @group
8065 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8066 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8067 .
8068
8069 20" + 17 *
8070 @end group
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 @noindent
8074 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8075
8076 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8077 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8078
8079 @noindent
8080 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8081 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8082 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 @group
8086 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8087 . . .
8088
8089 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8090 @end group
8091 @end smallexample
8092
8093 @noindent
8094 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8095
8096 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8097 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8098 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8099 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8100 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8101
8102 @smallexample
8103 @group
8104 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8105 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8106 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8107 .
8108
8109 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8110 @end group
8111 @end smallexample
8112
8113 @noindent
8114 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8115
8116 @smallexample
8117 @group
8118 1: 242
8119 .
8120
8121 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8122 @end group
8123 @end smallexample
8124
8125 @noindent
8126 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8127
8128 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8129 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8130
8131 @noindent
8132 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8133 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8134 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8135 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8136 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8137 don't know the leap year rule.
8138
8139 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8140 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8141 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8142 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8143 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8144
8145 @smallexample
8146 @group
8147 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8148 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8149 .
8150
8151 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8152
8153 @end group
8154 @end smallexample
8155 @noindent
8156 @smallexample
8157 @group
8158 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8159 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8160 1: 1991 . .
8161 .
8162
8163 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8164 @end group
8165 @end smallexample
8166
8167 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8168 @noindent
8169 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8170 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8171 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8172 background information in that regard.)
8173
8174 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8175 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8176
8177 @noindent
8178 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8179 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8180
8181 @smallexample
8182 @group
8183 1: 1. 2: 1.
8184 . 1: 0.2
8185 .
8186
8187 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8188 @end group
8189 @end smallexample
8190
8191 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8192
8193 @smallexample
8194 @group
8195 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8196 . . .
8197
8198 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8199 @end group
8200 @end smallexample
8201
8202 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8203 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8204
8205 @smallexample
8206 @group
8207 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8208 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8209 1: 706.21 .
8210 .
8211
8212 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8213 @end group
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @noindent
8217 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8218
8219 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8220 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8221
8222 @noindent
8223 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8224 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8225 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8226 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8227 but with no upper bound.
8228
8229 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8230
8231 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8232 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8233 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8234 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8235
8236 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8237 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8238 as a possible value.
8239
8240 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8241 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8242 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8243 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8244 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8245 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8246 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8247 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8248 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8249 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8250
8251 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8252 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8253
8254 @smallexample
8255 @group
8256 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8257 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8258 . .
8259
8260 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8261 @end group
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8266 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8267 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8268
8269 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8270 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8271 for different numbers.
8272
8273 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8274
8275 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8276 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8277
8278 @noindent
8279 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8280
8281 @smallexample
8282 @group
8283 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8284 . 811749612 .
8285 .
8286
8287 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8288 @end group
8289 @end smallexample
8290
8291 @noindent
8292 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8293 must not be prime.
8294
8295 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8296 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8297 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8298 use this method to test the second number.
8299
8300 @smallexample
8301 @group
8302 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8303 1: 15485863 .
8304 .
8305
8306 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8307 @end group
8308 @end smallexample
8309
8310 @noindent
8311 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8312 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8313
8314 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8315 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8316 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8317
8318 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8319 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8320 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8321 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8322
8323 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8324 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8325
8326 @noindent
8327 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8328 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8329 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8330
8331 @smallexample
8332 @group
8333 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8334 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8335 .
8336
8337 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8338
8339 @end group
8340 @end smallexample
8341 @noindent
8342 @smallexample
8343 @group
8344 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8345 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8346 .
8347
8348 x time @key{RET} +
8349 @end group
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 @noindent
8353 It will be just after six in the morning.
8354
8355 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8356 HMS form:
8357
8358 @smallexample
8359 @group
8360 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8361 . .
8362
8363 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8364 @end group
8365 @end smallexample
8366
8367 @noindent
8368 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8369 the actual number 3.14159...
8370
8371 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8372 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8373
8374 @noindent
8375 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8376 each.
8377
8378 @smallexample
8379 @group
8380 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8381 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8382 .
8383
8384 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8385
8386 @end group
8387 @end smallexample
8388 @noindent
8389 @smallexample
8390 @group
8391 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8392 .
8393
8394 17 *
8395 @end group
8396 @end smallexample
8397
8398 @noindent
8399 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8400
8401 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8402 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8403
8404 @noindent
8405 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8406
8407 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8408 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8409
8410 @noindent
8411 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8412 to the other?
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 @group
8416 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8417 . .
8418
8419 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8420 @end group
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 @noindent
8424 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8425
8426 @smallexample
8427 @group
8428 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356
8429 2: 4.1 ns .
8430 .
8431
8432 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} /
8433 @end group
8434 @end smallexample
8435
8436 @noindent
8437 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8438 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8439 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8440
8441 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8442 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8443
8444 @noindent
8445 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8446 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8447
8448 @smallexample
8449 @group
8450 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8451 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8452 .
8453
8454 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8455 @end group
8456 @end smallexample
8457
8458 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8459 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8460 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8461
8462 @smallexample
8463 @group
8464 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8465 . 1: 2 .
8466 .
8467
8468 u s 2 B
8469 @end group
8470 @end smallexample
8471
8472 @noindent
8473 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8474
8475 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8476 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8477
8478 @noindent
8479 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8480 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8481 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8482 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8483 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8484 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8485 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8486
8487 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8488 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8489
8490 @noindent
8491 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8492 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8493 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8494 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8495 familiar form.
8496
8497 @smallexample
8498 @group
8499 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8500 . .
8501
8502 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8503
8504 @end group
8505 @end smallexample
8506 @noindent
8507 @smallexample
8508 @group
8509 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: x*(x + 1.19023) (x - 1.19023)
8510 . .
8511
8512 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8513
8514 @end group
8515 @end smallexample
8516 @noindent
8517 @smallexample
8518 @group
8519 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8520 . .
8521
8522 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8523 @end group
8524 @end smallexample
8525
8526 @noindent
8527 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8528 same as the original polynomial.
8529
8530 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8531 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8532
8533 @smallexample
8534 @group
8535 1: x sin(pi x) 1: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8536 . .
8537
8538 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8539
8540 @end group
8541 @end smallexample
8542 @noindent
8543 @smallexample
8544 @group
8545 1: [y, 1]
8546 2: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8547 .
8548
8549 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8550
8551 @end group
8552 @end smallexample
8553 @noindent
8554 @smallexample
8555 @group
8556 1: [sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi, 1 / pi]
8557 .
8558
8559 V M $ @key{RET}
8560
8561 @end group
8562 @end smallexample
8563 @noindent
8564 @smallexample
8565 @group
8566 1: sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi - 1 / pi
8567 .
8568
8569 V R -
8570
8571 @end group
8572 @end smallexample
8573 @noindent
8574 @smallexample
8575 @group
8576 1: sin(3.14159 y) / 9.8696 - y cos(3.14159 y) / 3.14159 - 0.3183
8577 .
8578
8579 =
8580
8581 @end group
8582 @end smallexample
8583 @noindent
8584 @smallexample
8585 @group
8586 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8587 .
8588
8589 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8590 @end group
8591 @end smallexample
8592
8593 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8594 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8595
8596 @noindent
8597 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8598 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8599 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8600 coefficients. Here's one way:
8601
8602 @smallexample
8603 @group
8604 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8605 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8606 . .
8607
8608 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8609
8610 @end group
8611 @end smallexample
8612 @noindent
8613 @smallexample
8614 @group
8615 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8616 . .
8617
8618 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8619 @end group
8620 @end smallexample
8621
8622 @noindent
8623 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8624 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 @group
8628 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8629 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8630 .
8631
8632 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8633
8634 @end group
8635 @end smallexample
8636 @noindent
8637 @smallexample
8638 @group
8639 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8640 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8641 .
8642
8643 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8644 @end group
8645 @end smallexample
8646
8647 @noindent
8648 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8649 same thing.
8650
8651 @smallexample
8652 @group
8653 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8654 . . .
8655
8656 * .1 * 3 /
8657 @end group
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 @noindent
8661 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8662
8663 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8664 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8665
8666 @noindent
8667 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8668
8669 @smallexample
8670 @group
8671 ___
8672 V 2 + 2
8673 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: ---------
8674 . ___
8675 V 2 + 1
8676
8677 .
8678
8679 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8680 @end group
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 @group
8688 ___ ___
8689 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8690 .
8691
8692 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8693
8694 @end group
8695 @end smallexample
8696 @noindent
8697 @smallexample
8698 @group
8699 ___
8700 1: V 2
8701 .
8702
8703 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c
8704 @end group
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8709 second step.)
8710
8711 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8712 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8713 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8714
8715 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8716 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8717
8718 @noindent
8719 Here is the rule set:
8720
8721 @smallexample
8722 @group
8723 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8724 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8725 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8726 @end group
8727 @end smallexample
8728
8729 @noindent
8730 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8731 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8732 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8733 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8734 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8735 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8736 numbers.
8737
8738 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8739 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8740 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8741 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8742 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8743
8744 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8745 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8746 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8747 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8748 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8749 function.
8750
8751 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8752 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8756 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8757 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8758 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8759 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8760 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8761 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8762
8763 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8764 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8765 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8766 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8767 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8768 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8769 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8770 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8771 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8772
8773 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8774 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8775
8776 @noindent
8777 @ignore
8778 @starindex
8779 @end ignore
8780 @tindex seq
8781 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8782
8783 @smallexample
8784 @group
8785 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8786 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8787 @end group
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8791 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8792
8793 @example
8794 seq( 3, 1)
8795 seq(10, 2)
8796 seq( 5, 3)
8797 seq(16, 4)
8798 seq( 8, 5)
8799 seq( 4, 6)
8800 seq( 2, 7)
8801 seq( 1, 8)
8802 @end example
8803
8804 @noindent
8805 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8806
8807 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8808
8809 @smallexample
8810 @group
8811 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8812 seq(1, c) := c,
8813 ... ]
8814 @end group
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 @noindent
8818 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8819 as the result.
8820
8821 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8822
8823 @smallexample
8824 @group
8825 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8826 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8827 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8828 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8829 @end group
8830 @end smallexample
8831
8832 @noindent
8833 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8834
8835 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8836 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8837 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8838 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8839
8840 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8841 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8842 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8843 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8844 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8845
8846 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8847 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8848
8849 @noindent
8850 @ignore
8851 @starindex
8852 @end ignore
8853 @tindex nterms
8854 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8855 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8856 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8857
8858 @smallexample
8859 @group
8860 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8861 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8862 @end group
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8867 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8868 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8869
8870 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8871 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8872
8873 @noindent
8874 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8875
8876 @smallexample
8877 @group
8878 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8879 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8880 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8881 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8882 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8883 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8884 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8885 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8886 @end group
8887 @end smallexample
8888
8889 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8890 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8891 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8892 say, @code{O}, first.
8893
8894 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8895 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8896 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8897 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8898 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8899
8900 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O@.
8901 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8902 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8903 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8904
8905 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8906
8907 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8908 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8909 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8910
8911 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8912 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8913 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8914 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8915 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8916
8917 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8918
8919 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8920 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8921 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8922 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8923 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8924 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8925 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8926 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8927 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8928 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8929 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8930
8931 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8932 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8933 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8934 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8935 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8936 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8937 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8938 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8939 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8940 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8941 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8942 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8943 in Lisp.)
8944
8945 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8946 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8947
8948 @noindent
8949 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8950 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8951 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8952 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8953 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8954
8955 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8956 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8957
8958 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8959 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8960
8961 @noindent
8962 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8963 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
8964
8965 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
8966 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
8967
8968 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
8969 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
8970 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
8971
8972 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
8973 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
8974
8975 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8976 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
8977
8978 @noindent
8979 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
8980 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
8981
8982 @noindent
8983 Computing
8984 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
8985 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
8986
8987 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
8988
8989 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
8990
8991 @noindent
8992 Computing the logarithm:
8993
8994 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
8995
8996 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
8997
8998 @noindent
8999 Computing the vector of integers:
9000
9001 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9002 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9003 from the stack.)
9004
9005 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9006 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9007 next command.)
9008
9009 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9010
9011 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9012 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9013
9014 @noindent
9015 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9016
9017 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9018 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9019
9020 @smallexample
9021 @group
9022 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9023 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9024 . .
9025
9026 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9027 @end group
9028 @end smallexample
9029
9030 @noindent
9031 This answer is quite accurate.
9032
9033 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9034 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9035
9036 @noindent
9037 Here is the matrix:
9038
9039 @example
9040 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9041 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9042 @end example
9043
9044 @noindent
9045 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9046 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9047
9048 @example
9049 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9050 @end example
9051
9052 @noindent
9053 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9054 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9055 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9056 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9057 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9058 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9059 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9060 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9061
9062 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9063 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9064
9065 @noindent
9066 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9067 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9068 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9069
9070 @smallexample
9071 @group
9072 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9073 . 1: 4
9074 .
9075
9076 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9077 @end group
9078 @end smallexample
9079
9080 @noindent
9081 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9082 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9083 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9084 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9085 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9086 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9087 loop counter exceeds 4.
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 @group
9091 2: 31 3: 31
9092 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9093 . 1: 4.02724519544
9094 .
9095
9096 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9097 @end group
9098 @end smallexample
9099
9100 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9101 harmonic number is 4.02.
9102
9103 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9104 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9108 the formula
9109 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9110 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9111
9112 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9113 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9114 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9115 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9116 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9117 just for purposes of illustration.)
9118
9119 @smallexample
9120 @group
9121 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9122 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9123 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9124 .
9125
9126 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9127
9128 @end group
9129 @end smallexample
9130 @noindent
9131 @smallexample
9132 @group
9133 2: 4.5
9134 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9135 .
9136
9137 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9138 @end group
9139 @end smallexample
9140
9141 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9142 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9143 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9144 repetitions are done.)
9145
9146 @smallexample
9147 @group
9148 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9149 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9150 1: 4.5 .
9151 .
9152
9153 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9154 @end group
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9158 old one to see if we've converged.
9159
9160 @smallexample
9161 @group
9162 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9163 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9164 1: 4.5 .
9165 .
9166
9167 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9168 @end group
9169 @end smallexample
9170
9171 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9172 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9173
9174 @smallexample
9175 @group
9176 2: 5.26345856348
9177 1: 0.499999999997
9178 .
9179
9180 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9181 @end group
9182 @end smallexample
9183
9184 Let's test the new definition again:
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 @group
9188 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9189 1: 1 .
9190 .
9191
9192 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9193 @end group
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9197
9198 @example
9199 @group
9200 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9201 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9202 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9203 Z >
9204 Z '
9205 C-x )
9206 @end group
9207 @end example
9208
9209 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9210 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9211 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9212 to see how to use it.
9213
9214 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9215 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9216 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9217 @xref{Root Finding}.
9218
9219 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9220 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9221
9222 @noindent
9223 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9224 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9225 reduce the problem using
9226 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9227 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9228 on to compute
9229 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9230 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9231 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9232 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9233
9234 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9235 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9236 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9237 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9238 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9239 just for purposes of illustration.)
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 @group
9243 1: 1. 1: 1.
9244 . .
9245
9246 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9247 @end group
9248 @end smallexample
9249
9250 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9251 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9252
9253 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9254 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9255 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9256 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9257
9258 @smallexample
9259 @group
9260 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9261 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9262 1: 5 .
9263 .
9264
9265 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9266 @end group
9267 @end smallexample
9268
9269 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9270 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9271 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9272 minus the adjustment factor.
9273
9274 @smallexample
9275 @group
9276 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9277 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9278 . .
9279
9280 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9281 @end group
9282 @end smallexample
9283
9284 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9285 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9286 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9287
9288 @smallexample
9289 @group
9290 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9291 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9292 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9293 . . 1: 36.
9294 .
9295
9296 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9297
9298 @end group
9299 @end smallexample
9300 @noindent
9301 @smallexample
9302 @group
9303 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9304 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9305 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9306 . .
9307
9308 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9309 @end group
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312 This is the value of
9313 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9314 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9315 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9316 a higher precision:
9317
9318 @smallexample
9319 @group
9320 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9321 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9322
9323 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9324 @end group
9325 @end smallexample
9326
9327 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9328
9329 @example
9330 @group
9331 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9332 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9333 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9334 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9335 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9336 2 Z )
9337 Z '
9338 C-x )
9339 @end group
9340 @end example
9341
9342 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9343 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9344
9345 @noindent
9346 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9347 a term like
9348 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9349 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9350 Taking the derivative of a constant
9351 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9352 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9353 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9354
9355 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9356 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9357 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9358 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9359 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9360 just for purposes of illustration.)
9361
9362 @smallexample
9363 @group
9364 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9365 1: 6 2: 0
9366 . 1: 6
9367 .
9368
9369 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9370 @end group
9371 @end smallexample
9372
9373 @noindent
9374 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9375
9376 @smallexample
9377 @group
9378 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9379 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9380 . 1: 1 .
9381 .
9382
9383 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9384 @end group
9385 @end smallexample
9386
9387 @noindent
9388 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9389 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9390 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 @group
9394 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9395 . . .
9396
9397 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9398 @end group
9399 @end smallexample
9400
9401 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9402 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9403
9404 @smallexample
9405 @group
9406 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9407 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9408 . .
9409
9410 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9411
9412 @end group
9413 @end smallexample
9414 @noindent
9415 @smallexample
9416 @group
9417 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9418 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9419 .
9420
9421 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9422 @end group
9423 @end smallexample
9424
9425 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9426
9427 @example
9428 @group
9429 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9430 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9431 a d x @key{RET}
9432 1 Z ) r 1
9433 Z '
9434 C-x )
9435
9436 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9437 @end group
9438 @end example
9439
9440 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9441 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9442
9443 @noindent
9444 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9445 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9446 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9447 sure the stack comes out right.
9448
9449 @smallexample
9450 @group
9451 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9452 1: 2 . 1: 2
9453 . .
9454
9455 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9456 @end group
9457 @end smallexample
9458
9459 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9460 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9461 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9462 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9463
9464 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9465 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9466
9467 @smallexample
9468 @group
9469 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9470 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9471 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9472 1: 2 .
9473 .
9474
9475 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9476
9477 @end group
9478 @end smallexample
9479 @noindent
9480 @smallexample
9481 @group
9482 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9483 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9484 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9485 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9486 . . .
9487
9488 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9489 @end group
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 @noindent
9493 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9494 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9495
9496 @smallexample
9497 @group
9498 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9499 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9500 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9501 . 1: 2 .
9502 .
9503
9504 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9505
9506 @end group
9507 @end smallexample
9508 @noindent
9509 @smallexample
9510 @group
9511 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9512 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9513 . .
9514
9515 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9516 @end group
9517 @end smallexample
9518
9519 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9520 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9521 the right answers.
9522
9523 Here's the full program once again:
9524
9525 @example
9526 @group
9527 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9528 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9529 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9530 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9531 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9532 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9533 Z ]
9534 Z ]
9535 C-x )
9536 @end group
9537 @end example
9538
9539 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9540 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9541 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9542 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9543 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9544
9545 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9546 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9547
9548 @noindent
9549 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9550 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9551
9552 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9553 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9554
9555 @smallexample
9556 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9557 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9558 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9559 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9560 C-c C-c
9561 @end smallexample
9562
9563 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9564
9565 @smallexample
9566 @group
9567 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9568 1: 2 . .
9569 .
9570
9571 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9572 @end group
9573 @end smallexample
9574
9575 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9576 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9577 the last rule.
9578
9579 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9580 @tex
9581 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9582 @end tex
9583
9584 @c [reference]
9585
9586 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9587 @chapter Introduction
9588
9589 @noindent
9590 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9591 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9592 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9593
9594 @c [when-split]
9595 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9596
9597 @menu
9598 * Basic Commands::
9599 * Help Commands::
9600 * Stack Basics::
9601 * Numeric Entry::
9602 * Algebraic Entry::
9603 * Quick Calculator::
9604 * Prefix Arguments::
9605 * Undo::
9606 * Error Messages::
9607 * Multiple Calculators::
9608 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9609 @end menu
9610
9611 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9612 @section Basic Commands
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 @pindex calc
9616 @pindex calc-mode
9617 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9618 @cindex Running the Calculator
9619 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9620 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9621 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9622 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9623 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9624 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9625 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9626 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9627 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9628 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9629 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9630 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9631
9632 @kindex C-x * c
9633 @kindex C-x * *
9634 @ignore
9635 @mindex @null
9636 @end ignore
9637 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9638 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9639 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9640 in its Keypad mode.
9641
9642 @kindex x
9643 @kindex M-x
9644 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9645 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9646 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9647 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9648 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9649 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9650 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9651 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9652
9653 Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9654 Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9655 arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9656 numbers.
9657
9658 @cindex Extensions module
9659 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9660 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9661 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9662 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9663 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9664 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9665 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9666 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9667 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9668 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9669 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9670
9671 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9672 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9673 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9674 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9675 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9676 to auto-load the Calculator.
9677
9678 @kindex C-x * b
9679 @pindex full-calc
9680 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9681 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9682 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9683 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9684 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9685 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9686 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9687
9688 @kindex C-x * o
9689 @pindex calc-other-window
9690 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9691 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9692 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9693 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9694 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9695 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9696
9697 @ignore
9698 @mindex C-x * q
9699 @end ignore
9700 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9701 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9702 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9703 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9704
9705 @ignore
9706 @mindex C-x * k
9707 @end ignore
9708 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9709 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9710 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9711 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9712
9713 @kindex q
9714 @pindex calc-quit
9715 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9716 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9717 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9718 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9719 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9720 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9721 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9722 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9723 Calculator on and off.
9724
9725 @kindex C-x * x
9726 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9727 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9728 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9729
9730 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9731 @pindex calc-refresh
9732 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9733 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9734 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9735 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9736 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9737
9738 @ignore
9739 @mindex o
9740 @end ignore
9741 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9742 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9743
9744 @kindex <
9745 @kindex >
9746 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9747 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9748 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9749 @cindex Scrolling
9750 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9751 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9752 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9753 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9754 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9755 window whenever it can.)
9756
9757 @kindex @{
9758 @kindex @}
9759 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9760 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9761 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9762 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9763 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9764 height of the Calc window.
9765
9766 @kindex C-x * 0
9767 @pindex calc-reset
9768 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9769 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9770 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9771 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9772 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9773 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9774 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9775 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9776 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9777 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9778 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9779
9780 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9781 @section Help Commands
9782
9783 @noindent
9784 @cindex Help commands
9785 @kindex ?
9786 @kindex a ?
9787 @kindex b ?
9788 @kindex c ?
9789 @kindex d ?
9790 @kindex f ?
9791 @kindex g ?
9792 @kindex j ?
9793 @kindex k ?
9794 @kindex m ?
9795 @kindex r ?
9796 @kindex s ?
9797 @kindex t ?
9798 @kindex u ?
9799 @kindex v ?
9800 @kindex V ?
9801 @kindex z ?
9802 @kindex Z ?
9803 @pindex calc-help
9804 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9805 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs's
9806 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9807 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9808 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9809 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9810
9811 @kindex h h
9812 @pindex calc-full-help
9813 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9814 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9815 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9816
9817 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9818 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9819 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9820
9821 @kindex h i
9822 @kindex C-x * i
9823 @kindex i
9824 @pindex calc-info
9825 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9826 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9827 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9828 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9829 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9830 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9831 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9832 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9833 different command in a future version of Calc.
9834
9835 @kindex h t
9836 @kindex C-x * t
9837 @pindex calc-tutorial
9838 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9839 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9840 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9841 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9842 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9843 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9844 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9845 all times).
9846
9847 @kindex h s
9848 @kindex C-x * s
9849 @pindex calc-info-summary
9850 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9851 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9852 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9853
9854 @kindex h k
9855 @pindex calc-describe-key
9856 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9857 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9858 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9859 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9860 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9861 node indicated by the index.
9862
9863 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9864 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9865 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9866 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9867
9868 @kindex h c
9869 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9870 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9871 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9872 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9873 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9874 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9875 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9876 gives the description:
9877
9878 @smallexample
9879 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9880 @end smallexample
9881
9882 @noindent
9883 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9884 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9885 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9886 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9887 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9888
9889 @kindex h f
9890 @pindex calc-describe-function
9891 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9892 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9893 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9894 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9895 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9896 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9897 @samp{=>}.
9898
9899 @kindex h v
9900 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9901 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9902 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9903 @code{PlotRejects}.
9904
9905 @kindex h b
9906 @pindex describe-bindings
9907 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9908 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9909 listed.
9910
9911 @kindex h n
9912 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9913 the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
9914 @file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
9915 source files.
9916
9917 @kindex h C-c
9918 @kindex h C-d
9919 @kindex h C-w
9920 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9921 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9922 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9923 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9924
9925 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9926 @section Stack Basics
9927
9928 @noindent
9929 @cindex Stack basics
9930 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9931 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9932 Tutorial}.
9933
9934 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9935 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9936 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9937 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9938 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9939 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9940 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9941 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9942
9943 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9944 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9945 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9946 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9947 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9948 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9949
9950 @kindex d l
9951 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9952 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9953 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9954 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9955 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9956 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9957
9958 @kindex o
9959 @pindex calc-realign
9960 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9961 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9962 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9963 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9964
9965 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9966 two consecutive numbers.
9967 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9968 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9969 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9970 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9971
9972 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9973 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9974 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9975 commands.
9976
9977 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9978 @section Numeric Entry
9979
9980 @noindent
9981 @kindex 0-9
9982 @kindex .
9983 @kindex e
9984 @cindex Numeric entry
9985 @cindex Entering numbers
9986 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
9987 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
9988 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
9989 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
9990 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
9991
9992 @cindex Minus signs
9993 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
9994 @kindex _
9995 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
9996 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
9997 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
9998 different keys for these operations, respectively:
9999 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10000 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10001 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10002 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10003 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10004 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10005 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10006
10007 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10008 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10009 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10010 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10011
10012 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10013
10014 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10015 @section Algebraic Entry
10016
10017 @noindent
10018 @kindex '
10019 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10020 @cindex Algebraic notation
10021 @cindex Formulas, entering
10022 The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10023 calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10024 apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
10025
10026 @example
10027 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10028 @end example
10029
10030 @noindent
10031 This will compute
10032 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10033 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10034 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10035 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10036 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10037 clear previous results off the stack.
10038
10039 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10040 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10041 this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10042 keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10043
10044 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10045 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10046 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10047 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10048
10049 @kindex m a
10050 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10051 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10052 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10053 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10054 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10055 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10056 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10057 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10058 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10059 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10060 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10061
10062 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10063 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10064 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10065 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10066 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10067
10068 @kindex m t
10069 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10070 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10071 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10072 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10073 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10074 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10075 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10076 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10077 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10078 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10079 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10080 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10081 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10082
10083 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10084 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10085 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10086
10087 @kindex $
10088 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10089 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10090 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10091 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10092 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10093 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10094 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10095 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10096 first character in the new formula.
10097
10098 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10099 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10100 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10101 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10102 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10103 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10104 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10105
10106 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10107 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10108 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10109 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10110 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10111 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10112
10113 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10114 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10115 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10116 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10117 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10118 @key{TAB} key.
10119
10120 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10121 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10122 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10123 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10124
10125 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10126 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables simplification
10127 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10128 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10129 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10130 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10131
10132 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10133 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10134
10135 @noindent
10136 @kindex C-x * q
10137 @pindex quick-calc
10138 @cindex Quick Calculator
10139 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10140 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10141 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10142 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10143 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10144
10145 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10146 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10147 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10148 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10149 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10150 @samp{$} as the formula.
10151
10152 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10153 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10154 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10155 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10156 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10157 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10158 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10159 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10160
10161 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10162 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10163
10164 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10165 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10166 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10167 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10168 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10169 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10170
10171 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10172 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10173 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10174
10175 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10176 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10177 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10178 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10179 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10180 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10181
10182 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10183 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10184 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10185 an ASCII character.
10186
10187 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10188 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10189 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10190 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10191 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10192 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10193 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10194
10195 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10196 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10197 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10198 small calculations.
10199
10200 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10201 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10202
10203 @noindent
10204 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10205 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10206 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10207 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10208 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10209
10210 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10211 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10212 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10213 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10214 on the entire stack.
10215
10216 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10217 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10218 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10219 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10220 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10221 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10222 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10223 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10224 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10225 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10226 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10227 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10228 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10229 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10230 argument for some other purpose.
10231
10232 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10233 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10234 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10235 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10236
10237 @kindex ~
10238 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10239 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10240 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10241 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10242 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10243 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10244
10245 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10246 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10247
10248 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10249 @section Undoing Mistakes
10250
10251 @noindent
10252 @kindex U
10253 @kindex C-_
10254 @pindex calc-undo
10255 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10256 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10257 @cindex Errors, undoing
10258 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10259 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10260 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10261 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10262 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10263 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10264 specified number of operations. When the Calculator is quit, as with
10265 the @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command, the undo history will be
10266 truncated to the length of the customizable variable
10267 @code{calc-undo-length} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), which by default
10268 is @expr{100}. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is synonymous with
10269 @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this also truncates the
10270 undo history.)
10271
10272 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10273 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10274 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10275
10276 @kindex D
10277 @pindex calc-redo
10278 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10279 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10280 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10281 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10282 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10283 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10284 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10285 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10286
10287 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10288 @pindex calc-last-args
10289 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10290 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10291 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10292 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10293 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10294 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10295 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10296 onto the stack.
10297
10298 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10299 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10300
10301 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10302 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10303
10304 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10305
10306 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10307 @section Error Messages
10308
10309 @noindent
10310 @kindex w
10311 @pindex calc-why
10312 @cindex Errors, messages
10313 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10314 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10315 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10316 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10317 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10318 reasons for this to happen.
10319
10320 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10321 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10322 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10323 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10324 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10325 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10326 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10327
10328 @kindex d w
10329 @pindex calc-auto-why
10330 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10331 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10332 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10333 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10334 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10335 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10336
10337 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10338 @section Multiple Calculators
10339
10340 @noindent
10341 @pindex another-calc
10342 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10343 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10344 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10345 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10346 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10347 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10348 this would ordinarily never be done.
10349
10350 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10351 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10352 Calculator buffer.
10353
10354 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10355 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10356 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10357 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10358 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10359 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10360
10361 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10362 Calculator buffers.
10363
10364 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10365 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10366
10367 @noindent
10368 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10369 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10370
10371 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10372 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10373
10374 @menu
10375 * Autoloading Problems::
10376 * Recursion Depth::
10377 * Caches::
10378 * Debugging Calc::
10379 @end menu
10380
10381 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10382 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10383
10384 @noindent
10385 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10386 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10387 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10388 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10389 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10390
10391 @kindex C-x * L
10392 @pindex calc-load-everything
10393 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10394 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10395 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10396 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10397
10398 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10399 @subsection Recursion Depth
10400
10401 @noindent
10402 @kindex M
10403 @kindex I M
10404 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10405 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10406 @cindex Recursion depth
10407 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10408 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10409 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10410 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10411 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10412 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10413 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10414 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10415 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10416 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10417
10418 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10419 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10420 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10421 The default value is 1000.
10422
10423 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10424 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10425
10426 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10427 @subsection Caches
10428
10429 @noindent
10430 @cindex Caches
10431 @cindex Flushing caches
10432 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10433 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10434 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10435 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10436 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10437 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10438 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10439 @cpiover{4} and
10440 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10441 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10442 The visible effect of caching is that
10443 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10444 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10445 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10446 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10447
10448 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10449 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10450 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10451 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10452 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10453 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10454
10455 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10456 @subsection Debugging Calc
10457
10458 @noindent
10459 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10460 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10461 your own Calc commands.
10462
10463 @kindex Z T
10464 @pindex calc-timing
10465 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10466 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10467 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10468 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10469 accurate only to within one second.
10470
10471 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10472 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10473 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10474 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10475 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10476 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10477 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10478 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10479 to execute the whole macro.
10480
10481 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10482 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10483 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10484 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10485 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10486 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10487 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10488
10489 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10490 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10491 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10492 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10493 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10494 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10495 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10496
10497 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10498 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10499 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10500 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10501 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10502 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10503 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10504 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10505 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10506 will be lost.
10507
10508 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10509 @chapter Data Types
10510
10511 @noindent
10512 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10513 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10514 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10515 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10516
10517 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10518 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10519 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10520 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10521 arbitrarily: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10522 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10523 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10524
10525 @menu
10526 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10527 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10528 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10529 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10530 * Infinities::
10531 * Vectors and Matrices::
10532 * Strings::
10533 * HMS Forms::
10534 * Date Forms::
10535 * Modulo Forms::
10536 * Error Forms::
10537 * Interval Forms::
10538 * Incomplete Objects::
10539 * Variables::
10540 * Formulas::
10541 @end menu
10542
10543 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10544 @section Integers
10545
10546 @noindent
10547 @cindex Integers
10548 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10549 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10550 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10551 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10552 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10553 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10554
10555 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10556 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10557 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10558 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10559
10560 @kindex #
10561 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10562 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10563 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10564 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10565 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10566 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10567 number, the current display radix is used.
10568
10569 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10570 @section Fractions
10571
10572 @noindent
10573 @cindex Fractions
10574 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10575 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10576 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10577 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10578 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10579 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10580 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10581
10582 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10583 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10584 display formats.
10585
10586 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10587 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10588 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10589
10590 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10591 @section Floats
10592
10593 @noindent
10594 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10595 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10596 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10597 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10598 range of acceptable values is from
10599 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10600 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10601 (inclusive) to
10602 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10603 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10604 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10605
10606 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10607 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10608 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10609 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10610 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10611 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10612 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10613 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10614 would have overflowed!)
10615
10616 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10617 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10618 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10619 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10620
10621 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10622 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10623 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10624 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10625 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10626 or 0.235.
10627
10628 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10629 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10630 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10631 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10632
10633 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10634 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10635 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10636 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10637 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10638 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10639 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10640 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10641 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10642 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10643 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10644 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10645 way.
10646
10647 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10648 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10649 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10650 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10651 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10652 current precision. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10653 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10654 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10655 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10656 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10657 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10658 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10659 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10660 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10661 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10662 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10663
10664 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10665 @section Complex Numbers
10666
10667 @noindent
10668 @cindex Complex numbers
10669 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10670 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10671 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10672 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10673 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10674 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10675
10676 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10677 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10678 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10679 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10680 @texline @math{\theta}
10681 @infoline @var{theta}
10682 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10683 @texline @math{\theta}
10684 @infoline @var{theta}
10685 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10686 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10687 in radians.
10688
10689 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10690 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10691
10692 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10693 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10694 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10695 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10696 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10697
10698 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10699 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10700 number.
10701
10702 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10703 @section Infinities
10704
10705 @noindent
10706 @cindex Infinity
10707 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10708 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10709 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10710 @vindex inf
10711 @vindex uinf
10712 @vindex nan
10713 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10714 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10715 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10716 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10717 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10718 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10719 entered using algebraic entry.
10720
10721 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10722 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10723 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10724 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10725 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10726 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10727 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10728 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10729 @texline @math{e^x}
10730 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10731 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10732 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10733 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10734 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10735
10736 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10737 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10738 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10739 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10740 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10741 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10742 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10743 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10744 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10745 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10746 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10747
10748 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10749 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10750 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10751 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10752 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10753 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10754 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10755 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10756 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10757 some cases.
10758
10759 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10760 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10761 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10762 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10763 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10764 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10765 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10766 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10767 notation.
10768
10769 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10770 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10771 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10772 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10773 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10774 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10775 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10776 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10777 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10778 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10779 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10780 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10781 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10782 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10783 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10784 (as described above).
10785
10786 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10787 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10788
10789 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10790 @section Vectors and Matrices
10791
10792 @noindent
10793 @cindex Vectors
10794 @cindex Plain vectors
10795 @cindex Matrices
10796 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10797 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10798 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10799 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10800 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10801
10802 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10803 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10804 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10805 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10806 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10807 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10808 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10809 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10810 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10811 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10812 this case.
10813
10814 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10815 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10816 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10817 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10818 of its elements.
10819
10820 @ignore
10821 @starindex
10822 @end ignore
10823 @tindex vec
10824 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10825 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10826 @texline @math{n\times m}
10827 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10828 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10829 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10830
10831 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10832 @section Strings
10833
10834 @noindent
10835 @kindex "
10836 @cindex Strings
10837 @cindex Character strings
10838 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10839 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10840 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10841 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10842 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10843 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10844
10845 @example
10846 @group
10847 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10848 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10849 \e 27 \^[ 27
10850 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10851 \n 10 \^] 29
10852 \r 13 \^^ 30
10853 \t 9 \^_ 31
10854 \^? 127
10855 @end group
10856 @end example
10857
10858 @noindent
10859 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10860 character from its ASCII code.
10861
10862 @kindex d "
10863 @pindex calc-display-strings
10864 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10865 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10866 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10867 instead.
10868
10869 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10870 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10871 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10872 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10873 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10874 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10875
10876 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10877 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10878 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10879
10880 @ignore
10881 @starindex
10882 @end ignore
10883 @tindex string
10884 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10885 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10886 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10887 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10888 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10889 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10890 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10891 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10892 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10893
10894 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10895 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10896 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10897 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10898
10899 @ignore
10900 @starindex
10901 @end ignore
10902 @tindex bstring
10903 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10904 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10905 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10906 character in the string.
10907
10908 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10909 @section HMS Forms
10910
10911 @noindent
10912 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10913 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10914 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10915 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10916 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10917 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10918 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10919 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10920
10921 @kindex @@
10922 @ignore
10923 @mindex @null
10924 @end ignore
10925 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10926 @ignore
10927 @mindex @null
10928 @end ignore
10929 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10930 @ignore
10931 @mindex @null
10932 @end ignore
10933 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10934 @ignore
10935 @mindex @null
10936 @end ignore
10937 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10938 @ignore
10939 @mindex @null
10940 @end ignore
10941 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10942 @ignore
10943 @mindex @null
10944 @end ignore
10945 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10946 The default format for HMS values is
10947 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10948 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10949 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10950 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10951 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10952 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10953 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10954 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10955 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10956 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10957 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10958 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10959
10960 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10961 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10962 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10963 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10964
10965 @pindex calc-time
10966 @cindex Time of day
10967 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10968 the stack as an HMS form.
10969
10970 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10971 @section Date Forms
10972
10973 @noindent
10974 @cindex Date forms
10975 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10976 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10977 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10978 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10979 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10980 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10981 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10982
10983 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
10984 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
10985 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
10986 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
10987 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
10988
10989 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
10990 of days since midnight on the morning of December 31 of the year 1 BC@.
10991 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
10992 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
10993 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Thu Jan 10, 1991>}
10994 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
10995 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
10996 time can be stored without roundoff error.
10997
10998 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
10999 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11000 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11001 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11002 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11003 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11004 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11005 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11006 never an issue for them.
11007
11008 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11009 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11010 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11011
11012 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11013 year numbers represent years BC@. There is no ``year 0''; the day
11014 before @samp{<Mon Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Sun Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11015 days 1 and 0 respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme. The
11016 Gregorian calendar is used for all dates, including dates before the
11017 Gregorian calendar was invented (although that can be configured; see
11018 below). Thus Calc's use of the day number @mathit{-10000} to
11019 represent August 15, 28 BC should be taken with a grain of salt.
11020
11021 @cindex Julian calendar
11022 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11023 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11024 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the confusion
11025 caused by the irregular Roman calendar that was used before that time.
11026 The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in all years divisible by
11027 four. After some initial confusion, the calendar was adopted around
11028 the year we call 8 AD@. Some centuries later it became
11029 apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was itself not quite
11030 right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the Gregorian calendar,
11031 which added the new rule that years divisible by 100, but not by 400,
11032 were not to be considered leap years despite being divisible by four.
11033 Many countries delayed adoption of the Gregorian calendar
11034 because of religious differences. For example, Great Britain and the
11035 British colonies switched to the Gregorian calendar in September
11036 1752, when the Julian calendar was eleven days behind the
11037 Gregorian calendar. That year in Britain, the day after September 2
11038 was September 14. To take another example, Russia did not adopt the
11039 Gregorian calendar until 1918, and that year in Russia the day after
11040 January 31 was February 14. Calc's reckoning therefore matches English
11041 practice starting in 1752 and Russian practice starting in 1918, but
11042 disagrees with earlier dates in both countries.
11043
11044 When the Julian calendar was introduced, it had January 1 as the first
11045 day of the year. By the Middle Ages, many European countries
11046 had changed the beginning of a new year to a different date, often to
11047 a religious festival. Almost all countries reverted to using January 1
11048 as the beginning of the year by the time they adopted the Gregorian
11049 calendar.
11050
11051 Some calendars attempt to mimic the historical situation by using the
11052 Gregorian calendar for recent dates and the Julian calendar for older
11053 dates. The @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations does this,
11054 for example. While January 1 wasn't always the beginning of a calendar
11055 year, these hybrid calendars still use January 1 as the beginning of
11056 the year even for older dates. The customizable variable
11057 @code{calc-gregorian-switch} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}) can be set to
11058 have Calc's date forms switch from the Julian to Gregorian calendar at
11059 any specified date.
11060
11061 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second''.
11062 These do not occur regularly and Calc does not take these minor
11063 effects into account. (If it did, it would have to report a
11064 non-integer number of days between, say,
11065 @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11066 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11067
11068 @cindex Julian day counting
11069 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11070 ``Julian.'' Julian days go from noon to noon. The Julian day number
11071 is the numbers of days since 12:00 noon (GMT) on November 24, 4714 BC
11072 in the Gregorian calendar (i.e., January 1, 4713 BC in the Julian
11073 calendar). In Calc's scheme (in GMT) the Julian day origin is
11074 @mathit{-1721422.5}, because Calc starts at midnight instead of noon.
11075 Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11076 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721422.5 after
11077 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11078 command performs this conversion for you.
11079
11080 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11081 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11082 since it involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11083 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11084 Julian cycle is based on three other cycles: the indiction cycle, the
11085 Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15 year
11086 cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later used to
11087 date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year cycle; 19
11088 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year and a lunar
11089 month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will occur on the
11090 same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year cycle; the Julian
11091 calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The smallest time period
11092 which contains multiples of all three cycles is the least common
11093 multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which (since they're
11094 pairwise relatively prime) is
11095 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11096 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11097 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11098 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scaliger
11099 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11100 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11101 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11102 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11103 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11104 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11105 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11106 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11107 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11108 noon GMT@.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11109
11110 @cindex Unix time format
11111 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11112 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11113 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11114 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11115 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11116 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11117 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11118 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11119 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11120 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11121 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11122 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11123 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11124 conversions.
11125
11126 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11127 @section Modulo Forms
11128
11129 @noindent
11130 @cindex Modulo forms
11131 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11132 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11133 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11134 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11135 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11136 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11137 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11138 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11139 integers but this is not required.
11140
11141 @ignore
11142 @mindex M
11143 @end ignore
11144 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11145 @ignore
11146 @mindex mod
11147 @end ignore
11148 @tindex mod (operator)
11149 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11150 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11151 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11152 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11153 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11154 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11155
11156 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11157 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11158 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11159 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11160 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11161 the result always lies in the desired range.
11162
11163 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11164 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11165 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11166 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11167 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11168 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11169 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11170 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11171
11172 @cindex Modulo division
11173 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11174 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11175 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11176 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11177 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11178 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11179 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11180 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11181 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11182 in the sense of reducing
11183 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11184 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11185 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11186 number-theoretical point of view.)
11187
11188 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11189 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11190 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11191 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11192 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11193 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11194 24 radians!
11195
11196 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11197 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11198 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11199
11200 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11201 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11202
11203 @ignore
11204 @starindex
11205 @end ignore
11206 @tindex makemod
11207 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11208 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11209
11210 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11211 @section Error Forms
11212
11213 @noindent
11214 @cindex Error forms
11215 @cindex Standard deviations
11216 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11217 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11218 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11219 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11220 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11221 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11222 deviation or ``error''
11223 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11224 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11225 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11226 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11227 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11228 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11229 regular number by the Calculator.
11230
11231 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11232 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11233 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11234 @texline @math{\sin x}
11235 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11236 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11237 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11238 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11239 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11240 @tex
11241 $$ \eqalign{
11242 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11243 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11244 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11245 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11246 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11247 \right| \right)^2
11248 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11249 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11250 } $$
11251 @end tex
11252 Note that this
11253 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11254 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11255 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11256 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11257 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11258 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11259 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11260
11261 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11262 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11263 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11264 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11265 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11266 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11267 is
11268 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11269 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11270 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11271 @texline @math{\cos x}
11272 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11273 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11274 @texline @math{\sigma};
11275 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11276 this makes sense, since
11277 @texline @math{\sin x}
11278 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11279 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11280 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11281 @texline @math{\cos x}
11282 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11283 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11284 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11285 has relatively little effect on the value of
11286 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11287 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11288 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11289 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11290 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11291 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11292 @texline @math{\sin x}
11293 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11294 would indeed have been negligible.
11295
11296 @ignore
11297 @mindex p
11298 @end ignore
11299 @kindex p (error forms)
11300 @tindex +/-
11301 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11302 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11303 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11304 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11305 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11306
11307 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11308 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11309 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11310 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11311 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11312 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11313 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11314 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11315
11316 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11317 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11318
11319 @ignore
11320 @starindex
11321 @end ignore
11322 @tindex sdev
11323 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11324
11325 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11326 @section Interval Forms
11327
11328 @noindent
11329 @cindex Interval forms
11330 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11331 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11332 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11333 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11334 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11335 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11336 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11337 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11338 set of possible values of the input.
11339
11340 @ifnottex
11341 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11342 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11343 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11344 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11345 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11346 terms,
11347 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11348 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11349 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11350 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11351 @end ifnottex
11352 @tex
11353 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11354 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11355 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11356 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11357 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11358 terms,
11359 $$ \eqalign{
11360 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11361 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11362 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11363 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11364 } $$
11365 @end tex
11366
11367 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11368 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11369 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11370 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11371 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11372 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11373 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11374 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11375 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11376 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11377 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11378 the real infinities.
11379
11380 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11381 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11382 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11383 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11384 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11385 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11386 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11387
11388 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11389 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11390 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11391 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11392 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11393 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11394 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11395 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11396 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11397
11398 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11399 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11400 form
11401 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11402 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11403 means a variable is random, and its value could
11404 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11405 @texline @math{\sigma}
11406 @infoline @var{sigma}
11407 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11408 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11409 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11410 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11411 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11412 answer.
11413
11414 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11415 HMS forms or date forms.
11416
11417 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11418 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11419
11420 @ignore
11421 @starindex
11422 @end ignore
11423 @tindex intv
11424 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11425 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11426 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11427 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11428
11429 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11430 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11431 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11432 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11433 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11434 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11435 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11436 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11437 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11438 error.
11439
11440 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11441 @section Incomplete Objects
11442
11443 @noindent
11444 @ignore
11445 @mindex [ ]
11446 @end ignore
11447 @kindex [
11448 @ignore
11449 @mindex ( )
11450 @end ignore
11451 @kindex (
11452 @kindex ,
11453 @ignore
11454 @mindex @null
11455 @end ignore
11456 @kindex ]
11457 @ignore
11458 @mindex @null
11459 @end ignore
11460 @kindex )
11461 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11462 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11463 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11464 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11465 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11466 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11467 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11468 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11469 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11470
11471 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11472 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11473 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11474
11475 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11476 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11477 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11478 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11479
11480 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11481 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11482 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11483 from the list.
11484
11485 @kindex ;
11486 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11487 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11488 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11489 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11490
11491 @kindex ..
11492 @pindex calc-dots
11493 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11494 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11495 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11496 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11497 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11498 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11499
11500 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11501 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11502
11503 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11504 @section Variables
11505
11506 @noindent
11507 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11508 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11509 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11510 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11511 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11512 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11513 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11514 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11515 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11516 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11517 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11518 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11519 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11520 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11521 refer to the same variable.)
11522
11523 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11524 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11525 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11526 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11527 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11528 @code{foo}.
11529
11530 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11531 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11532 (@key{'}) key.
11533
11534 @kindex =
11535 @pindex calc-evaluate
11536 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11537 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11538 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11539 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11540 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11541 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11542 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11543 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11544 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11545 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11546 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11547 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11548
11549 @cindex @code{e} variable
11550 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11551 @cindex @code{i} variable
11552 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11553 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11554 @vindex e
11555 @vindex pi
11556 @vindex i
11557 @vindex phi
11558 @vindex gamma
11559 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11560 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11561 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11562 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11563 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11564 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11565
11566 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11567 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11568 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11569 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11570 a value into any of these special variables.
11571
11572 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11573
11574 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11575 @section Formulas
11576
11577 @noindent
11578 @cindex Formulas
11579 @cindex Expressions
11580 @cindex Operators in formulas
11581 @cindex Precedence of operators
11582 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11583 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11584 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11585 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11586 Parentheses may
11587 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11588 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11589 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11590 with their equivalent function names, are:
11591
11592 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11593
11594 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11595
11596 prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11597
11598 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11599 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11600
11601 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11602 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11603
11604 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11605
11606 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11607
11608 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11609
11610 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11611 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11612
11613 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11614
11615 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11616
11617 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11618 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11619
11620 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11621
11622 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11623
11624 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11625
11626 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11627
11628 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11629
11630 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11631
11632 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11633
11634 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11635
11636 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11637
11638 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11639 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11640 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11641 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11642
11643 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11644 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11645 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11646 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11647 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11648 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11649 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11650 as in @samp{f(x)},
11651 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11652 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11653 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11654 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11655 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11656
11657 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11658 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11659 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11660 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11661 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11662 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11663 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11664 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11665 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11666 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11667 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11668
11669 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11670 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11671 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11672 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11673 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11674 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11675 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11676 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11677 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11678 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11679
11680 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11681 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11682 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11683 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11684
11685 @cindex Function call notation
11686 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11687 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11688 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11689 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11690 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11691 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11692 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11693 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11694 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11695 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11696 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11697
11698 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11699 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11700 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11701 represent the same operation.
11702
11703 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11704 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11705 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11706 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11707 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11708 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11709 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11710
11711 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11712 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11713 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11714 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11715
11716 @example
11717 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11718 c + d,
11719 %% last line is coming up:
11720 e + f ]
11721 @end example
11722
11723 @noindent
11724 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11725
11726 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11727 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11728 formats.
11729
11730 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11731
11732 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11733 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11734
11735 @noindent
11736 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11737 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11738 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11739
11740 @menu
11741 * Stack Manipulation::
11742 * Editing Stack Entries::
11743 * Trail Commands::
11744 * Keep Arguments::
11745 @end menu
11746
11747 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11748 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11749
11750 @noindent
11751 @kindex @key{RET}
11752 @kindex @key{SPC}
11753 @pindex calc-enter
11754 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11755 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11756 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11757 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11758 several elements at the top of the stack.
11759 Given a negative argument,
11760 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11761 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11762 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11763 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11764 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11765 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11766 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11767
11768 @kindex @key{LFD}
11769 @pindex calc-over
11770 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11771 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11772 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11773 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11774 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11775 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11776 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11777
11778 @kindex @key{DEL}
11779 @kindex C-d
11780 @pindex calc-pop
11781 @cindex Removing stack entries
11782 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11783 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11784 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11785 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11786 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11787 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11788 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11789 stack is emptied.
11790 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11791 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11792 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11793 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11794 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11795
11796 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11797 @pindex calc-pop-above
11798 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11799 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11800 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11801 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11802 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11803 the third stack element.
11804
11805 @kindex @key{TAB}
11806 @pindex calc-roll-down
11807 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11808 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11809 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11810 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11811 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11812 top-for-bottom.
11813 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11814 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11815 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11816 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11817 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11818
11819 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11820 @pindex calc-roll-up
11821 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11822 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11823 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11824 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11825 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11826 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11827 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11828 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11829
11830 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11831 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11832 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11833 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11834 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11835 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11836 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11837
11838 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11839 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11840 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11841 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @var{n}, also
11842 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11843
11844 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11845 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11846
11847 @kindex C-xC-t
11848 @pindex calc-transpose-lines
11849 @cindex Moving stack entries
11850 The command @kbd{C-x C-t} (@code{calc-transpose-lines}) will transpose
11851 the stack object determined by the point with the stack object at the
11852 next higher level. For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the
11853 stack and the point on the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-x C-t}
11854 creates @samp{10 20 40 30 50}. More generally, @kbd{C-x C-t} acts on
11855 the stack objects determined by the current point (and mark) similar
11856 to how the text-mode command @code{transpose-lines} acts on
11857 lines. With argument @var{n}, @kbd{C-x C-t} will move the stack object
11858 at the level above the current point and move it past N other objects;
11859 for example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack and the point on
11860 the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-u 2 C-x C-t} creates
11861 @samp{10 40 20 30 50}. With an argument of 0, @kbd{C-x C-t} will switch
11862 the stack objects at the levels determined by the point and the mark.
11863
11864 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11865 @section Editing Stack Entries
11866
11867 @noindent
11868 @kindex `
11869 @pindex calc-edit
11870 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11871 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11872 The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11873 (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11874 Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11875 numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11876 at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11877 argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11878
11879 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11880 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11881 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11882 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11883 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11884
11885 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11886 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11887 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11888 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11889 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11890 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11891 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11892
11893 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11894 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11895 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11896 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11897
11898 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11899 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11900 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11901 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11902 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11903 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11904 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11905 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11906 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11907
11908 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11909 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11910 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11911 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11912 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11913
11914 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11915 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11916 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11917
11918 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11919 @section Trail Commands
11920
11921 @noindent
11922 @cindex Trail buffer
11923 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11924 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11925
11926 @kindex t d
11927 @pindex calc-trail-display
11928 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11929 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11930 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11931 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11932 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11933 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11934 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11935 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11936 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11937
11938 @kindex t i
11939 @pindex calc-trail-in
11940 @kindex t o
11941 @pindex calc-trail-out
11942 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11943 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11944 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11945 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11946 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11947 in the Calculator window.
11948
11949 @cindex Trail pointer
11950 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11951 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11952 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11953 trail pointer in various ways.
11954
11955 @kindex t y
11956 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11957 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11958 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11959 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11960 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11961 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11962 trail pointer.
11963
11964 @kindex t <
11965 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11966 @kindex t >
11967 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11968 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11969 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11970 window left or right by one half of its width.
11971
11972 @kindex t n
11973 @pindex calc-trail-next
11974 @kindex t p
11975 @pindex calc-trail-previous
11976 @kindex t f
11977 @pindex calc-trail-forward
11978 @kindex t b
11979 @pindex calc-trail-backward
11980 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11981 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11982 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11983 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11984 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11985 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11986
11987 @kindex t [
11988 @pindex calc-trail-first
11989 @kindex t ]
11990 @pindex calc-trail-last
11991 @kindex t h
11992 @pindex calc-trail-here
11993 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
11994 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
11995 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
11996 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
11997 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
11998
11999 @kindex t s
12000 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
12001 @kindex t r
12002 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12003 @ifnottex
12004 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12005 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12006 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12007 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12008 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12009 it was when the search began.
12010 @end ifnottex
12011 @tex
12012 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12013 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12014 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12015 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12016 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12017 it was when the search began.
12018 @end tex
12019
12020 @kindex t m
12021 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12022 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12023 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12024 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12025 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12026 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12027
12028 @kindex t k
12029 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12030 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12031 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12032 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12033 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12034 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12035
12036 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12037 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12038
12039 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12040 @section Keep Arguments
12041
12042 @noindent
12043 @kindex K
12044 @pindex calc-keep-args
12045 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12046 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12047 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12048 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12049 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12050
12051 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12052 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12053 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12054 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12055 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12056 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12057 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12058 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12059 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12060 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12061 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12062 extra work.
12063
12064 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12065 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12066 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12067
12068 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12069 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12070 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12071 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12072 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12073 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12074
12075 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12076 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12077 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12078 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12079 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12080 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12081
12082 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12083 @chapter Mode Settings
12084
12085 @noindent
12086 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12087 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12088 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12089
12090 @menu
12091 * General Mode Commands::
12092 * Precision::
12093 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12094 * Calculation Modes::
12095 * Simplification Modes::
12096 * Declarations::
12097 * Display Modes::
12098 * Language Modes::
12099 * Modes Variable::
12100 * Calc Mode Line::
12101 @end menu
12102
12103 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12104 @section General Mode Commands
12105
12106 @noindent
12107 @kindex m m
12108 @pindex calc-save-modes
12109 @cindex Continuous memory
12110 @cindex Saving mode settings
12111 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12112 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12113 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12114 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12115 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})
12116 command. This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time
12117 it starts up. The modes saved in the file include everything
12118 controlled by the @kbd{m} and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current
12119 precision and binary word size, whether or not the trail is displayed,
12120 the current height of the Calc window, and more. The current
12121 interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *}) is also saved. If there
12122 were already saved mode settings in the file, they are replaced.
12123 Otherwise, the new mode information is appended to the end of the
12124 file.
12125
12126 @kindex m R
12127 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12128 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12129 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12130 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12131 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12132 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12133 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12134 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12135 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12136
12137 @kindex m F
12138 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12139 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12140 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12141 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12142 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12143 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12144 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12145 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12146 file name is @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12147 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12148 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12149
12150 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12151 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12152 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12153 to reread. You can give
12154 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12155 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12156 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12157 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12158 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12159 modes present in the file you were using before.
12160
12161 @kindex m x
12162 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12163 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12164 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12165 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12166 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12167 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12168 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12169 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12170
12171 @kindex m S
12172 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12173 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12174 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12175 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12176 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12177 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12178 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12179 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12180 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12181 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12182 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12183 shifted-prefix mode.
12184
12185 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12186 @section Precision
12187
12188 @noindent
12189 @kindex p
12190 @pindex calc-precision
12191 @cindex Precision of calculations
12192 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12193 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12194 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12195 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12196 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12197
12198 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12199 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12200
12201 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12202 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12203 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12204 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12205 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12206 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12207 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12208 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12209 existing value to a new precision.
12210
12211 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12212 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12213 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12214 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12215 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12216 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12217 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12218 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12219 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12220 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12221 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12222 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12223 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12224
12225 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12226 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12227 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12228 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12229 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12230 of the numbers involved.
12231
12232 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12233 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12234 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12235 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12236 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12237 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12238
12239 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12240 issues.
12241
12242 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12243 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12244
12245 @noindent
12246 @kindex I
12247 @pindex calc-inverse
12248 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12249 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12250 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12251 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12252 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12253
12254 @kindex H
12255 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12256 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12257 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12258 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12259 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12260 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12261 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12262
12263 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12264 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12265 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12266 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12267
12268 @kindex O
12269 @pindex calc-option
12270 The @kbd{O} key (@code{calc-option}) sets another flag, the
12271 @dfn{Option Flag}, which also can alter the subsequent Calc command in
12272 various ways.
12273
12274 The Inverse, Hyperbolic and Option flags apply only to the next
12275 Calculator command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They
12276 are also cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits
12277 you type after @kbd{I}, @kbd{H} or @kbd{O} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as
12278 prefix arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The
12279 same is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means
12280 to subtract and keep arguments).
12281
12282 Another Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12283 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12284
12285 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12286 @section Calculation Modes
12287
12288 @noindent
12289 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12290 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12291 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12292 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12293
12294 @menu
12295 * Angular Modes::
12296 * Polar Mode::
12297 * Fraction Mode::
12298 * Infinite Mode::
12299 * Symbolic Mode::
12300 * Matrix Mode::
12301 * Automatic Recomputation::
12302 * Working Message::
12303 @end menu
12304
12305 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12306 @subsection Angular Modes
12307
12308 @noindent
12309 @cindex Angular mode
12310 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12311 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12312 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12313 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12314 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12315 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12316
12317 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12318 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12319 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12320 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12321 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12322 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12323 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12324
12325 @kindex m r
12326 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12327 @kindex m d
12328 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12329 @kindex m h
12330 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12331 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12332 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12333 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12334 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12335
12336 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12337 @subsection Polar Mode
12338
12339 @noindent
12340 @cindex Polar mode
12341 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12342 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12343 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12344 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12345 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12346
12347 @kindex m p
12348 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12349 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12350 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12351 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12352
12353 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12354 @subsection Fraction Mode
12355
12356 @noindent
12357 @cindex Fraction mode
12358 @cindex Division of integers
12359 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12360 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12361 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12362 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12363 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12364 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12365 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12366
12367 @kindex m f
12368 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12369 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12370 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12371 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12372 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12373 Float mode.
12374
12375 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12376 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12377 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12378
12379 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12380 @subsection Infinite Mode
12381
12382 @noindent
12383 @cindex Infinite mode
12384 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12385 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12386 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12387 results.
12388
12389 @kindex m i
12390 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12391 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12392 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12393 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12394 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12395 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12396 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12397
12398 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12399 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12400 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12401 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12402 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12403 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12404 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12405 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12406
12407 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12408 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12409 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12410 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12411 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12412 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12413 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12414 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12415 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12416 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12417 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12418
12419 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12420 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12421
12422 @noindent
12423 @cindex Symbolic mode
12424 @cindex Inexact results
12425 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12426 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12427 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12428 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12429 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12430
12431 @kindex m s
12432 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12433 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12434 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12435 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12436 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12437
12438 @kindex N
12439 @pindex calc-eval-num
12440 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12441 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12442 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12443 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12444 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12445 of the command.
12446
12447 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12448 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12449 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12450 variables.)
12451
12452 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12453 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12454
12455 @noindent
12456 @cindex Matrix mode
12457 @cindex Scalar mode
12458 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12459 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12460 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12461 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12462
12463 @kindex m v
12464 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12465 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12466 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12467 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12468 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12469 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12470 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12471 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12472 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12473 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12474 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12475 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12476 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12477 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12478 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12479 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12480 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12481 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12482 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12483
12484 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12485 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12486 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12487 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12488 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12489 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12490 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12491
12492 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12493
12494 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12495 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12496 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12497 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12498 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12499 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12500 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12501
12502 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12503 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12504 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12505 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12506 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12507 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12508
12509 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12510 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12511 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12512 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12513 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12514 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12515 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12516
12517 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12518 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12519 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12520 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12521 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12522 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12523
12524 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12525 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12526
12527 @noindent
12528 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12529 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12530 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12531 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12532
12533 @kindex m C
12534 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12535 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12536 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12537 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12538 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12539 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12540 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12541 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12542 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12543
12544 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12545 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12546 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12547
12548 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12549 @subsection Working Messages
12550
12551 @noindent
12552 @cindex Performance
12553 @cindex Working messages
12554 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12555 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12556 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12557 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12558 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12559 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12560 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12561
12562 @kindex m w
12563 @pindex calc-working
12564 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12565 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12566 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12567 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12568 the current mode.
12569
12570 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12571 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12572 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12573 to turn the messages off.
12574
12575 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12576 @section Simplification Modes
12577
12578 @noindent
12579 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12580 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12581 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12582 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12583 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12584 are done automatically but can be turned off when necessary.
12585
12586 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12587 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12588 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12589 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12590
12591 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12592 followed by a shifted letter.
12593
12594 @kindex m O
12595 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12596 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12597 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12598 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12599 in this mode. Explicit simplification commands, such as @kbd{=} or
12600 @kbd{a s}, can still be given to simplify any formulas.
12601 @xref{Algebraic Definitions}, for a sample use of
12602 No-Simplification mode.
12603
12604
12605 @kindex m N
12606 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12607 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12608 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12609 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12610 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12611 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12612 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12613 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12614 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12615 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12616 elements are constant.
12617
12618 @kindex m I
12619 @pindex calc-basic-simplify-mode
12620 The @kbd{m I} (@code{calc-basic-simplify-mode}) command does some basic
12621 simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12622 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12623 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12624 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12625
12626 @kindex m B
12627 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12628 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the basic
12629 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12630 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12631 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12632 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12633 results (after the basic simplifications) are left alone.
12634
12635 @kindex m A
12636 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12637 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does standard
12638 algebraic simplifications. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12639
12640 @kindex m E
12641 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12642 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended'', or
12643 ``unsafe'', algebraic simplification. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12644
12645 @kindex m U
12646 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12647 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12648 simplification. @xref{Simplification of Units}. These include the
12649 algebraic simplifications, plus variable names which
12650 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12651 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12652
12653 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12654 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12655 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12656 perform higher types of simplifications on demand.
12657 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12658 @section Declarations
12659
12660 @noindent
12661 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12662 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12663 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12664 take the fully general situation into account.
12665
12666 @menu
12667 * Declaration Basics::
12668 * Kinds of Declarations::
12669 * Functions for Declarations::
12670 @end menu
12671
12672 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12673 @subsection Declaration Basics
12674
12675 @noindent
12676 @kindex s d
12677 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12678 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12679 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12680 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12681 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12682 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12683 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12684 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12685
12686 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12687 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12688 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12689 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12690 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12691 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12692 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12693 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12694
12695 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12696 @vindex Decls
12697 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12698 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12699 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12700 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12701 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12702 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12703 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12704 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12705 permanently if you wish.
12706
12707 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12708 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12709 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12710 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12711 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12712
12713 For example, the declaration matrix
12714
12715 @smallexample
12716 @group
12717 [ [ foo, real ]
12718 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12719 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12720 @end group
12721 @end smallexample
12722
12723 @noindent
12724 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12725 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12726 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12727
12728 @vindex All
12729 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12730 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12731 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12732 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12733 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12734 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12735 response to the variable-name prompt.
12736
12737 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12738 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12739
12740 @noindent
12741 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12742 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12743 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12744 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12745 for the variable.
12746
12747 @smallexample
12748 @group
12749 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12750 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12751 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12752 @end group
12753 @end smallexample
12754
12755 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12756 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12757 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12758 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12759 nearly equivalent (see below).
12760
12761 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12762 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12763 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12764 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12765
12766 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12767 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12768 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12769 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12770 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12771 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12772
12773 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12774 stored in a variable:
12775
12776 @table @code
12777 @item int
12778 Integers.
12779 @item numint
12780 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12781 @item frac
12782 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12783 @item rat
12784 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12785 @item float
12786 Floating-point numbers.
12787 @item real
12788 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12789 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12790 reals here.)
12791 @item pos
12792 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12793 @item nonneg
12794 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12795 @item number
12796 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12797 @end table
12798
12799 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12800 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12801 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12802 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12803 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12804 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12805 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12806 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12807 of the formula.
12808
12809 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12810 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12811 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12812 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12813 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12814 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12815
12816 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12817 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12818 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12819 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12820 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12821
12822 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12823 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12824 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12825 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12826 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12827 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12828
12829 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12830 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12831 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12832 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12833 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12834 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12835 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12836 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12837 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12838 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12839
12840 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12841 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12842
12843 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12844 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12845 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12846 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12847 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12848 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12849 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12850
12851 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12852 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12853 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12854 type symbol.
12855
12856 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12857 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12858 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12859 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12860 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12861
12862 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12863 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12864 shown above).
12865
12866 Calc's algebraic simplifications also make use of declarations when
12867 simplifying equations and inequalities. They will cancel @code{x}
12868 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12869 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12870 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12871 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12872 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12873 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12874 including canceling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12875 not known to be nonzero.
12876
12877 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12878
12879 @table @code
12880 @item scalar
12881 The value is not a vector.
12882 @item vector
12883 The value is a vector.
12884 @item matrix
12885 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12886 @item sqmatrix
12887 The value is a square matrix.
12888 @end table
12889
12890 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12891 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12892 is a matrix of integers.
12893
12894 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12895 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12896 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12897 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12898 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12899 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12900 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12901 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12902 declarations.)
12903
12904 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12905 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12906 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12907
12908 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12909 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12910
12911 @table @code
12912 @item const
12913 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12914 @end table
12915
12916 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12917 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12918 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12919 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12920 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12921 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12922 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12923 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12924 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12925 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12926
12927 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12928 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12929
12930 @noindent
12931 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12932 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12933 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12934 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12935 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12936 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12937 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12938 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12939 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12940
12941 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12942 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12943 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12944 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12945 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12946
12947 @ignore
12948 @starindex
12949 @end ignore
12950 @tindex dint
12951 @ignore
12952 @starindex
12953 @end ignore
12954 @tindex dnumint
12955 @ignore
12956 @starindex
12957 @end ignore
12958 @tindex dnatnum
12959 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12960 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12961 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12962 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12963 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12964 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12965 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12966 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12967
12968 @ignore
12969 @starindex
12970 @end ignore
12971 @tindex drat
12972 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12973 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12974 and error forms do not.
12975
12976 @ignore
12977 @starindex
12978 @end ignore
12979 @tindex dreal
12980 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12981 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12982
12983 @ignore
12984 @starindex
12985 @end ignore
12986 @tindex dimag
12987 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
12988 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
12989
12990 @ignore
12991 @starindex
12992 @end ignore
12993 @tindex dpos
12994 @ignore
12995 @starindex
12996 @end ignore
12997 @tindex dneg
12998 @ignore
12999 @starindex
13000 @end ignore
13001 @tindex dnonneg
13002 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13003 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13004 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13005 equal to zero. Note that Calc's algebraic simplifications, which are
13006 effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules, can simplify
13007 an expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}.
13008 So the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13009 are rarely necessary.
13010
13011 @ignore
13012 @starindex
13013 @end ignore
13014 @tindex dnonzero
13015 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13016 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13017 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13018 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13019 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13020 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13021 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13022
13023 @ignore
13024 @starindex
13025 @end ignore
13026 @tindex deven
13027 @ignore
13028 @starindex
13029 @end ignore
13030 @tindex dodd
13031 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13032 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13033 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13034 Calc's algebraic simplifications use this to simplify a test of the form
13035 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13036
13037 @ignore
13038 @starindex
13039 @end ignore
13040 @tindex drange
13041 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13042 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13043 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13044 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13045 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13046 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13047 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13048 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13049 remains unevaluated.
13050
13051 @ignore
13052 @starindex
13053 @end ignore
13054 @tindex dscalar
13055 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13056 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13057 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13058 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13059 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13060 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13061 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13062 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13063 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13064 information to tell.
13065
13066 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13067 @section Display Modes
13068
13069 @noindent
13070 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13071 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13072 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13073 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13074 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13075 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13076
13077 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13078 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13079 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13080 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13081 reflect the latest mode settings.
13082
13083 @kindex d @key{RET}
13084 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13085 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13086 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13087 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13088 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13089 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13090 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13091 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13092
13093 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13094 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13095 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13096 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13097
13098 @menu
13099 * Radix Modes::
13100 * Grouping Digits::
13101 * Float Formats::
13102 * Complex Formats::
13103 * Fraction Formats::
13104 * HMS Formats::
13105 * Date Formats::
13106 * Truncating the Stack::
13107 * Justification::
13108 * Labels::
13109 @end menu
13110
13111 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13112 @subsection Radix Modes
13113
13114 @noindent
13115 @cindex Radix display
13116 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13117 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13118 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13119 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13120 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13121 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13122 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13123
13124 @kindex d 2
13125 @kindex d 8
13126 @kindex d 6
13127 @kindex d 0
13128 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13129 @cindex Octal integers
13130 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13131 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13132 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13133 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13134 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13135 as decimal.
13136
13137 @kindex d r
13138 @pindex calc-radix
13139 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13140 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13141 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13142
13143 @kindex d z
13144 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13145 @cindex Leading zeros
13146 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13147 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13148 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13149 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13150 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13151 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13152 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13153 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13154 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13155 entirety.)
13156
13157 @cindex Two's complements
13158 Calc can display @expr{w}-bit integers using two's complement
13159 notation, although this is most useful with the binary, octal and
13160 hexadecimal display modes. This option is selected by using the
13161 @kbd{O} option prefix before setting the display radix, and a negative word
13162 size might be appropriate (@pxref{Binary Functions}). In two's
13163 complement notation, the integers in the (nearly) symmetric interval
13164 from
13165 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13166 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13167 to
13168 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13169 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13170 are represented by the integers from @expr{0} to @expr{2^w-1}:
13171 the integers from @expr{0} to
13172 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13173 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13174 are represented by themselves and the integers from
13175 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13176 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13177 to @expr{-1} are represented by the integers from
13178 @texline @math{2^{w-1}}
13179 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)}
13180 to @expr{2^w-1} (the integer @expr{k} is represented by @expr{k+2^w}).
13181 Calc will display a two's complement integer by the radix (either
13182 @expr{2}, @expr{8} or @expr{16}), two @kbd{#} symbols, and then its
13183 representation (including any leading zeros necessary to include all
13184 @expr{w} bits). In a two's complement display mode, numbers that
13185 are not displayed in two's complement notation (i.e., that aren't
13186 integers from
13187 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13188 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13189 to
13190 @c (
13191 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1})
13192 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1})
13193 will be represented using Calc's usual notation (in the appropriate
13194 radix).
13195
13196 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13197 @subsection Grouping Digits
13198
13199 @noindent
13200 @kindex d g
13201 @pindex calc-group-digits
13202 @cindex Grouping digits
13203 @cindex Digit grouping
13204 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13205 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13206 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13207 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13208 separated by commas.
13209
13210 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13211 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13212 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13213 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13214 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13215 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13216 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13217
13218 @kindex d ,
13219 @pindex calc-group-char
13220 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13221 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13222 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13223 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13224 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13225 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13226 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13227
13228 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13229 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13230 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13231 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13232 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13233
13234 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13235 @subsection Float Formats
13236
13237 @noindent
13238 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13239 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13240 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13241 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13242 formats for floats.
13243
13244 @kindex d n
13245 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13246 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13247 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13248 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13249 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13250 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13251 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13252 current precision is 12.)
13253
13254 @kindex d f
13255 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13256 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13257 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13258 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13259 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13260 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13261 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13262 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13263
13264 @kindex d s
13265 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13266 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13267 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13268 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13269 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13270 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13271 The default is to display all significant digits.
13272
13273 @kindex d e
13274 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13275 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13276 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13277 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13278 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13279 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13280 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13281
13282 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13283 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13284 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13285 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13286 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13287 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13288 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13289 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13290 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13291
13292 @kindex d .
13293 @pindex calc-point-char
13294 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13295 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13296 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13297 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13298 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13299
13300 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13301 @subsection Complex Formats
13302
13303 @noindent
13304 @kindex d c
13305 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13306 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13307 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13308 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13309 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13310
13311 @kindex d i
13312 @pindex calc-i-notation
13313 @kindex d j
13314 @pindex calc-j-notation
13315 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13316 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13317 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13318 in some disciplines.
13319
13320 @cindex @code{i} variable
13321 @vindex i
13322 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13323 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13324 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13325 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13326 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13327 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13328 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13329 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13330
13331 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13332 @subsection Fraction Formats
13333
13334 @noindent
13335 @kindex d o
13336 @pindex calc-over-notation
13337 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13338 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13339 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13340 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13341 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13342 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13343 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13344 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13345
13346 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13347 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13348 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13349 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13350 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13351
13352 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13353 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13354 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13355 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13356 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13357 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13358 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13359 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13360 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13361 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13362 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13363
13364 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13365 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13366 never affects floats.
13367
13368 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13369 @subsection HMS Formats
13370
13371 @noindent
13372 @kindex d h
13373 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13374 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13375 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13376 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13377 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13378 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13379 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13380 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13381
13382 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13383 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13384 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13385 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13386 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13387 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13388 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13389 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13390 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13391 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13392 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13393 entry.
13394
13395 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13396 @subsection Date Formats
13397
13398 @noindent
13399 @kindex d d
13400 @pindex calc-date-notation
13401 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13402 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13403 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13404 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13405 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13406 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13407 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13408 pure dates.
13409
13410 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13411 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13412 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13413 reestablished.
13414
13415 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13416 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13417 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13418
13419 @menu
13420 * Date Formatting Codes::
13421 * Free-Form Dates::
13422 * Standard Date Formats::
13423 @end menu
13424
13425 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13426 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13427
13428 @noindent
13429 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13430 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13431 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13432 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13433 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13434 below.
13435
13436 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13437 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13438 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13439 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13440 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13441 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13442 since Dec 31, 1 BC@. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13443 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13444
13445 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13446
13447 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13448 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13449 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13450 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13451 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13452
13453 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13454
13455 @table @asis
13456 @item Y
13457 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13458 @item YY
13459 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13460 @item BY
13461 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13462 @item YYY
13463 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13464 @item YYYY
13465 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13466 @item aa
13467 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13468 @item AA
13469 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13470 @item aaa
13471 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13472 @item AAA
13473 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13474 @item aaaa
13475 Year: ``a.d.@:'' or blank.
13476 @item AAAA
13477 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13478 @item bb
13479 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13480 @item BB
13481 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13482 @item bbb
13483 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13484 @item BBB
13485 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13486 @item bbbb
13487 Year: ``b.c.@:'' or blank.
13488 @item BBBB
13489 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13490 @item M
13491 Month: ``8'' for August.
13492 @item MM
13493 Month: ``08'' for August.
13494 @item BM
13495 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13496 @item MMM
13497 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13498 @item Mmm
13499 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13500 @item mmm
13501 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13502 @item MMMM
13503 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13504 @item Mmmm
13505 Month: ``August'' for August.
13506 @item D
13507 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13508 @item DD
13509 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13510 @item BD
13511 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13512 @item W
13513 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13514 @item WWW
13515 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13516 @item Www
13517 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13518 @item www
13519 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13520 @item WWWW
13521 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13522 @item Wwww
13523 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13524 @item d
13525 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13526 @item ddd
13527 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13528 @item bdd
13529 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13530 @item h
13531 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13532 @item hh
13533 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13534 @item bh
13535 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13536 @item H
13537 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13538 @item HH
13539 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13540 @item BH
13541 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13542 @item p
13543 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13544 @item P
13545 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13546 @item pp
13547 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13548 @item PP
13549 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13550 @item pppp
13551 AM/PM: ``a.m.@:'' or ``p.m.''.
13552 @item PPPP
13553 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13554 @item m
13555 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13556 @item mm
13557 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13558 @item bm
13559 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13560 @item s
13561 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13562 @item ss
13563 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13564 @item bs
13565 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13566 @item SS
13567 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13568 @item BS
13569 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13570 @item N
13571 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13572 @item n
13573 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13574 @item J
13575 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13576 @item j
13577 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13578 @item U
13579 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13580 @item X
13581 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13582 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13583 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13584 required for algebraic entry.
13585 @end table
13586
13587 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13588 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13589
13590 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13591 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13592 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13593 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13594 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13595
13596 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13597 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13598 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13599 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13600 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13601
13602 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13603 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13604 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13605
13606 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13607 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13608
13609 @noindent
13610 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13611 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13612 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13613 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13614 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13615
13616 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13617 while interpreting dates.
13618
13619 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13620 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13621 the date.
13622
13623 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13624 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13625 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13626 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13627 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13628 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13629 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13630 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13631 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13632 recognized with no number attached.
13633
13634 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13635 format.
13636
13637 To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13638 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13639 be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13640 are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13641 abbreviations.
13642
13643 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13644 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13645 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13646 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13647 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13648 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13649 current year is taken from the system clock.
13650
13651 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13652 words, then the input is rejected.
13653
13654 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13655 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13656 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13657 date components when the date was formatted.
13658
13659 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13660 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13661 minus sign on the year value.
13662
13663 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13664 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13665
13666 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13667 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13668
13669 @noindent
13670 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13671 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13672 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13673 to select the other formats.
13674
13675 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13676 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13677 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13678 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13679 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13680 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13681
13682 @table @asis
13683 @item 0
13684 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13685 @item 1
13686 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13687 @item 2
13688 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13689 @item 3
13690 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13691 @item 4
13692 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13693 @item 5
13694 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13695 @item 6
13696 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13697 @item 7
13698 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13699 @item 8
13700 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13701 @item 9
13702 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13703 @end table
13704
13705 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13706 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13707
13708 @noindent
13709 @kindex d t
13710 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13711 @cindex Truncating the stack
13712 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13713 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13714 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13715 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13716 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13717 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13718 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13719 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13720 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13721 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13722 the stack.
13723
13724 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13725 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13726 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13727 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13728 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13729 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13730 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13731
13732 @kindex d [
13733 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13734 @kindex d ]
13735 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13736 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13737 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13738 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13739
13740 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13741 @subsection Justification
13742
13743 @noindent
13744 @kindex d <
13745 @pindex calc-left-justify
13746 @kindex d =
13747 @pindex calc-center-justify
13748 @kindex d >
13749 @pindex calc-right-justify
13750 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13751 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13752 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13753 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13754 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13755 window.
13756
13757 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13758 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13759 text.
13760
13761 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13762 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13763 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13764
13765 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13766 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13767 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13768 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13769 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13770 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13771 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13772 mode.
13773
13774 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13775 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13776 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13777 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13778 line is indented to the origin.
13779
13780 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13781 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13782 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13783 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13784 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13785 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13786
13787 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13788 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13789 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13790 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13791 line width or Calc window width is used.
13792
13793 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13794 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13795 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13796 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13797 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13798 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13799 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13800
13801 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13802 @subsection Labels
13803
13804 @noindent
13805 @kindex d @{
13806 @pindex calc-left-label
13807 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13808 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13809 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13810 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13811 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13812 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13813 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13814
13815 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13816
13817 @kindex d @}
13818 @pindex calc-right-label
13819 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13820 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13821 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13822 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13823 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13824 justified to the line width.
13825
13826 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13827 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13828 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13829 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13830 left or right as you prefer.
13831
13832 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13833 @section Language Modes
13834
13835 @noindent
13836 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13837 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13838 other common language such as Pascal or @LaTeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13839 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13840 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13841 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13842
13843 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13844 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13845 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13846 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13847
13848 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13849 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13850 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13851 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13852 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13853 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13854 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13855 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13856
13857 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13858 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13859 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13860 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13861 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13862
13863 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a @LaTeX{}
13864 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13865 formula from the program in C mode, switch to @LaTeX{} mode, and yank the
13866 formula into the document in @LaTeX{} math-mode format.
13867
13868 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13869 shifted letter key.
13870
13871 @menu
13872 * Normal Language Modes::
13873 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13874 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13875 * Eqn Language Mode::
13876 * Yacas Language Mode::
13877 * Maxima Language Mode::
13878 * Giac Language Mode::
13879 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13880 * Maple Language Mode::
13881 * Compositions::
13882 * Syntax Tables::
13883 @end menu
13884
13885 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13886 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13887
13888 @noindent
13889 @kindex d N
13890 @pindex calc-normal-language
13891 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13892 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13893 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13894 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13895 keyboard.
13896
13897 @kindex d O
13898 @pindex calc-flat-language
13899 @cindex Matrix display
13900 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13901 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13902 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13903 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13904
13905 @kindex d b
13906 @pindex calc-line-breaking
13907 @cindex Line breaking
13908 @cindex Breaking up long lines
13909 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13910 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13911 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13912 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13913 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13914 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13915 long lines.
13916
13917 @kindex d B
13918 @pindex calc-big-language
13919 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
13920 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
13921 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
13922
13923 @example
13924 ____________
13925 | a + 1 2
13926 | ----- + c
13927 \| b
13928 @end example
13929
13930 @noindent
13931 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
13932
13933 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
13934 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
13935 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
13936 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
13937 notation.
13938
13939 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
13940
13941 @example
13942 3
13943 - -
13944 4
13945 @end example
13946
13947 @noindent
13948 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
13949 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
13950 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
13951 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
13952 typical use.
13953
13954 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
13955 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
13956 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
13957 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
13958 in Big mode.
13959
13960 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
13961 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
13962 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
13963 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
13964 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
13965
13966 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
13967 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
13968 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
13969 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
13970
13971 @kindex d U
13972 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
13973 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
13974 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
13975 shown above would be displayed:
13976
13977 @example
13978 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
13979 @end example
13980
13981 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
13982 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
13983 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
13984 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
13985 parentheses).
13986
13987 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
13988 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
13989
13990 @noindent
13991 @kindex d C
13992 @pindex calc-c-language
13993 @cindex C language
13994 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
13995 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
13996 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
13997 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
13998 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
13999 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
14000 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
14001
14002 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
14003 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
14004 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
14005 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
14006 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
14007 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
14008 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
14009
14010 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
14011 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
14012 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
14013 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
14014 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14015 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14016 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14017 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14018
14019 @kindex d P
14020 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14021 @cindex Pascal language
14022 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14023 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14024 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14025 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14026 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14027 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
14028 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14029 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14030 of handling these in Pascal.
14031
14032 @kindex d F
14033 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14034 @cindex FORTRAN language
14035 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14036 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14037 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14038 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14039 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14040 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14041 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14042 If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14043 @code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
14044 parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
14045 matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
14046 Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
14047 unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
14048 actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14049 function!).
14050
14051 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14052 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14053 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14054
14055 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14056 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14057 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14058 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14059 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14060 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14061
14062 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14063 @subsection @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} Language Modes
14064
14065 @noindent
14066 @kindex d T
14067 @pindex calc-tex-language
14068 @cindex TeX language
14069 @kindex d L
14070 @pindex calc-latex-language
14071 @cindex LaTeX language
14072 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14073 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14074 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14075 conventions of ``math mode'' in @LaTeX{}, a typesetting language that
14076 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's @LaTeX{} language mode can
14077 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although @LaTeX{}
14078 mode may display it differently.
14079
14080 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14081 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14082 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14083 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14084 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in @LaTeX{} mode.
14085 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14086 @LaTeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14087 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14088 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14089
14090 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14091 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14092 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in
14093 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14094 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14095 @code{\binom} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14096 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14097 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14098 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14099 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14100 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14101 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14102 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14103
14104 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14105 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14106 and @LaTeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14107 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14108 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14109 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14110 printed result is
14111 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14112 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14113 but
14114 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14115 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14116
14117 The @TeX{} specific unit names (@pxref{Predefined Units}) will not use
14118 the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
14119 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example.
14120
14121 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14122 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14123 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14124 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14125 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14126 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14127 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14128 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in @LaTeX{} mode. The
14129 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14130 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14131 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14132 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14133 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14134 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14135 any @TeX{} mode.)
14136
14137 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14138 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14139 @code{\bmatrix}. In @LaTeX{} mode this also applies to
14140 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14141 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14142 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14143 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14144 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14145 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14146 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14147 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14148 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14149 @LaTeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14150 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14151 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14152 form, such as
14153
14154 @example
14155 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14156 a & b \\
14157 c & d
14158 \end@{pmatrix@}
14159 @end example
14160
14161 @noindent
14162 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14163 expressions being displayed like
14164
14165 @example
14166 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14167 a & b \\
14168 c & d
14169 \end@{pmatrix@}
14170 @end example
14171
14172 @noindent
14173 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect @LaTeX{}.
14174 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14175
14176 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14177 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14178 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14179 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14180 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14181 in Calc, @TeX{}, @LaTeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14182
14183 @ignore
14184 @iftex
14185 @begingroup
14186 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14187 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14188 @end iftex
14189 @starindex
14190 @end ignore
14191 @tindex acute
14192 @ignore
14193 @starindex
14194 @end ignore
14195 @tindex Acute
14196 @ignore
14197 @starindex
14198 @end ignore
14199 @tindex bar
14200 @ignore
14201 @starindex
14202 @end ignore
14203 @tindex Bar
14204 @ignore
14205 @starindex
14206 @end ignore
14207 @tindex breve
14208 @ignore
14209 @starindex
14210 @end ignore
14211 @tindex Breve
14212 @ignore
14213 @starindex
14214 @end ignore
14215 @tindex check
14216 @ignore
14217 @starindex
14218 @end ignore
14219 @tindex Check
14220 @ignore
14221 @starindex
14222 @end ignore
14223 @tindex dddot
14224 @ignore
14225 @starindex
14226 @end ignore
14227 @tindex ddddot
14228 @ignore
14229 @starindex
14230 @end ignore
14231 @tindex dot
14232 @ignore
14233 @starindex
14234 @end ignore
14235 @tindex Dot
14236 @ignore
14237 @starindex
14238 @end ignore
14239 @tindex dotdot
14240 @ignore
14241 @starindex
14242 @end ignore
14243 @tindex DotDot
14244 @ignore
14245 @starindex
14246 @end ignore
14247 @tindex dyad
14248 @ignore
14249 @starindex
14250 @end ignore
14251 @tindex grave
14252 @ignore
14253 @starindex
14254 @end ignore
14255 @tindex Grave
14256 @ignore
14257 @starindex
14258 @end ignore
14259 @tindex hat
14260 @ignore
14261 @starindex
14262 @end ignore
14263 @tindex Hat
14264 @ignore
14265 @starindex
14266 @end ignore
14267 @tindex Prime
14268 @ignore
14269 @starindex
14270 @end ignore
14271 @tindex tilde
14272 @ignore
14273 @starindex
14274 @end ignore
14275 @tindex Tilde
14276 @ignore
14277 @starindex
14278 @end ignore
14279 @tindex under
14280 @ignore
14281 @starindex
14282 @end ignore
14283 @tindex Vec
14284 @ignore
14285 @starindex
14286 @end ignore
14287 @tindex VEC
14288 @ignore
14289 @iftex
14290 @endgroup
14291 @end iftex
14292 @end ignore
14293 @example
14294 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14295 ---- --- ----- ---
14296 acute \acute \acute
14297 Acute \Acute
14298 bar \bar \bar bar
14299 Bar \Bar
14300 breve \breve \breve
14301 Breve \Breve
14302 check \check \check
14303 Check \Check
14304 dddot \dddot
14305 ddddot \ddddot
14306 dot \dot \dot dot
14307 Dot \Dot
14308 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14309 DotDot \Ddot
14310 dyad dyad
14311 grave \grave \grave
14312 Grave \Grave
14313 hat \hat \hat hat
14314 Hat \Hat
14315 Prime prime
14316 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14317 Tilde \Tilde
14318 under \underline \underline under
14319 Vec \vec \vec vec
14320 VEC \Vec
14321 @end example
14322
14323 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14324 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14325 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14326 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14327 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14328 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14329 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14330 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14331
14332 @example
14333 \def\evalto@{@}
14334 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14335 @end example
14336
14337 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14338 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14339 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14340 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14341 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14342 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14343
14344 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14345 reading is:
14346
14347 @example
14348 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14349 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14350 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14351 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14352 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14353 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14354 \evalto
14355 @end example
14356
14357 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14358 @LaTeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14359 font information.
14360
14361 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14362 the same as @samp{*}.
14363
14364 @ifnottex
14365 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14366 end of this section.
14367 @end ifnottex
14368 @iftex
14369 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14370
14371 @example
14372 @group
14373 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14374 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14375 @end group
14376 @end example
14377 @tex
14378 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14379 @end tex
14380 @sp 1
14381
14382 @example
14383 @group
14384 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14385 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14386 @end group
14387 @end example
14388 @tex
14389 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14390 @end tex
14391 @sp 1
14392
14393 @example
14394 @group
14395 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14396 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14397 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14398 @end group
14399 @end example
14400 @tex
14401 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14402 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14403 @end tex
14404 @sp 1
14405
14406 @example
14407 @group
14408 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14409 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14410 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14411 @end group
14412 @end example
14413 @tex
14414 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14415 @end tex
14416 @sp 2
14417
14418 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14419 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14420 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14421
14422 @example
14423 @group
14424 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14425 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14426 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14427 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14428 @end group
14429 @end example
14430 @tex
14431 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14432 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14433 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14434 @end tex
14435 @sp 2
14436
14437 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14438
14439 @example
14440 @group
14441 2 + 3 => 5
14442 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14443 @end group
14444 @end example
14445 @tex
14446 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14447 $$ 5 $$
14448 @end tex
14449 @sp 2
14450
14451 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14452
14453 @example
14454 @group
14455 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14456 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14457 @end group
14458 @end example
14459 @tex
14460 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14461 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14462 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14463 @end tex
14464 @sp 2
14465
14466 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14467
14468 @example
14469 @group
14470 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14471 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14472 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14473 @end group
14474 @end example
14475 @tex
14476 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14477 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14478 @end tex
14479 @sp 2
14480 @end iftex
14481
14482 @node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14483 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14484
14485 @noindent
14486 @kindex d E
14487 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14488 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14489 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14490 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14491 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14492
14493 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14494 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14495 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14496 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14497 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14498 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14499
14500 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14501 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14502 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14503 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14504 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14505 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14506 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14507
14508 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14509 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14510 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14511 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14512 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14513 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14514 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14515 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14516 names, too.)
14517
14518 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14519 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14520 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14521 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14522 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14523
14524 As in @LaTeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14525 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14526 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14527 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14528
14529 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14530 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14531 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14532 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14533 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14534 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14535 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14536
14537 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14538 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14539 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14540 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14541 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14542 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14543 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14544 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14545
14546 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14547 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14548 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14549 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14550 recognized for these operators during reading.
14551
14552 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14553 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14554 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14555 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14556 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14557
14558 @node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14559 @subsection Yacas Language Mode
14560
14561 @noindent
14562 @kindex d Y
14563 @pindex calc-yacas-language
14564 @cindex Yacas language
14565 The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14566 conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14567 operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14568 of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14569 @samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14570 in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14571 mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14572 The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14573 @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14574 represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14575 represents @code{nan}.
14576
14577 Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14578 and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14579 example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14580 @w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14581
14582 Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14583 are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14584 use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14585 @samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14586
14587
14588 @node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14589 @subsection Maxima Language Mode
14590
14591 @noindent
14592 @kindex d X
14593 @pindex calc-maxima-language
14594 @cindex Maxima language
14595 The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14596 conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14597 function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14598 For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14599 @samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14600 standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14601 @code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14602 the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14603
14604 Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14605 variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14606 the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14607 @samp{o'o}.
14608
14609 Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14610 written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14611 the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14612
14613 @node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14614 @subsection Giac Language Mode
14615
14616 @noindent
14617 @kindex d A
14618 @pindex calc-giac-language
14619 @cindex Giac language
14620 The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14621 conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14622 names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14623 @samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14624 in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14625 and @code{uinf}.
14626
14627 Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14628 Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
14629 0, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14630 @samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14631 @samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14632
14633 The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14634 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14635 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14636 the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14637
14638 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
14639 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14640
14641 @noindent
14642 @kindex d M
14643 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14644 @cindex Mathematica language
14645 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14646 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14647 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14648 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14649 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14650 Mathematica mode.
14651
14652 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14653 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14654 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14655 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14656 Mathematica mode.
14657 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14658 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14659 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14660
14661 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14662 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14663
14664 @noindent
14665 @kindex d W
14666 @pindex calc-maple-language
14667 @cindex Maple language
14668 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14669 conventions of Maple.
14670
14671 Maple's language is much like C@. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14672 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14673 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14674 denote powers.
14675
14676 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14677 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14678 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14679 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14680 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14681 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14682
14683 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14684 notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
14685
14686 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14687 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14688 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14689 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14690
14691 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14692 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14693 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14694
14695 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14696 @subsection Compositions
14697
14698 @noindent
14699 @cindex Compositions
14700 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14701 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14702 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14703 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14704 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14705
14706 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14707 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14708 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14709 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14710 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14711 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14712 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14713 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14714
14715 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14716 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14717 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14718 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14719 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14720 the language modes.
14721
14722 @menu
14723 * Composition Basics::
14724 * Horizontal Compositions::
14725 * Vertical Compositions::
14726 * Other Compositions::
14727 * Information about Compositions::
14728 * User-Defined Compositions::
14729 @end menu
14730
14731 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14732 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14733
14734 @noindent
14735 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14736 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14737 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14738 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14739 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14740 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14741 For example, in the Big mode formula
14742
14743 @example
14744 @group
14745 2
14746 a + b
14747 17 + ------
14748 c
14749 @end group
14750 @end example
14751
14752 @noindent
14753 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14754 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14755 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14756
14757 @tex
14758 \bigskip
14759 @end tex
14760
14761 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14762 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14763 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14764 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14765 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14766
14767 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14768 following precedences:
14769
14770 @example
14771 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14772 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14773 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14774 mod 400
14775 +/- 300
14776 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14777 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14778 ^ 200
14779 - 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14780 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14781 / % \ 190
14782 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14783 | 170
14784 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14785 && 110
14786 || 100
14787 ? : 90
14788 !!! 85
14789 &&& 80
14790 ||| 75
14791 := 50
14792 :: 45
14793 => 40
14794 @end example
14795
14796 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14797 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14798 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14799 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14800 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14801 normally never get additional parentheses).
14802
14803 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14804 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14805 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14806 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14807 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14808 with one-higher precedence.
14809
14810 @ignore
14811 @starindex
14812 @end ignore
14813 @tindex cprec
14814 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14815 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14816 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14817 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14818 precedence than multiplication).
14819
14820 @tex
14821 \bigskip
14822 @end tex
14823
14824 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14825 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14826 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14827 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14828 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14829 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14830 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14831 view them.
14832
14833 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14834 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14835 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14836 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14837 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14838 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14839 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14840 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14841 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14842
14843 @example
14844 @group
14845 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14846 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14847 @end group
14848 @end example
14849
14850 @noindent
14851 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14852 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14853 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14854 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14855 itself been too large to fit.
14856
14857 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14858 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14859 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14860 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14861 end of the string.
14862
14863 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14864 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14865 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14866 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14867 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14868 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14869 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14870 object.
14871
14872 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14873 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14874
14875 @noindent
14876 @ignore
14877 @starindex
14878 @end ignore
14879 @tindex choriz
14880 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14881 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14882 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14883
14884 @example
14885 @group
14886 a b
14887 17---d
14888 c
14889 @end group
14890 @end example
14891
14892 @noindent
14893 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14894 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14895 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14896 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14897 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14898 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14899
14900 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14901 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14902 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14903 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14904 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14905 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14906
14907 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14908 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14909 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14910 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14911 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14912
14913 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14914 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14915
14916 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14917 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14918
14919 @noindent
14920 @ignore
14921 @starindex
14922 @end ignore
14923 @tindex cvert
14924 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14925 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14926 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14927 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14928 formats in Big mode as
14929
14930 @example
14931 @group
14932 f( a , 2 )
14933 bb a + 1
14934 ccc 2
14935 b
14936 @end group
14937 @end example
14938
14939 @ignore
14940 @starindex
14941 @end ignore
14942 @tindex cbase
14943 There are several special composition functions that work only as
14944 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14945 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14946 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14947 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14948 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14949
14950 @example
14951 @group
14952 2
14953 a + 1
14954 a 2
14955 f(bb , b )
14956 ccc
14957 @end group
14958 @end example
14959
14960 @ignore
14961 @starindex
14962 @end ignore
14963 @tindex ctbase
14964 @ignore
14965 @starindex
14966 @end ignore
14967 @tindex cbbase
14968 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14969 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14970 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14971 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14972 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14973
14974 @example
14975 @group
14976 a
14977 a -
14978 - + a + b
14979 b -
14980 b
14981 @end group
14982 @end example
14983
14984 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14985 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14986 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14987 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14988 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14989 item.
14990
14991 @ignore
14992 @starindex
14993 @end ignore
14994 @tindex crule
14995 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
14996 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
14997 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
14998 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
14999 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
15000 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
15001 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
15002
15003 @example
15004 @group
15005 a + 1
15006 =====
15007 2
15008 b
15009 @end group
15010 @end example
15011
15012 @ignore
15013 @starindex
15014 @end ignore
15015 @tindex clvert
15016 @ignore
15017 @starindex
15018 @end ignore
15019 @tindex crvert
15020 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15021 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15022 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15023 gives:
15024
15025 @example
15026 @group
15027 a + a
15028 bb bb
15029 ccc ccc
15030 @end group
15031 @end example
15032
15033 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15034 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15035 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15036
15037 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15038 @subsubsection Other Compositions
15039
15040 @noindent
15041 @ignore
15042 @starindex
15043 @end ignore
15044 @tindex csup
15045 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15046 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15047 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15048 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15049 bottom line is one above the baseline.
15050
15051 @ignore
15052 @starindex
15053 @end ignore
15054 @tindex csub
15055 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15056 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15057 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15058 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15059 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15060
15061 @ignore
15062 @starindex
15063 @end ignore
15064 @tindex cflat
15065 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15066 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15067 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15068 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15069 to improve its readability.
15070
15071 @ignore
15072 @starindex
15073 @end ignore
15074 @tindex cspace
15075 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15076 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15077 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15078 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15079 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15080 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15081 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15082
15083 @example
15084 @group
15085 2 2 2 2
15086 a a a a
15087 @end group
15088 @end example
15089
15090 @noindent
15091 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15092
15093 @ignore
15094 @starindex
15095 @end ignore
15096 @tindex cvspace
15097 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15098 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15099 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15100 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15101 height if used in a vertical composition.
15102
15103 @ignore
15104 @starindex
15105 @end ignore
15106 @tindex ctspace
15107 @ignore
15108 @starindex
15109 @end ignore
15110 @tindex cbspace
15111 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15112 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15113 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15114 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15115 displays as:
15116
15117 @example
15118 @group
15119 a
15120 -
15121 a b
15122 - a a
15123 b + - + -
15124 a b b
15125 - a
15126 b -
15127 b
15128 @end group
15129 @end example
15130
15131 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15132 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15133
15134 @noindent
15135 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15136 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15137 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15138
15139 @ignore
15140 @starindex
15141 @end ignore
15142 @tindex cwidth
15143 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15144 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15145 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15146 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15147 the composition functions described in this section.
15148
15149 @ignore
15150 @starindex
15151 @end ignore
15152 @tindex cheight
15153 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15154 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15155
15156 @ignore
15157 @starindex
15158 @end ignore
15159 @tindex cascent
15160 @ignore
15161 @starindex
15162 @end ignore
15163 @tindex cdescent
15164 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15165 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15166 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15167 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15168 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15169 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15170 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15171 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15172
15173 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15174 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15175
15176 @noindent
15177 @kindex Z C
15178 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15179 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15180 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15181 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15182 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15183 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15184 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15185 replaced.
15186
15187 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15188 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15189 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15190 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15191 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15192 affect the display at all.
15193
15194 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15195 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15196 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15197 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15198 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15199 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15200 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15201 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15202 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15203 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15204
15205 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15206 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15207 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15208
15209 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15210 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15211
15212 @example
15213 @group
15214 n
15215 ( )
15216 m
15217 @end group
15218 @end example
15219
15220 @noindent
15221 You might prefer the notation,
15222
15223 @example
15224 @group
15225 C
15226 n m
15227 @end group
15228 @end example
15229
15230 @noindent
15231 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15232 then put the formula
15233
15234 @smallexample
15235 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15236 @end smallexample
15237
15238 @noindent
15239 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15240 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15241 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15242 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15243 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15244 as an algebraic entry.
15245
15246 @example
15247 @group
15248 C + C
15249 a b 7 3
15250 @end group
15251 @end example
15252
15253 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15254 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15255 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15256 instead of parentheses.
15257
15258 @smallexample
15259 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15260 @end smallexample
15261
15262 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15263 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15264
15265 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15266 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15267 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15268 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15269 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15270 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15271 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15272 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15273 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15274 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15275 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15276 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15277
15278 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15279 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15280 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15281 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15282 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15283 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15284 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15285 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15286 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15287 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15288 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15289 symbolic form.
15290
15291 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15292 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15293 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15294 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15295 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15296 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15297 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15298 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15299 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15300
15301 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15302 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15303
15304 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15305 @subsection Syntax Tables
15306
15307 @noindent
15308 @cindex Syntax tables
15309 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15310 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15311 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15312 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15313
15314 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15315 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15316
15317 @kindex Z S
15318 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15319 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15320 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15321 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15322 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15323 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15324 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15325 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15326
15327 @menu
15328 * Syntax Table Basics::
15329 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15330 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15331 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15332 @end menu
15333
15334 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15335 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15336
15337 @noindent
15338 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15339 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15340 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15341 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15342 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15343 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15344 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15345 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15346 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15347 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15348
15349 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15350 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15351 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15352 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15353 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15354 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15355 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15356 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15357 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15358 completely different.)
15359
15360 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15361 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15362 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15363
15364 @example
15365 foo ( ) := 2+3
15366 @end example
15367
15368 @noindent
15369 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15370 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15371 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15372 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15373 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15374 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15375 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15376 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15377 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15378 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15379 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15380 calls would no longer recognize it!
15381
15382 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15383 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15384 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15385
15386 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15387 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15388 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15389 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15390 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15391 and postfix operator, respectively:
15392
15393 @example
15394 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15395 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15396 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15397 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15398 @end example
15399
15400 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15401 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15402
15403 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15404 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15405 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15406 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15407 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15408 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15409 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15410 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15411 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15412 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15413 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15414 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15415
15416 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15417 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15418 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15419 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15420 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15421 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15422 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15423 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15424
15425 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15426 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15427 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15428 rule,
15429
15430 @example
15431 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15432 @end example
15433
15434 @noindent
15435 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15436 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15437 define these operators quite easily:
15438
15439 @example
15440 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15441 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15442 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15443 @end example
15444
15445 @noindent
15446 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15447 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15448 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15449 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15450
15451 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15452 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15453
15454 @example
15455 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15456 @end example
15457
15458 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15459 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15460 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15461 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15462 backslashes in tokens.)
15463
15464 @example
15465 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15466 @end example
15467
15468 @noindent
15469 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15470
15471 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15472 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15473 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15474 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15475 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15476 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15477 respectively).
15478
15479 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15480 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15481
15482 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15483 @subsubsection Precedence
15484
15485 @noindent
15486 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15487 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15488
15489 @example
15490 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15491 @end example
15492
15493 @noindent
15494 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15495 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15496 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15497 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15498 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15499 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15500
15501 @example
15502 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15503 @end example
15504
15505 @noindent
15506 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15507 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15508 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15509 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15510 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15511 can create a right-associative operator.
15512
15513 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15514 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15515 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15516
15517 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15518 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15519
15520 @noindent
15521 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15522 write
15523
15524 @example
15525 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15526 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15527 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15528 @end example
15529
15530 @noindent
15531 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15532 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15533 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15534
15535 @example
15536 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15537 @end example
15538
15539 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15540 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15541 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15542 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15543 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15544 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15545 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15546 several expressions separated by commas.
15547
15548 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15549 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15550 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15551 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15552 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15553 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15554
15555 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15556 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15557 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15558 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15559 always be an empty vector.
15560
15561 @example
15562 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15563 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15564 @end example
15565
15566 @noindent
15567 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15568 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15569 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15570 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15571 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15572
15573 @example
15574 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15575 @end example
15576
15577 @noindent
15578 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15579 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15580
15581 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15582 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15583 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15584
15585 @example
15586 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15587 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15588 @end example
15589
15590 @noindent
15591 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15592 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15593 empty vector is produced.
15594
15595 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15596 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15597 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15598 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15599 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15600 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15601 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15602 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15603 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15604 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15605 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15606 as optional.
15607
15608 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15609 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15610
15611 @example
15612 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15613 @end example
15614
15615 @noindent
15616 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15617 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15618 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15619 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15620 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15621 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15622 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15623
15624 @example
15625 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15626 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15627 @end example
15628
15629 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15630 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15631 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15632 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15633 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15634 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15635 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15636
15637 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15638 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15639
15640 @noindent
15641 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15642 example, the rules
15643
15644 @example
15645 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15646 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15647 @end example
15648
15649 @noindent
15650 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15651 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15652 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15653 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15654 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15655 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15656
15657 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15658 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15659 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15660 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15661 using the algebraic simplifications (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15662 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15663 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15664 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15665 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15666 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15667 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15668
15669 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15670 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15671 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15672 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15673 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15674 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15675
15676 @example
15677 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15678 @end example
15679
15680 @noindent
15681 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15682 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15683 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15684 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15685
15686 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15687 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15688 rules.
15689
15690 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15691 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15692 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15693 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15694 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15695 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15696
15697 @example
15698 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15699 @end example
15700
15701 @noindent
15702 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15703 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15704 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15705 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15706 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15707 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15708 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15709 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15710
15711 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15712 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15713
15714 @noindent
15715 @kindex m g
15716 @pindex calc-get-modes
15717 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15718 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15719 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15720 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15721 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15722 on the current mode settings.
15723
15724 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15725 @vindex Modes
15726 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15727 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15728 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15729 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15730 command will continue to work, however.)
15731
15732 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15733 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15734 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15735 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15736
15737 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15738
15739 @enumerate
15740 @item
15741 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15742
15743 @item
15744 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15745
15746 @item
15747 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15748 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15749
15750 @item
15751 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15752
15753 @item
15754 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15755 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15756 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15757 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15758 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15759 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15760 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15761 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15762 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15763 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15764
15765 @item
15766 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15767 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15768
15769 @item
15770 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15771
15772 @item
15773 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15774
15775 @item
15776 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15777 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15778
15779 @item
15780 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15781 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15782 or @var{N} for
15783 @texline @math{N\times N}
15784 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15785 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15786
15787 @item
15788 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15789 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15790 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15791
15792 @item
15793 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15794 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15795 @end enumerate
15796
15797 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15798 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15799 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15800 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15801 keyboard macro.)
15802
15803 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15804 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15805
15806 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15807 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15808 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15809 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15810 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15811 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15812
15813 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15814 @section The Calc Mode Line
15815
15816 @noindent
15817 @cindex Mode line indicators
15818 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15819 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15820 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15821
15822 The basic mode line format is:
15823
15824 @example
15825 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15826 @end example
15827
15828 The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
15829 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15830 as if it were text.
15831
15832 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15833 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15834 that are in effect.
15835
15836 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15837 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15838 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15839
15840 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15841 on the mode line:
15842
15843 @table @code
15844 @item Alg
15845 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15846
15847 @item Alg[(
15848 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15849
15850 @item Alg*
15851 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15852
15853 @item Symb
15854 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15855
15856 @item Matrix
15857 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15858
15859 @item Matrix@var{n}
15860 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15861
15862 @item SqMatrix
15863 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15864
15865 @item Scalar
15866 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15867
15868 @item Polar
15869 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15870
15871 @item Frac
15872 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15873
15874 @item Inf
15875 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15876
15877 @item +Inf
15878 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15879
15880 @item NoSimp
15881 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15882
15883 @item NumSimp
15884 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15885
15886 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15887 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15888
15889 @item BasicSimp
15890 Basic simplification mode (@kbd{m I}).
15891
15892 @item ExtSimp
15893 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15894
15895 @item UnitSimp
15896 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15897
15898 @item Bin
15899 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15900
15901 @item Oct
15902 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15903
15904 @item Hex
15905 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15906
15907 @item Radix@var{n}
15908 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15909
15910 @item Zero
15911 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15912
15913 @item Big
15914 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15915
15916 @item Flat
15917 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15918
15919 @item Unform
15920 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15921
15922 @item C
15923 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15924
15925 @item Pascal
15926 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15927
15928 @item Fortran
15929 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15930
15931 @item TeX
15932 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15933
15934 @item LaTeX
15935 @LaTeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15936
15937 @item Eqn
15938 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15939
15940 @item Math
15941 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15942
15943 @item Maple
15944 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15945
15946 @item Norm@var{n}
15947 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15948
15949 @item Fix@var{n}
15950 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15951
15952 @item Sci
15953 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15954
15955 @item Sci@var{n}
15956 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15957
15958 @item Eng
15959 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15960
15961 @item Eng@var{n}
15962 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15963
15964 @item Left@var{n}
15965 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15966
15967 @item Right
15968 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15969
15970 @item Right@var{n}
15971 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15972
15973 @item Center
15974 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15975
15976 @item Center@var{n}
15977 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15978
15979 @item Wid@var{n}
15980 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15981
15982 @item Wide
15983 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15984
15985 @item Break
15986 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15987
15988 @item Save
15989 Record modes in @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15990
15991 @item Local
15992 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15993
15994 @item LocEdit
15995 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15996
15997 @item LocPerm
15998 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15999
16000 @item Global
16001 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16002
16003 @item Manual
16004 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
16005 Recomputation}).
16006
16007 @item Graph
16008 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
16009
16010 @item Sel
16011 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16012
16013 @item Dirty
16014 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
16015
16016 @item Inv
16017 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
16018
16019 @item Hyp
16020 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16021
16022 @item Keep
16023 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16024
16025 @item Narrow
16026 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16027 @end table
16028
16029 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16030 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16031
16032 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16033 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
16034
16035 @noindent
16036 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16037 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16038 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16039 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16040 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16041 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16042 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16043
16044 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16045 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16046 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16047
16048 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16049 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16050 interpret a prefix argument.
16051
16052 @menu
16053 * Basic Arithmetic::
16054 * Integer Truncation::
16055 * Complex Number Functions::
16056 * Conversions::
16057 * Date Arithmetic::
16058 * Financial Functions::
16059 * Binary Functions::
16060 @end menu
16061
16062 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16063 @section Basic Arithmetic
16064
16065 @noindent
16066 @kindex +
16067 @pindex calc-plus
16068 @ignore
16069 @mindex @null
16070 @end ignore
16071 @tindex +
16072 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16073 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16074 onto the stack.
16075
16076 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16077 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16078 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16079 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16080 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16081 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16082 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16083 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16084 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16085 to every element of a vector.
16086
16087 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16088 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16089 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16090 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16091 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16092
16093 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16094 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16095 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16096 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16097 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16098
16099 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16100 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16101 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16102 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16103 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16104 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16105 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16106 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16107
16108 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16109 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16110 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16111 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16112 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16113 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16114 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16115 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16116
16117 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16118 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16119 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16120 the two values.
16121
16122 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16123 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16124 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16125 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16126
16127 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16128 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16129 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16130 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16131
16132 @kindex -
16133 @pindex calc-minus
16134 @ignore
16135 @mindex @null
16136 @end ignore
16137 @tindex -
16138 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16139 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16140 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16141 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16142
16143 @kindex *
16144 @pindex calc-times
16145 @ignore
16146 @mindex @null
16147 @end ignore
16148 @tindex *
16149 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16150 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16151 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16152 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16153 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16154 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16155 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16156 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16157 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16158
16159 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16160 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16161 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16162 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16163 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16164 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16165 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16166 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16167
16168 @kindex /
16169 @pindex calc-divide
16170 @ignore
16171 @mindex @null
16172 @end ignore
16173 @tindex /
16174 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16175
16176 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16177 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16178 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16179 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16180 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16181 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16182 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16183 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16184 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16185 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16186 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16187 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16188 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16189 @smallexample
16190 @group
16191 a b
16192 ---.
16193 c d
16194 @end group
16195 @end smallexample
16196
16197 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16198 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16199 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16200 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16201 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16202 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16203 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16204 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16205 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16206 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16207 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16208 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16209 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16210 transpose the result.
16211
16212 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16213 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16214 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16215 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16216 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16217 interval.
16218
16219 @kindex ^
16220 @pindex calc-power
16221 @ignore
16222 @mindex @null
16223 @end ignore
16224 @tindex ^
16225 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16226 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16227 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16228 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16229 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16230 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16231
16232 @kindex I ^
16233 @tindex nroot
16234 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16235 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16236 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16237
16238 @kindex \
16239 @pindex calc-idiv
16240 @tindex idiv
16241 @ignore
16242 @mindex @null
16243 @end ignore
16244 @tindex \
16245 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16246 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16247 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16248 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16249 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16250 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16251
16252 @kindex %
16253 @pindex calc-mod
16254 @ignore
16255 @mindex @null
16256 @end ignore
16257 @tindex %
16258 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16259 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16260 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16261 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16262 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16263 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16264 must be positive real number.
16265
16266 @kindex :
16267 @pindex calc-fdiv
16268 @tindex fdiv
16269 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16270 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16271 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16272 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16273 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16274 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16275 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16276 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16277
16278 @kindex n
16279 @pindex calc-change-sign
16280 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16281 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16282 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16283
16284 @kindex A
16285 @pindex calc-abs
16286 @tindex abs
16287 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16288 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16289 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16290 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16291 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16292 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16293 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16294 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16295 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16296
16297 @kindex f A
16298 @pindex calc-abssqr
16299 @tindex abssqr
16300 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16301 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16302
16303 @kindex f s
16304 @pindex calc-sign
16305 @tindex sign
16306 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16307 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16308 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16309 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16310 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16311
16312 @kindex &
16313 @pindex calc-inv
16314 @tindex inv
16315 @cindex Reciprocal
16316 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16317 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16318 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16319
16320 @kindex Q
16321 @pindex calc-sqrt
16322 @tindex sqrt
16323 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16324 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16325 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16326
16327 @kindex f h
16328 @pindex calc-hypot
16329 @tindex hypot
16330 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16331 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16332 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16333 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16334 magnitudes are used.
16335
16336 @kindex f Q
16337 @pindex calc-isqrt
16338 @tindex isqrt
16339 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16340 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16341 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16342 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16343 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16344 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16345 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16346
16347 @kindex f n
16348 @kindex f x
16349 @pindex calc-min
16350 @tindex min
16351 @pindex calc-max
16352 @tindex max
16353 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16354 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16355 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16356 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16357 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16358 all the arguments.)
16359
16360 @kindex f M
16361 @kindex f X
16362 @pindex calc-mant-part
16363 @tindex mant
16364 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16365 @tindex xpon
16366 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16367 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16368 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16369 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16370 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16371 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16372 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16373 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16374 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16375 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16376 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16377 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16378 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16379
16380 @kindex f S
16381 @pindex calc-scale-float
16382 @tindex scf
16383 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16384 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16385 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16386 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16387 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16388
16389 @kindex f [
16390 @kindex f ]
16391 @pindex calc-decrement
16392 @pindex calc-increment
16393 @tindex decr
16394 @tindex incr
16395 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16396 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16397 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16398 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16399 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16400 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16401 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16402 @samp{0.0} produces
16403 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16404 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16405 where @expr{p} is the current
16406 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16407 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16408
16409 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16410 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16411 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16412 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16413 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16414 way floating-point numbers work.
16415
16416 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16417 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16418
16419 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16420 @section Integer Truncation
16421
16422 @noindent
16423 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16424 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16425 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16426 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16427 to integer form.
16428
16429 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16430 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16431
16432 @cindex Integer part of a number
16433 @kindex F
16434 @pindex calc-floor
16435 @tindex floor
16436 @tindex ffloor
16437 @ignore
16438 @mindex @null
16439 @end ignore
16440 @kindex H F
16441 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16442 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16443 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16444 @mathit{-4}.
16445
16446 @kindex I F
16447 @pindex calc-ceiling
16448 @tindex ceil
16449 @tindex fceil
16450 @ignore
16451 @mindex @null
16452 @end ignore
16453 @kindex H I F
16454 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16455 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16456 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16457
16458 @kindex R
16459 @pindex calc-round
16460 @tindex round
16461 @tindex fround
16462 @ignore
16463 @mindex @null
16464 @end ignore
16465 @kindex H R
16466 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16467 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16468 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16469 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16470 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16471
16472 @kindex I R
16473 @pindex calc-trunc
16474 @tindex trunc
16475 @tindex ftrunc
16476 @ignore
16477 @mindex @null
16478 @end ignore
16479 @kindex H I R
16480 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16481 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16482 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16483 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16484
16485 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16486 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16487 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16488 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16489 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16490 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16491
16492 @ignore
16493 @starindex
16494 @end ignore
16495 @tindex rounde
16496 @ignore
16497 @starindex
16498 @end ignore
16499 @tindex roundu
16500 @ignore
16501 @starindex
16502 @end ignore
16503 @tindex frounde
16504 @ignore
16505 @starindex
16506 @end ignore
16507 @tindex froundu
16508 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16509 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16510 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16511 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16512 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16513 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16514 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16515 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16516 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16517 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16518 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16519 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16520 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16521 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16522 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16523
16524 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16525 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16526 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16527 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16528 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16529 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16530 no second argument at all.
16531
16532 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16533 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16534 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16535 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16536
16537 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16538 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16539 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16540 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16541
16542 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16543 @section Complex Number Functions
16544
16545 @noindent
16546 @kindex J
16547 @pindex calc-conj
16548 @tindex conj
16549 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16550 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16551 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16552 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16553 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16554
16555 @kindex G
16556 @pindex calc-argument
16557 @tindex arg
16558 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16559 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16560 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16561 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16562 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16563 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16564 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16565 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16566
16567 @pindex calc-imaginary
16568 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16569 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16570 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16571 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16572
16573 @kindex f r
16574 @pindex calc-re
16575 @tindex re
16576 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16577 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16578 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16579 the value part.)
16580
16581 @kindex f i
16582 @pindex calc-im
16583 @tindex im
16584 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16585 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16586 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16587
16588 @ignore
16589 @mindex v p
16590 @end ignore
16591 @kindex v p (complex)
16592 @kindex V p (complex)
16593 @pindex calc-pack
16594 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16595 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16596 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16597 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16598 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16599
16600 @ignore
16601 @mindex v u
16602 @end ignore
16603 @kindex v u (complex)
16604 @kindex V u (complex)
16605 @pindex calc-unpack
16606 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16607 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16608 into its separate components.
16609
16610 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16611 @section Conversions
16612
16613 @noindent
16614 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16615 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16616
16617 @kindex c f
16618 @pindex calc-float
16619 @tindex pfloat
16620 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16621 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16622 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16623 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16624 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16625 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16626 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16627 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16628 format may lose information.
16629
16630 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16631 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16632 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16633 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16634 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16635 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16636
16637 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16638 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16639 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16640 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16641
16642 @kindex H c f
16643 @tindex float
16644 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16645 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16646 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16647 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16648
16649 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16650 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16651 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16652 that appear right now.
16653
16654 @kindex c F
16655 @pindex calc-fraction
16656 @tindex pfrac
16657 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16658 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16659 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16660 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16661 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16662 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16663 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16664 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16665 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16666 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16667 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16668
16669 @kindex H c F
16670 @tindex frac
16671 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16672 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16673 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16674
16675 @kindex c d
16676 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16677 @tindex deg
16678 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16679 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16680 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16681 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16682
16683 @kindex c r
16684 @pindex calc-to-radians
16685 @tindex rad
16686 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16687 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16688
16689 @kindex c h
16690 @pindex calc-to-hms
16691 @tindex hms
16692 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16693 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16694 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16695 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16696 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16697
16698 @pindex calc-from-hms
16699 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16700 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16701
16702 @kindex c p
16703 @kindex I c p
16704 @pindex calc-polar
16705 @tindex polar
16706 @tindex rect
16707 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16708 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16709 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16710 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16711 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16712 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16713 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16714 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16715
16716 @kindex c c
16717 @pindex calc-clean
16718 @tindex pclean
16719 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16720 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16721 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16722 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16723 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16724 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16725 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16726 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16727 number (i.e., pervasively).
16728
16729 If the simplification mode is set below basic simplification, it is raised
16730 for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c} applies the basic
16731 simplifications even if their automatic application is disabled.
16732 @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16733
16734 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16735 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16736 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16737 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16738 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16739
16740 @kindex c 0-9
16741 @pindex calc-clean-num
16742 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16743 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16744 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16745 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16746
16747 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16748 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16749 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16750 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16751 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16752 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16753 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16754
16755 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16756 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16757 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16758 does not clip small numbers.)
16759
16760 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16761 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16762 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16763 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16764 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16765 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16766
16767 @kindex H c 0-9
16768 @kindex H c c
16769 @tindex clean
16770 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16771 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16772
16773 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16774 @section Date Arithmetic
16775
16776 @noindent
16777 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16778 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16779 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16780 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16781 letters.
16782
16783 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16784 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16785 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16786 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16787 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16788 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16789
16790 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16791 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16792 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16793
16794 @menu
16795 * Date Conversions::
16796 * Date Functions::
16797 * Time Zones::
16798 * Business Days::
16799 @end menu
16800
16801 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16802 @subsection Date Conversions
16803
16804 @noindent
16805 @kindex t D
16806 @pindex calc-date
16807 @tindex date
16808 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16809 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD@. The
16810 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16811 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16812 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16813
16814 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16815 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16816 of the following ways:
16817
16818 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16819 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16820 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16821 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16822 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16823 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16824 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16825 month will be used.
16826
16827 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16828 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16829 real-time clock.
16830
16831 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16832 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16833
16834 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16835 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16836 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16837 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16838 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16839 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16840
16841 @kindex t J
16842 @pindex calc-julian
16843 @tindex julian
16844 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16845 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16846 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16847 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC@. A pure date is converted to an
16848 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16849 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16850 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16851 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16852 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16853 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16854 are never time-zone adjusted.
16855
16856 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16857 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16858 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16859 current or specified time zone.
16860
16861 @kindex t U
16862 @pindex calc-unix-time
16863 @tindex unixtime
16864 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16865 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16866 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16867 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16868 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16869 precision, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16870 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16871 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16872 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16873 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16874 suppress the adjustment if so.
16875
16876 @kindex t C
16877 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16878 @tindex tzconv
16879 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16880 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16881 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16882 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16883 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16884 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16885 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16886 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16887 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16888
16889 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16890 @subsection Date Functions
16891
16892 @noindent
16893 @kindex t N
16894 @pindex calc-now
16895 @tindex now
16896 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16897 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16898 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16899 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16900
16901 @kindex t P
16902 @pindex calc-date-part
16903 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16904 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16905 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16906 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16907
16908 @tindex year
16909 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16910 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16911 following functions will also accept a real number for an
16912 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16913 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
16914 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16915
16916 @tindex month
16917 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16918 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16919
16920 @tindex day
16921 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16922 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16923
16924 @tindex hour
16925 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16926 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16927 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16928 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16929 HMS forms as input.
16930
16931 @tindex minute
16932 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16933 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16934
16935 @tindex second
16936 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16937 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16938 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16939 precision, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16940
16941 @tindex weekday
16942 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16943 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16944 to 6 (Saturday).
16945
16946 @tindex yearday
16947 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16948 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16949 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16950
16951 @tindex time
16952 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16953 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16954 for a pure date form.
16955
16956 @kindex t M
16957 @pindex calc-new-month
16958 @tindex newmonth
16959 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16960 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16961 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16962 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16963 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16964 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16965 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16966 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16967
16968 @kindex t Y
16969 @pindex calc-new-year
16970 @tindex newyear
16971 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16972 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16973 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16974 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16975 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16976 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16977 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16978 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16979 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16980
16981 @kindex t W
16982 @pindex calc-new-week
16983 @tindex newweek
16984 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16985 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16986 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16987 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16988 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16989 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16990
16991 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16992 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16993 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16994 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16995 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16996 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16997 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16998 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16999 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
17000 the time to midnight; hint: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
17001 of the @code{weekday} function?).
17002
17003 @ignore
17004 @starindex
17005 @end ignore
17006 @tindex pwday
17007 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
17008 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
17009 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
17010 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
17011 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
17012 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
17013 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
17014 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
17015 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
17016 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
17017 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
17018
17019 @kindex t I
17020 @pindex calc-inc-month
17021 @tindex incmonth
17022 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17023 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17024 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17025 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17026 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17027 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17028 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17029 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17030 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17031 in this case).
17032
17033 @ignore
17034 @starindex
17035 @end ignore
17036 @tindex incyear
17037 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17038 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17039 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17040 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17041 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17042 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17043 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17044 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17045
17046 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17047 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17048 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17049
17050 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17051 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17052
17053 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17054 @subsection Business Days
17055
17056 @noindent
17057 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17058 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17059 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17060 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17061 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17062 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17063
17064 @kindex t +
17065 @kindex t -
17066 @tindex badd
17067 @tindex bsub
17068 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17069 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17070 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17071 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17072 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17073 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17074 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17075 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17076 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17077 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17078 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17079 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17080 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17081 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17082 dates.
17083
17084 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17085 @vindex Holidays
17086 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17087 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17088 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17089 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17090 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17091 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17092 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17093
17094 @itemize @bullet
17095 @item
17096 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17097 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17098
17099 @item
17100 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17101 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17102
17103 @item
17104 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17105 considered to be a holiday.
17106
17107 @item
17108 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17109 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17110 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17111 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17112 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17113 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17114 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17115 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17116 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17117
17118 @item
17119 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17120 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17121
17122 @item
17123 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17124 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17125 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17126 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17127 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17128 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17129 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17130 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17131 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17132 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17133
17134 @item
17135 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17136 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17137 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17138 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17139 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17140 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17141 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17142 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17143 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17144 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17145 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17146 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17147 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17148 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17149 @end itemize
17150
17151 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17152 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17153 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17154
17155 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17156 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17157 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17158 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17159 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17160 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17161
17162 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17163 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17164 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17165 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17166 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17167 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17168 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17169 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17170
17171 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17172 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17173 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17174 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17175 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17176 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17177 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17178 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17179 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17180 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17181 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17182 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17183 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17184 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17185 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17186
17187 @ignore
17188 @starindex
17189 @end ignore
17190 @tindex holiday
17191 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17192 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17193 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17194 business day.
17195
17196 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17197 @subsection Time Zones
17198
17199 @noindent
17200 @cindex Time zones
17201 @cindex Daylight saving time
17202 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17203 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17204 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17205 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17206 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17207 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17208 can't determine the right correction to use.
17209
17210 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17211 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17212 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17213 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17214 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17215 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17216 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17217 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17218 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17219 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17220 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17221 April 7, 1991.
17222
17223 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17224 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17225 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17226 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17227
17228 @pindex calc-time-zone
17229 @ignore
17230 @starindex
17231 @end ignore
17232 @tindex tzone
17233 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17234 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17235 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17236 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17237 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17238 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17239 the normal difference.
17240
17241 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17242 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17243 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17244 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17245 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17246 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17247 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17248 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17249 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17250
17251 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17252 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17253 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17254 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17255
17256 @smallexample
17257 @group
17258 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17259 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17260
17261 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17262 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17263
17264 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17265 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17266 @end group
17267 @end smallexample
17268
17269 @vindex math-tzone-names
17270 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17271 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17272 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17273 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17274 Pacific Time look like this:
17275
17276 @smallexample
17277 @group
17278 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17279 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17280 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17281 @end group
17282 @end smallexample
17283
17284 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17285 @vindex TimeZone
17286 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17287 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17288 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17289 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17290 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17291 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17292 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17293 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17294 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17295 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17296 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17297 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17298 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17299 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17300 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17301 The special time zone name @code{local}
17302 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17303 from the calendar.
17304
17305 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17306 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17307 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17308 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17309
17310 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17311 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17312 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17313 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17314 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17315 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17316 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17317 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17318 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17319 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17320 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17321 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17322 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17323 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17324 the conversion functions.
17325
17326 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17327 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17328 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17329 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17330 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17331
17332 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17333 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17334 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17335 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17336 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17337 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17338 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17339
17340 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17341 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17342 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17343 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17344 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17345 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17346 and the weekday number (0-6).
17347
17348 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17349 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17350 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17351 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17352 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17353 daylight saving hook:
17354
17355 @smallexample
17356 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17357 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17358 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17359 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17360 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17361 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17362 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17363 (t -1))))
17364 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17365 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17366 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17367 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17368 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17369 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17370 (t 0))))
17371 (t 0))
17372 )
17373 @end smallexample
17374
17375 @noindent
17376 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17377 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17378 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17379 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17380 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17381
17382 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17383 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17384 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17385 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17386 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17387 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17388 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17389 later).
17390
17391 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17392 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17393
17394 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17395 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17396 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17397 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17398 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17399 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17400 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17401 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17402 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17403 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17404 is typically represented in.
17405
17406 @ignore
17407 @starindex
17408 @end ignore
17409 @tindex dsadj
17410 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17411 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17412 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17413 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17414 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17415 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17416 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17417
17418 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17419 @section Financial Functions
17420
17421 @noindent
17422 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17423 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17424 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17425
17426 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17427 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17428 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17429 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17430
17431 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17432 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17433 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17434 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17435
17436 @menu
17437 * Percentages::
17438 * Future Value::
17439 * Present Value::
17440 * Related Financial Functions::
17441 * Depreciation Functions::
17442 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17443 @end menu
17444
17445 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17446 @subsection Percentages
17447
17448 @kindex M-%
17449 @pindex calc-percent
17450 @tindex %
17451 @tindex percent
17452 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17453 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17454 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17455 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17456
17457 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17458 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17459 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17460 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17461 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17462 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17463 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17464 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17465
17466 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17467 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17468 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17469 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17470 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17471 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17472
17473 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17474 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17475 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17476 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17477
17478 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17479 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17480 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17481
17482 @kindex c %
17483 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17484 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17485 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17486 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17487 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17488 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17489 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17490 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17491
17492 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17493 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17494 @samp{25%}.
17495
17496 @kindex b %
17497 @pindex calc-percent-change
17498 @tindex relch
17499 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17500 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17501 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17502 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17503 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17504 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17505 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17506 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17507 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17508 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17509
17510 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17511 @subsection Future Value
17512
17513 @noindent
17514 @kindex b F
17515 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17516 @tindex fv
17517 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17518 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17519 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17520 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17521 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17522 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17523 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17524 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17525 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17526 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17527
17528 @kindex I b F
17529 @tindex fvb
17530 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17531 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17532 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17533 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17534 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17535 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17536 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17537 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17538 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17539
17540 @kindex H b F
17541 @tindex fvl
17542 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17543 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17544 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17545 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17546
17547 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17548 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17549 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17550 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17551 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17552
17553 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17554 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17555 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17556 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17557 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17558 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17559 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17560 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17561 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17562 by @code{fvb} directly.
17563
17564 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17565 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17566 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17567 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17568 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17569 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17570 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17571
17572 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17573 @subsection Present Value
17574
17575 @noindent
17576 @kindex b P
17577 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17578 @tindex pv
17579 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17580 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17581 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17582 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17583 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17584 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17585 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17586 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17587 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17588 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17589 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17590 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17591 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17592
17593 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17594 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17595 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17596 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17597 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17598 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17599 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17600 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17601 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17602
17603 @kindex I b P
17604 @tindex pvb
17605 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17606 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17607 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17608 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17609 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17610 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17611
17612 @kindex H b P
17613 @tindex pvl
17614 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17615 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17616 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17617 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17618 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17619 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17620 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17621
17622 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17623 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17624 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17625
17626 @kindex b N
17627 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17628 @tindex npv
17629 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17630 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17631 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17632 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17633 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17634 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17635 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17636
17637 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17638 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17639 not all the same!
17640
17641 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17642 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17643 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17644 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17645 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17646 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17647 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17648 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17649
17650 @kindex I b N
17651 @tindex npvb
17652 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17653 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17654 rather than at the end.
17655
17656 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17657 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17658
17659 @noindent
17660 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17661 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17662
17663 @kindex b M
17664 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17665 @tindex pmt
17666 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17667 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17668 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17669 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17670 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17671
17672 @kindex I b M
17673 @tindex pmtb
17674 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17675 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17676 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17677 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17678
17679 @kindex H b M
17680 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17681 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17682
17683 @kindex b #
17684 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17685 @tindex nper
17686 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17687 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17688 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17689 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17690 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17691 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17692 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17693
17694 @kindex I b #
17695 @tindex nperb
17696 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17697 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17698 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17699 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17700
17701 @kindex H b #
17702 @tindex nperl
17703 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17704 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17705 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17706 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17707 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17708
17709 @kindex b T
17710 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17711 @tindex rate
17712 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17713 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17714 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17715 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17716 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17717
17718 @kindex I b T
17719 @kindex H b T
17720 @tindex rateb
17721 @tindex ratel
17722 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17723 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17724 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17725 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17726 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17727 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17728 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17729
17730 @kindex b I
17731 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17732 @tindex irr
17733 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17734 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17735 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17736 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17737 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17738
17739 @kindex I b I
17740 @tindex irrb
17741 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17742 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17743
17744 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17745 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17746
17747 @noindent
17748 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17749 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17750 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17751 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17752 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17753 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17754
17755 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17756 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17757
17758 @kindex b S
17759 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17760 @tindex sln
17761 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17762 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17763 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17764 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17765 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17766 per year.
17767
17768 @kindex b Y
17769 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17770 @tindex syd
17771 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17772 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17773 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17774 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17775 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17776 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17777 return zero.
17778
17779 @kindex b D
17780 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17781 @tindex ddb
17782 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17783 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17784 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17785
17786 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17787 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17788 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17789
17790 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17791 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17792 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17793 the three depreciation methods:
17794
17795 @example
17796 @group
17797 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17798 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17799 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17800 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17801 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17802 @end group
17803 @end example
17804
17805 @noindent
17806 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17807 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17808 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17809 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17810
17811 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17812 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17813 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17814
17815 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17816 @subsection Definitions
17817
17818 @noindent
17819 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17820 Calc's financial functions.
17821
17822 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17823 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17824 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17825 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17826 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17827 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17828
17829 @ifnottex
17830 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17831 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17832 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17833
17834 @example
17835 n
17836 (1 + rate) - 1
17837 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17838 rate
17839
17840 n
17841 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17842 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17843 rate
17844
17845 n
17846 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17847
17848 -n
17849 1 - (1 + rate)
17850 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17851 rate
17852
17853 -n
17854 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17855 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17856 rate
17857
17858 -n
17859 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17860
17861 -1 -2 -3
17862 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17863
17864 -1 -2
17865 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17866
17867 -n
17868 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17869 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17870 -n
17871 1 - (1 + rate)
17872
17873 -n
17874 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17875 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17876 -n
17877 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17878
17879 amt * rate
17880 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17881 pmt
17882
17883 amt * rate
17884 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17885 pmt * (1 + rate)
17886
17887 amt
17888 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17889 pmt
17890
17891 1/n
17892 pmt
17893 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17894 1/n
17895 amt
17896
17897 cost - salv
17898 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17899 life
17900
17901 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17902 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17903 life * (life + 1) / 2
17904
17905 book * 2
17906 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17907 life
17908 @end example
17909 @end ifnottex
17910 @tex
17911 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17912 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17913 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17914 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17915 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17916 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17917 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17918 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17919 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17920 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17921 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17922 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17923 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17924 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17925 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17926 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17927 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17928 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17929 @end tex
17930
17931 @noindent
17932 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17933
17934 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17935 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17936 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17937 all sorts of inputs.
17938
17939 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17940 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17941 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17942
17943 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17944 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17945 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17946 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17947 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17948 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17949
17950 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17951 for @samp{rate}.
17952
17953 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17954 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17955 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17956
17957 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17958 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17959 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17960
17961 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17962 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17963 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17964 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17965 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17966 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17967 period.
17968
17969 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17970 @section Binary Number Functions
17971
17972 @noindent
17973 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17974 the @kbd{b} prefix.
17975
17976 @cindex Binary numbers
17977 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17978 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17979 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17980 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17981 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17982
17983 @cindex Word size for binary operations
17984 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17985 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17986 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17987 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17988 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17989
17990 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce twos-complement
17991 integers from
17992 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
17993 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
17994 to
17995 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
17996 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
17997 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
17998 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
17999
18000 @kindex b c
18001 @pindex calc-clip
18002 @tindex clip
18003 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
18004 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
18005 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
18006 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
18007 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
18008 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
18009 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
18010 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
18011 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
18012
18013 @kindex b w
18014 @pindex calc-word-size
18015 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
18016 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
18017 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18018 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18019 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18020 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18021 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18022
18023 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18024 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18025 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18026 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18027 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18028 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18029 integer-valued floats.
18030
18031 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18032 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18033 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18034 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18035
18036 @kindex b a
18037 @pindex calc-and
18038 @tindex and
18039 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18040 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18041 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18042 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18043 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18044
18045 @kindex b o
18046 @pindex calc-or
18047 @tindex or
18048 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18049 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18050 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18051
18052 @kindex b x
18053 @pindex calc-xor
18054 @tindex xor
18055 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18056 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18057 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18058
18059 @kindex b d
18060 @pindex calc-diff
18061 @tindex diff
18062 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18063 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18064 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18065
18066 @kindex b n
18067 @pindex calc-not
18068 @tindex not
18069 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18070 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18071
18072 @kindex b l
18073 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18074 @tindex lsh
18075 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18076 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18077 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18078 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18079 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18080 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18081
18082 @kindex H b l
18083 @kindex H b r
18084 @ignore
18085 @mindex @idots
18086 @end ignore
18087 @kindex H b L
18088 @ignore
18089 @mindex @null
18090 @end ignore
18091 @kindex H b R
18092 @ignore
18093 @mindex @null
18094 @end ignore
18095 @kindex H b t
18096 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18097 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18098 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18099 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18100 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18101
18102 @kindex b r
18103 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18104 @tindex rsh
18105 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18106 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18107 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18108
18109 @kindex b L
18110 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18111 @tindex ash
18112 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18113 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18114 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18115 is performed as described below.
18116
18117 @kindex b R
18118 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18119 @tindex rash
18120 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18121 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18122 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18123 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18124 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18125 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18126 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18127 performs a standard left shift.
18128
18129 @kindex b t
18130 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18131 @tindex rot
18132 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18133 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18134 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18135 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18136 or right.
18137
18138 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18139 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18140 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18141 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18142 bits in a binary integer.
18143
18144 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18145 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18146 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18147 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18148 into a binary integer.
18149
18150 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18151 @chapter Scientific Functions
18152
18153 @noindent
18154 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18155 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18156 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18157 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18158
18159 @kindex P
18160 @pindex calc-pi
18161 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18162 @vindex pi
18163 @kindex H P
18164 @cindex @code{e} variable
18165 @vindex e
18166 @kindex I P
18167 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18168 @vindex gamma
18169 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18170 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18171 @kindex H I P
18172 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18173 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18174 @cindex Golden ratio
18175 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18176 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18177 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18178 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18179 @texline @math{\gamma}
18180 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18181 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18182 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18183 @texline @math{\phi}
18184 @infoline @expr{phi}
18185 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18186 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18187 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18188 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18189 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18190
18191 @ignore
18192 @mindex Q
18193 @end ignore
18194 @ignore
18195 @mindex I Q
18196 @end ignore
18197 @kindex I Q
18198 @tindex sqr
18199 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18200 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18201 computes the square of the argument.
18202
18203 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18204 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18205 interpret a prefix argument.
18206
18207 @menu
18208 * Logarithmic Functions::
18209 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18210 * Advanced Math Functions::
18211 * Branch Cuts::
18212 * Random Numbers::
18213 * Combinatorial Functions::
18214 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18215 @end menu
18216
18217 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18218 @section Logarithmic Functions
18219
18220 @noindent
18221 @kindex L
18222 @pindex calc-ln
18223 @tindex ln
18224 @ignore
18225 @mindex @null
18226 @end ignore
18227 @kindex I E
18228 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18229 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18230 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18231 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18232
18233 @kindex E
18234 @pindex calc-exp
18235 @tindex exp
18236 @ignore
18237 @mindex @null
18238 @end ignore
18239 @kindex I L
18240 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18241 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18242 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18243 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18244
18245 @kindex H L
18246 @kindex H E
18247 @pindex calc-log10
18248 @tindex log10
18249 @tindex exp10
18250 @ignore
18251 @mindex @null
18252 @end ignore
18253 @kindex H I L
18254 @ignore
18255 @mindex @null
18256 @end ignore
18257 @kindex H I E
18258 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18259 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18260 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18261 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18262 by
18263 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18264 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18265
18266 @kindex B
18267 @kindex I B
18268 @pindex calc-log
18269 @tindex log
18270 @tindex alog
18271 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18272 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18273 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18274 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18275 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18276 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18277 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18278 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18279
18280 @kindex f I
18281 @pindex calc-ilog
18282 @tindex ilog
18283 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18284 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18285 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18286 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18287 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18288 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18289 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18290
18291 @kindex f E
18292 @pindex calc-expm1
18293 @tindex expm1
18294 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18295 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18296 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18297 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18298 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18299 @texline @math{e^x}
18300 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18301 is close to one.
18302
18303 @kindex f L
18304 @pindex calc-lnp1
18305 @tindex lnp1
18306 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18307 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18308 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18309 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18310
18311 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18312 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18313
18314 @noindent
18315 @kindex S
18316 @pindex calc-sin
18317 @tindex sin
18318 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18319 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18320 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18321 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18322 on complex numbers.
18323
18324 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18325 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18326 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18327 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18328 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18329
18330 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18331 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18332 the default algebraic simplifications recognize many such
18333 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18334 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18335 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18336 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18337 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18338 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18339 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18340
18341 Calc's algebraic simplifications know all angles which are integer multiples of
18342 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18343 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18344 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18345
18346 @kindex I S
18347 @pindex calc-arcsin
18348 @tindex arcsin
18349 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18350 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18351 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18352 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18353
18354 @kindex H S
18355 @pindex calc-sinh
18356 @tindex sinh
18357 @kindex H I S
18358 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18359 @tindex arcsinh
18360 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18361 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18362 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18363 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18364
18365 @kindex C
18366 @pindex calc-cos
18367 @tindex cos
18368 @ignore
18369 @mindex @idots
18370 @end ignore
18371 @kindex I C
18372 @pindex calc-arccos
18373 @ignore
18374 @mindex @null
18375 @end ignore
18376 @tindex arccos
18377 @ignore
18378 @mindex @null
18379 @end ignore
18380 @kindex H C
18381 @pindex calc-cosh
18382 @ignore
18383 @mindex @null
18384 @end ignore
18385 @tindex cosh
18386 @ignore
18387 @mindex @null
18388 @end ignore
18389 @kindex H I C
18390 @pindex calc-arccosh
18391 @ignore
18392 @mindex @null
18393 @end ignore
18394 @tindex arccosh
18395 @ignore
18396 @mindex @null
18397 @end ignore
18398 @kindex T
18399 @pindex calc-tan
18400 @ignore
18401 @mindex @null
18402 @end ignore
18403 @tindex tan
18404 @ignore
18405 @mindex @null
18406 @end ignore
18407 @kindex I T
18408 @pindex calc-arctan
18409 @ignore
18410 @mindex @null
18411 @end ignore
18412 @tindex arctan
18413 @ignore
18414 @mindex @null
18415 @end ignore
18416 @kindex H T
18417 @pindex calc-tanh
18418 @ignore
18419 @mindex @null
18420 @end ignore
18421 @tindex tanh
18422 @ignore
18423 @mindex @null
18424 @end ignore
18425 @kindex H I T
18426 @pindex calc-arctanh
18427 @ignore
18428 @mindex @null
18429 @end ignore
18430 @tindex arctanh
18431 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18432 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18433 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18434 variants of these functions.
18435
18436 @kindex f T
18437 @pindex calc-arctan2
18438 @tindex arctan2
18439 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18440 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18441 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18442 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18443 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18444 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18445 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18446 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18447 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18448 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18449
18450 @pindex calc-sincos
18451 @ignore
18452 @starindex
18453 @end ignore
18454 @tindex sincos
18455 @ignore
18456 @starindex
18457 @end ignore
18458 @ignore
18459 @mindex arc@idots
18460 @end ignore
18461 @tindex arcsincos
18462 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18463 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18464 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18465 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18466 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18467 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18468
18469 @pindex calc-sec
18470 @tindex sec
18471 @pindex calc-csc
18472 @tindex csc
18473 @pindex calc-cot
18474 @tindex cot
18475 @pindex calc-sech
18476 @tindex sech
18477 @pindex calc-csch
18478 @tindex csch
18479 @pindex calc-coth
18480 @tindex coth
18481 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18482 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
18483 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18484 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18485 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
18486 [@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18487
18488 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18489 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18490
18491 @noindent
18492 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18493 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18494 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18495 will work to arbitrarily large precision. They can not at present
18496 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18497
18498 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18499 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18500 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18501 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18502 slow for some values of the arguments.
18503
18504 @kindex f g
18505 @pindex calc-gamma
18506 @tindex gamma
18507 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18508 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18509 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18510 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18511 integral:
18512 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18513 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18514 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18515
18516 @kindex f G
18517 @tindex gammaP
18518 @ignore
18519 @mindex @idots
18520 @end ignore
18521 @kindex I f G
18522 @ignore
18523 @mindex @null
18524 @end ignore
18525 @kindex H f G
18526 @ignore
18527 @mindex @null
18528 @end ignore
18529 @kindex H I f G
18530 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18531 @ignore
18532 @mindex @null
18533 @end ignore
18534 @tindex gammaQ
18535 @ignore
18536 @mindex @null
18537 @end ignore
18538 @tindex gammag
18539 @ignore
18540 @mindex @null
18541 @end ignore
18542 @tindex gammaG
18543 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18544 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18545 the integral,
18546 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18547 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18548 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18549 definition of the normal gamma function).
18550
18551 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18552 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18553 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18554 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18555 @expr{x} to infinity.
18556
18557 @ifnottex
18558 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18559 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18560 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18561 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18562 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18563 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18564 @end ifnottex
18565 @tex
18566 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18567 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18568 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18569 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18570 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18571 @end tex
18572
18573 @kindex f b
18574 @pindex calc-beta
18575 @tindex beta
18576 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18577 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18578 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18579 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18580 or by
18581 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18582 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18583
18584 @kindex f B
18585 @kindex H f B
18586 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18587 @tindex betaI
18588 @tindex betaB
18589 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18590 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18591 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18592 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18593 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18594 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18595
18596 @kindex f e
18597 @kindex I f e
18598 @pindex calc-erf
18599 @tindex erf
18600 @tindex erfc
18601 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18602 error function
18603 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18604 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18605 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18606 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18607 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18608 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18609
18610 @kindex f j
18611 @kindex f y
18612 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18613 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18614 @tindex besJ
18615 @tindex besY
18616 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18617 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18618 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18619 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18620 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18621 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18622 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18623 Use with care!
18624
18625 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18626 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18627
18628 @noindent
18629 @cindex Branch cuts
18630 @cindex Principal values
18631 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18632 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18633 This section describes the values
18634 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18635 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18636 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18637 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18638 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18639
18640 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18641 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18642 versions of Calc follow the second edition.
18643
18644 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18645 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18646 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18647 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18648 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18649 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18650
18651 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18652 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18653 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18654 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18655
18656 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18657 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18658 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18659 in the right half of the complex plane.
18660
18661 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18662 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18663 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18664 negative real axis.
18665
18666 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18667 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18668 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18669 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18670 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18671
18672 @smallexample
18673 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18674 ----------------------------------------
18675 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18676 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18677 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18678 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18679 @end smallexample
18680
18681 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18682 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18683 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18684 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18685 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18686 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18687
18688 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18689 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18690
18691 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18692 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18693 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18694
18695 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18696 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18697 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18698
18699 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18700 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18701 above @expr{i}.
18702
18703 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18704 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18705 real axis less than 1.
18706
18707 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18708 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18709
18710 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18711 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18712 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18713
18714 @smallexample
18715 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18716 -------------------------------------------------------
18717 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18718 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18719 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18720 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18721 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18722 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18723 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18724 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18725 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18726 @end smallexample
18727
18728 @smallexample
18729 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18730 -----------------------------------------------------
18731 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18732 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18733 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18734 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18735 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18736 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18737 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18738 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18739 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18740 @end smallexample
18741
18742 @smallexample
18743 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18744 -----------------------------------------------------
18745 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18746 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18747 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18748 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18749 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18750 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18751 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18752 @end smallexample
18753
18754 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18755 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18756 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18757
18758 @smallexample
18759 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18760 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18761 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18762 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18763 @end smallexample
18764
18765 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18766 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18767 are not rigorously specified at present.
18768
18769 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18770 @section Random Numbers
18771
18772 @noindent
18773 @kindex k r
18774 @pindex calc-random
18775 @tindex random
18776 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18777 random numbers of various sorts.
18778
18779 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18780 integer @expr{N} in the range
18781 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18782 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18783 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18784
18785 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18786 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18787 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18788 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18789 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18790 the result is a random integer in the range
18791 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18792 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18793
18794 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18795 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18796 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18797 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18798 or
18799 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18800 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18801 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18802
18803 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18804 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18805 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18806 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18807
18808 If @expr{M} is an error form
18809 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18810 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18811 where @var{m} and
18812 @texline @math{\sigma}
18813 @infoline @var{s}
18814 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18815 @var{m} and standard deviation
18816 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18817 @infoline @var{s}.
18818
18819 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18820 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18821 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18822 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18823 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18824 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18825 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18826 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18827 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18828 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18829 extremely small.)
18830
18831 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18832 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18833
18834 @vindex RandSeed
18835 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18836 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18837 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18838 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18839 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18840 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18841 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18842 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18843 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18844 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18845 of random numbers as before.
18846
18847 @pindex calc-rrandom
18848 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18849 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18850
18851 @kindex k a
18852 @pindex calc-random-again
18853 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18854 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18855 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18856 that value of @expr{M}.
18857
18858 @kindex k h
18859 @pindex calc-shuffle
18860 @tindex shuffle
18861 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18862 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18863 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18864 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18865 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18866 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18867 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18868
18869 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18870 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18871 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18872 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18873 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18874 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18875 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18876 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18877 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18878 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18879 each make it into the result vector.)
18880
18881 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18882 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18883 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18884 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18885 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18886 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18887 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18888
18889 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18890 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18891 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18892 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18893 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18894
18895 @menu
18896 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18897 @end menu
18898
18899 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18900 @subsection Random Number Generator
18901
18902 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18903 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18904 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18905 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18906 characterization.
18907
18908 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs's built-in
18909 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18910 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18911 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18912
18913 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18914 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18915 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18916
18917 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18918 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18919 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18920 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18921 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18922 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18923 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18924 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18925
18926 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18927 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18928 computing
18929 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18930 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18931 This method expands the seed
18932 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18933 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18934 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18935 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18936 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18937 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18938 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18939 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18940 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18941 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18942 to reseed the generator with that number.
18943
18944 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18945 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18946 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18947 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18948 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18949 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18950 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18951 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18952 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18953 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18954 damage its randomness.
18955
18956 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18957 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18958 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18959 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18960 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18961 value.
18962
18963 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18964 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18965 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18966 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18967 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18968 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18969 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18970 numbers on the order of
18971 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
18972 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
18973 or
18974 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
18975 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
18976 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18977 correspond to small integers times
18978 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18979 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18980
18981 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18982 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18983 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18984 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18985 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18986 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18987 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18988 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18989 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18990 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18991
18992 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18993 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C@. This method
18994 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18995 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18996
18997 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18998 @section Combinatorial Functions
18999
19000 @noindent
19001 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
19002 @kbd{k} key prefix.
19003
19004 @kindex k g
19005 @pindex calc-gcd
19006 @tindex gcd
19007 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
19008 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
19009 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
19010 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
19011 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
19012 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
19013 the operation is left in symbolic form.
19014
19015 @kindex k l
19016 @pindex calc-lcm
19017 @tindex lcm
19018 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19019 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19020 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19021 numbers.
19022
19023 @kindex k E
19024 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
19025 @tindex egcd
19026 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19027 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19028 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
19029 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19030 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19031
19032 @kindex !
19033 @pindex calc-factorial
19034 @tindex fact
19035 @ignore
19036 @mindex @null
19037 @end ignore
19038 @tindex !
19039 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19040 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19041 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19042 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19043 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19044 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19045 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19046 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19047 the commands in this section.
19048
19049 @kindex k d
19050 @pindex calc-double-factorial
19051 @tindex dfact
19052 @ignore
19053 @mindex @null
19054 @end ignore
19055 @tindex !!
19056 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19057 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19058 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19059 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19060 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19061 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19062 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19063
19064 @kindex k c
19065 @pindex calc-choose
19066 @tindex choose
19067 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19068 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19069 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19070 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19071 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19072 real numbers by
19073 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19074 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19075
19076 @kindex H k c
19077 @pindex calc-perm
19078 @tindex perm
19079 @ifnottex
19080 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19081 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19082 @end ifnottex
19083 @tex
19084 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19085 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19086 @end tex
19087
19088 @kindex k b
19089 @kindex H k b
19090 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19091 @tindex bern
19092 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19093 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19094 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19095 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19096 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19097 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19098 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19099
19100 @kindex k e
19101 @kindex H k e
19102 @pindex calc-euler-number
19103 @tindex euler
19104 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19105 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19106 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19107 functions.
19108
19109 @kindex k s
19110 @kindex H k s
19111 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19112 @tindex stir1
19113 @tindex stir2
19114 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19115 computes a Stirling number of the first
19116 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19117 @infoline kind,
19118 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19119 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19120 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19121 @infoline kind.
19122 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19123 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19124 non-empty sets, respectively.
19125
19126 @kindex k p
19127 @pindex calc-prime-test
19128 @cindex Primes
19129 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19130 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19131 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19132 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19133 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19134 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19135 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19136 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19137 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19138 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19139 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19140 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19141 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19142
19143 @ignore
19144 @starindex
19145 @end ignore
19146 @tindex prime
19147 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19148 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19149 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19150 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19151 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19152 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19153
19154 @kindex k f
19155 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19156 @tindex prfac
19157 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19158 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19159 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19160 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19161 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19162 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19163 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19164 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19165 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19166
19167 @kindex k n
19168 @pindex calc-next-prime
19169 @ignore
19170 @mindex nextpr@idots
19171 @end ignore
19172 @tindex nextprime
19173 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19174 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19175 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19176 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19177 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19178 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19179 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19180 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19181 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19182 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19183 prime.
19184
19185 @kindex I k n
19186 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19187 @ignore
19188 @mindex prevpr@idots
19189 @end ignore
19190 @tindex prevprime
19191 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19192 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19193
19194 @kindex k t
19195 @pindex calc-totient
19196 @tindex totient
19197 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19198 Euler ``totient''
19199 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19200 @infoline function,
19201 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19202 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19203
19204 @kindex k m
19205 @pindex calc-moebius
19206 @tindex moebius
19207 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19208 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19209 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19210 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19211 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19212 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19213 the result is zero.
19214
19215 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19216 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19217
19218 @noindent
19219 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19220 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19221 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19222 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19223 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19224 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19225 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19226 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19227
19228 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19229 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19230 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19231 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19232 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19233 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19234
19235 @kindex k B
19236 @kindex I k B
19237 @pindex calc-utpb
19238 @tindex utpb
19239 @tindex ltpb
19240 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19241 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19242 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19243 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19244 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19245 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19246 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19247
19248 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19249 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19250 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19251 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19252 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19253 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19254 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19255 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19256 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19257 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19258 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19259
19260 @kindex k C
19261 @pindex calc-utpc
19262 @tindex utpc
19263 @ignore
19264 @mindex @idots
19265 @end ignore
19266 @kindex I k C
19267 @ignore
19268 @mindex @null
19269 @end ignore
19270 @tindex ltpc
19271 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19272 @texline @math{\nu}
19273 @infoline @expr{v}
19274 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19275 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19276
19277 @kindex k F
19278 @pindex calc-utpf
19279 @tindex utpf
19280 @ignore
19281 @mindex @idots
19282 @end ignore
19283 @kindex I k F
19284 @ignore
19285 @mindex @null
19286 @end ignore
19287 @tindex ltpf
19288 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19289 various statistical tests. The parameters
19290 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19291 @infoline @expr{v1}
19292 and
19293 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19294 @infoline @expr{v2}
19295 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19296 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19297
19298 @kindex k N
19299 @pindex calc-utpn
19300 @tindex utpn
19301 @ignore
19302 @mindex @idots
19303 @end ignore
19304 @kindex I k N
19305 @ignore
19306 @mindex @null
19307 @end ignore
19308 @tindex ltpn
19309 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19310 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19311 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19312 @infoline @expr{s}.
19313 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19314 would exceed @expr{x}.
19315
19316 @kindex k P
19317 @pindex calc-utpp
19318 @tindex utpp
19319 @ignore
19320 @mindex @idots
19321 @end ignore
19322 @kindex I k P
19323 @ignore
19324 @mindex @null
19325 @end ignore
19326 @tindex ltpp
19327 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19328 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19329 Poisson random events will occur.
19330
19331 @kindex k T
19332 @pindex calc-ltpt
19333 @tindex utpt
19334 @ignore
19335 @mindex @idots
19336 @end ignore
19337 @kindex I k T
19338 @ignore
19339 @mindex @null
19340 @end ignore
19341 @tindex ltpt
19342 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19343 with
19344 @texline @math{\nu}
19345 @infoline @expr{v}
19346 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19347 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19348 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19349 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19350 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19351 where
19352 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19353 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19354 and
19355 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19356 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19357 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19358 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19359
19360 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19361 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19362 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19363 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19364 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19365
19366 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19367 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19368
19369 @noindent
19370 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19371 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19372 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19373 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19374 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19375
19376 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19377 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19378 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19379 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19380 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19381
19382 @menu
19383 * Packing and Unpacking::
19384 * Building Vectors::
19385 * Extracting Elements::
19386 * Manipulating Vectors::
19387 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19388 * Set Operations::
19389 * Statistical Operations::
19390 * Reducing and Mapping::
19391 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19392 @end menu
19393
19394 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19395 @section Packing and Unpacking
19396
19397 @noindent
19398 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19399 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19400 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19401 vectors.
19402
19403 @kindex v p
19404 @kindex V p
19405 @pindex calc-pack
19406 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19407 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19408 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19409 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19410 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19411 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19412 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19413 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19414
19415 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19416 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19417 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19418 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19419
19420 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19421
19422 @table @cite
19423 @item -1
19424 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19425 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19426 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19427 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19428 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19429 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19430 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19431 components are not suitable.)
19432
19433 @item -2
19434 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19435 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19436 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19437 mode.
19438
19439 @item -3
19440 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19441 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19442 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19443 number.
19444
19445 @item -4
19446 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19447 may be real numbers or formulas.
19448
19449 @item -5
19450 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19451 must be real numbers.
19452
19453 @item -6
19454 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19455 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19456
19457 @item -7
19458 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19459
19460 @item -8
19461 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19462
19463 @item -9
19464 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19465
19466 @item -10
19467 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19468
19469 @item -11
19470 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19471 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19472 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19473 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19474
19475 @item -12
19476 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19477 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19478 is desired.
19479
19480 @item -13
19481 A real number is converted into a date form.
19482
19483 @item -14
19484 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19485
19486 @item -15
19487 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19488 @end table
19489
19490 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19491 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19492 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19493 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19494 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19495 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19496 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19497 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19498 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19499 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19500
19501 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19502 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19503 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19504 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19505 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19506
19507 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19508 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19509 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19510 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19511 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19512
19513 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19514 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19515 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19516 @texline @math{2\times3}
19517 @infoline 2x3
19518 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19519 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19520 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19521
19522 @ignore
19523 @starindex
19524 @end ignore
19525 @tindex pack
19526 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19527 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19528 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19529 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19530 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19531 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19532 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19533 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19534 by the mode.
19535
19536 @kindex v u
19537 @kindex V u
19538 @pindex calc-unpack
19539 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19540 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19541 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19542 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19543 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19544 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19545
19546 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19547 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19548 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19549 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19550 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19551 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19552 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19553
19554 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19555 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19556 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19557 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19558 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19559 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19560 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19561 is not a composite object.
19562
19563 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19564 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19565 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19566 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19567 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19568 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19569 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19570 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19571
19572 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19573 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19574 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19575 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19576 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19577 original object.
19578
19579 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19580 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19581 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19582 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19583
19584 @ignore
19585 @starindex
19586 @end ignore
19587 @tindex unpack
19588 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19589 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19590 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19591 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19592 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19593 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19594
19595 @ignore
19596 @starindex
19597 @end ignore
19598 @tindex unpackt
19599 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19600 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19601 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19602 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19603 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19604 The identity for re-building the original object is
19605 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19606 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19607 name and a vector of arguments.)
19608
19609 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19610 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19611 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19612 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19613
19614 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19615 @section Building Vectors
19616
19617 @noindent
19618 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19619 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19620
19621 @kindex |
19622 @pindex calc-concat
19623 @ignore
19624 @mindex @null
19625 @end ignore
19626 @tindex |
19627 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19628 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19629 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19630 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19631 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19632 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19633
19634 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19635 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19636 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19637 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19638 one-row matrix.
19639
19640 @kindex H |
19641 @tindex append
19642 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19643 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19644 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19645 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19646 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19647
19648 @kindex I |
19649 @kindex H I |
19650 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19651 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19652 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19653
19654 @kindex v d
19655 @kindex V d
19656 @pindex calc-diag
19657 @tindex diag
19658 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19659 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19660 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19661 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19662 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19663 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19664 the prefix argument is required.
19665
19666 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19667 @texline @math{3\times3}
19668 @infoline 3x3
19669 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19670 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19671 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19672
19673 @kindex v i
19674 @kindex V i
19675 @pindex calc-ident
19676 @tindex idn
19677 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19678 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19679 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19680 this command prompts for one.
19681
19682 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19683 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19684 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19685 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19686 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19687 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19688 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19689 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19690 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19691 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19692 dimensions.
19693
19694 @kindex v x
19695 @kindex V x
19696 @pindex calc-index
19697 @tindex index
19698 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19699 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19700 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19701 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19702 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19703
19704 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19705 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19706 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19707 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19708 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19709 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19710 of numbers or formulas.
19711
19712 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19713 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19714 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19715 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19716 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19717 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19718
19719 @kindex v b
19720 @kindex V b
19721 @pindex calc-build-vector
19722 @tindex cvec
19723 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19724 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19725 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19726 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19727 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19728 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19729
19730 @kindex v h
19731 @kindex V h
19732 @kindex I v h
19733 @kindex I V h
19734 @pindex calc-head
19735 @pindex calc-tail
19736 @tindex head
19737 @tindex tail
19738 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19739 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19740 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19741 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19742
19743 @kindex v k
19744 @kindex V k
19745 @pindex calc-cons
19746 @tindex cons
19747 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19748 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19749 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19750 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19751 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19752
19753 @kindex H v h
19754 @kindex H V h
19755 @tindex rhead
19756 @ignore
19757 @mindex @idots
19758 @end ignore
19759 @kindex H I v h
19760 @kindex H I V h
19761 @ignore
19762 @mindex @null
19763 @end ignore
19764 @kindex H v k
19765 @kindex H V k
19766 @ignore
19767 @mindex @null
19768 @end ignore
19769 @tindex rtail
19770 @ignore
19771 @mindex @null
19772 @end ignore
19773 @tindex rcons
19774 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19775 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19776 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19777 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19778 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19779 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19780 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19781
19782 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19783 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19784
19785 @noindent
19786 @kindex v r
19787 @kindex V r
19788 @pindex calc-mrow
19789 @tindex mrow
19790 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19791 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19792 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19793 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19794 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19795 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19796
19797 @cindex Permutations, applying
19798 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19799 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19800 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19801 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19802 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19803 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19804
19805 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19806 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19807 submatrix is returned.
19808
19809 @cindex Subscript notation
19810 @kindex a _
19811 @pindex calc-subscript
19812 @tindex subscr
19813 @tindex _
19814 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19815 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19816 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19817 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19818 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19819 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19820 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19821 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19822 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19823 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19824
19825 @tindex mrrow
19826 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19827 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19828 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19829 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19830 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19831
19832 @tindex getdiag
19833 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19834 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19835 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19836
19837 @kindex v c
19838 @kindex V c
19839 @pindex calc-mcol
19840 @tindex mcol
19841 @tindex mrcol
19842 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19843 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19844 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19845 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19846 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19847 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19848
19849 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19850 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19851 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19852 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19853 of matrix @expr{m}.
19854
19855 @kindex v s
19856 @kindex V s
19857 @pindex calc-subvector
19858 @tindex subvec
19859 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19860 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19861 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19862 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19863 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19864 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19865 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19866 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19867
19868 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19869 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19870 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19871 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19872 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19873 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19874 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19875
19876 @kindex I v s
19877 @kindex I V s
19878 @tindex rsubvec
19879 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19880 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19881 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19882 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19883 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19884
19885 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19886 vectors one element at a time.
19887
19888 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19889 @section Manipulating Vectors
19890
19891 @noindent
19892 @kindex v l
19893 @kindex V l
19894 @pindex calc-vlength
19895 @tindex vlen
19896 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19897 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19898 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19899 command.
19900
19901 @kindex H v l
19902 @kindex H V l
19903 @tindex mdims
19904 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19905 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19906 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19907 its argument is a
19908 @texline @math{2\times3}
19909 @infoline 2x3
19910 matrix.
19911
19912 @kindex v f
19913 @kindex V f
19914 @pindex calc-vector-find
19915 @tindex find
19916 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19917 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19918 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19919 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19920 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19921 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19922
19923 @kindex v a
19924 @kindex V a
19925 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
19926 @tindex arrange
19927 @cindex Arranging a matrix
19928 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
19929 @cindex Flattening a matrix
19930 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19931 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19932 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19933 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19934 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19935 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19936 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19937 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19938 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19939 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19940 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19941 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19942 @texline @math{1\times4}
19943 @infoline 1x4
19944 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19945 @texline @math{4\times1}
19946 @infoline 4x1
19947 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19948 @texline @math{2\times2}
19949 @infoline 2x2
19950 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19951 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19952 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19953
19954 @cindex Sorting data
19955 @kindex v S
19956 @kindex V S
19957 @kindex I v S
19958 @kindex I V S
19959 @pindex calc-sort
19960 @tindex sort
19961 @tindex rsort
19962 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19963 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19964 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19965 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19966 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19967 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19968 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19969 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19970 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19971 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19972 alphabetical order by this command.
19973
19974 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19975
19976 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
19977 @cindex Inverse of permutation
19978 @cindex Index tables
19979 @cindex Rank tables
19980 @kindex v G
19981 @kindex V G
19982 @kindex I v G
19983 @kindex I V G
19984 @pindex calc-grade
19985 @tindex grade
19986 @tindex rgrade
19987 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19988 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19989 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19990 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19991 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19992 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19993 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19994 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19995 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19996 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19997 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19998 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19999 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
20000
20001 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
20002 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
20003 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
20004 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
20005 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
20006 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
20007 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
20008 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
20009 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
20010 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
20011 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
20012
20013 @cindex Histograms
20014 @kindex v H
20015 @kindex V H
20016 @pindex calc-histogram
20017 @ignore
20018 @mindex histo@idots
20019 @end ignore
20020 @tindex histogram
20021 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
20022 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
20023 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
20024 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
20025 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
20026 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
20027 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
20028 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
20029 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
20030 input vector.)
20031
20032 If no prefix is given, then you will be prompted for a vector which
20033 will be used to determine the bins. (If a positive integer is given at
20034 this prompt, it will be still treated as if it were given as a
20035 prefix.) Each bin will consist of the interval of numbers closest to
20036 the corresponding number of this new vector; if the vector
20037 @expr{[a, b, c, ...]} is entered at the prompt, the bins will be
20038 @expr{(-inf, (a+b)/2]}, @expr{((a+b)/2, (b+c)/2]}, etc. The result of
20039 this command will be a vector counting how many elements of the
20040 original vector are in each bin.
20041
20042 The result will then be a vector with the same length as this new vector;
20043 each element of the new vector will be replaced by the number of
20044 elements of the original vector which are closest to it.
20045
20046 @kindex H v H
20047 @kindex H V H
20048 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20049 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20050 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20051 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20052 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20053 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20054
20055 @kindex v t
20056 @kindex V t
20057 @pindex calc-transpose
20058 @tindex trn
20059 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20060 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20061 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20062 a one-column matrix.
20063
20064 @kindex v v
20065 @kindex V v
20066 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
20067 @tindex rev
20068 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
20069 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20070 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20071 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20072 a matrix.)
20073
20074 @kindex v m
20075 @kindex V m
20076 @pindex calc-mask-vector
20077 @tindex vmask
20078 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20079 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20080 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20081 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20082 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20083 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20084 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20085 @xref{Logical Operations}.
20086
20087 @kindex v e
20088 @kindex V e
20089 @pindex calc-expand-vector
20090 @tindex vexp
20091 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20092 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20093 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20094 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20095 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20096 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20097 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20098 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20099 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20100
20101 @kindex H v e
20102 @kindex H V e
20103 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20104 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20105 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20106 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20107 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20108 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20109 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20110 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20111 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20112
20113 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20114 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20115 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20116 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20117 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20118 masking using vectors.
20119
20120 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20121 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20122
20123 @noindent
20124 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20125 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20126 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20127 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20128 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20129
20130 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20131 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20132 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20133 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20134
20135 @kindex v J
20136 @kindex V J
20137 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20138 @tindex ctrn
20139 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20140 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20141
20142 @ignore
20143 @mindex A
20144 @end ignore
20145 @kindex A (vectors)
20146 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20147 @ignore
20148 @mindex abs
20149 @end ignore
20150 @tindex abs (vectors)
20151 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20152 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20153 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20154 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20155 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20156 from that point to the origin.
20157
20158 @kindex v n
20159 @kindex V n
20160 @pindex calc-rnorm
20161 @tindex rnorm
20162 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20163 infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20164 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20165 a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20166 the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
20167
20168 @kindex v N
20169 @kindex V N
20170 @pindex calc-cnorm
20171 @tindex cnorm
20172 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20173 the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
20174 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20175 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20176 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20177 not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20178 vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
20179
20180 @kindex v C
20181 @kindex V C
20182 @pindex calc-cross
20183 @tindex cross
20184 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20185 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20186 exactly three elements.
20187
20188 @ignore
20189 @mindex &
20190 @end ignore
20191 @kindex & (matrices)
20192 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20193 @ignore
20194 @mindex inv
20195 @end ignore
20196 @tindex inv (matrices)
20197 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20198 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20199 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20200 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20201 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20202 quickly in the future.
20203
20204 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20205 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20206 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20207 by a matrix.
20208
20209 @kindex v D
20210 @kindex V D
20211 @pindex calc-mdet
20212 @tindex det
20213 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20214 determinant of a square matrix.
20215
20216 @kindex v L
20217 @kindex V L
20218 @pindex calc-mlud
20219 @tindex lud
20220 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20221 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20222 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20223 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20224 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20225 and the third is upper-triangular.
20226
20227 @kindex v T
20228 @kindex V T
20229 @pindex calc-mtrace
20230 @tindex tr
20231 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20232 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20233 elements of the matrix.
20234
20235 @kindex v K
20236 @kindex V K
20237 @pindex calc-kron
20238 @tindex kron
20239 The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20240 the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20241
20242 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20243 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20244
20245 @noindent
20246 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20247 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20248 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20249 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20250 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20251 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20252 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20253 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20254 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20255 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20256 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20257 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20258 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20259
20260 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20261 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20262 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20263 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20264 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20265 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20266
20267 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20268 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20269 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20270 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20271
20272 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20273 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20274 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20275
20276 @kindex v +
20277 @kindex V +
20278 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20279 @tindex rdup
20280 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20281 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20282 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20283 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20284 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20285 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20286 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20287 them.
20288
20289 @kindex v V
20290 @kindex V V
20291 @pindex calc-set-union
20292 @tindex vunion
20293 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20294 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20295 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20296 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20297 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20298
20299 @kindex v ^
20300 @kindex V ^
20301 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20302 @tindex vint
20303 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20304 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20305 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20306 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20307 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20308 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20309 notation for set
20310 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20311 @infoline union
20312 and
20313 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20314 @infoline intersection.
20315
20316 @kindex v -
20317 @kindex V -
20318 @pindex calc-set-difference
20319 @tindex vdiff
20320 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20321 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20322 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20323 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20324 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20325 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20326 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20327 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20328 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20329 enough to express in a few intervals).
20330
20331 @kindex v X
20332 @kindex V X
20333 @pindex calc-set-xor
20334 @tindex vxor
20335 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20336 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20337 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20338 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20339 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20340
20341 @kindex v ~
20342 @kindex V ~
20343 @pindex calc-set-complement
20344 @tindex vcompl
20345 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20346 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20347 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20348 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20349 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20350
20351 @kindex v F
20352 @kindex V F
20353 @pindex calc-set-floor
20354 @tindex vfloor
20355 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20356 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20357 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20358 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20359 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20360 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20361 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20362 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20363
20364 @kindex v E
20365 @kindex V E
20366 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20367 @tindex venum
20368 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20369 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20370 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20371 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20372 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20373
20374 @kindex v :
20375 @kindex V :
20376 @pindex calc-set-span
20377 @tindex vspan
20378 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20379 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20380 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20381 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20382 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20383
20384 @kindex v #
20385 @kindex V #
20386 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20387 @tindex vcard
20388 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20389 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20390 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20391 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20392
20393 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20394 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20395 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20396 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20397 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20398 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20399 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20400 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20401 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20402 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20403 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20404 convenient to you.
20405
20406 @kindex b p
20407 @kindex b u
20408 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20409 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20410 @tindex vpack
20411 @tindex vunpack
20412 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20413 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20414 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20415 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20416 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20417 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20418 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20419 (binary) prefix key.
20420
20421 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20422 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20423 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20424 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20425 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20426 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20427 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20428 representation
20429 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20430 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20431
20432 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20433 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20434
20435 @noindent
20436 @cindex Statistical functions
20437 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20438 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20439 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20440 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20441 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20442 Vetterling.
20443
20444 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20445 a shifted letter or other character.
20446
20447 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20448 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20449
20450 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20451 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20452
20453 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20454 probability distribution functions.
20455
20456 @menu
20457 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20458 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20459 @end menu
20460
20461 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20462 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20463
20464 @noindent
20465 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20466 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20467 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20468 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20469 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20470 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20471 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20472
20473 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20474 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20475 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20476 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20477
20478 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20479 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20480 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20481 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20482 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20483 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20484 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20485
20486 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20487 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20488 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20489 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20490 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20491 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20492 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20493 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20494 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20495 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20496
20497 @kindex u #
20498 @pindex calc-vector-count
20499 @tindex vcount
20500 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20501 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20502 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20503 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20504 simply computes the length of the vector.
20505
20506 @kindex u +
20507 @kindex u *
20508 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20509 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20510 @tindex vsum
20511 @tindex vprod
20512 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20513 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20514 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20515 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20516 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20517 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20518 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20519
20520 @kindex u X
20521 @kindex u N
20522 @pindex calc-vector-max
20523 @pindex calc-vector-min
20524 @tindex vmax
20525 @tindex vmin
20526 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20527 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20528 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20529 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20530 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20531 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20532 plus or minus infinity.
20533
20534 @kindex u M
20535 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20536 @tindex vmean
20537 @cindex Mean of data values
20538 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20539 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20540 If the inputs are error forms
20541 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20542 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20543 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20544 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20545 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20546 @tex
20547 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20548 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20549 @end tex
20550 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20551 values divided by the count of the values.
20552
20553 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20554 error
20555 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20556 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20557 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20558 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20559 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20560 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20561 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20562 weight is completely negligible.)
20563
20564 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20565 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20566 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20567 and maximum values of the interval.
20568
20569 @kindex I u M
20570 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20571 @tindex vmeane
20572 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20573 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20574 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20575 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20576 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20577 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20578 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20579 @tex
20580 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20581 @end tex
20582 If the inputs are plain
20583 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20584 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20585 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20586 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20587 deviation.)
20588 @tex
20589 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20590 @end tex
20591
20592 @kindex H u M
20593 @pindex calc-vector-median
20594 @tindex vmedian
20595 @cindex Median of data values
20596 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20597 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20598 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20599 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20600 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20601 The median function is different from the other functions in
20602 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20603 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20604 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20605 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20606 ignored.
20607
20608 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20609 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20610 the same as the mean.
20611
20612 @kindex H I u M
20613 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20614 @tindex vhmean
20615 @cindex Harmonic mean
20616 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20617 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20618 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20619 of the values.
20620 @tex
20621 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20622 @end tex
20623
20624 @kindex u G
20625 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20626 @tindex vgmean
20627 @cindex Geometric mean
20628 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20629 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20630 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20631 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20632 of the data values.
20633 @tex
20634 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20635 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20636 @end tex
20637
20638 @kindex H u G
20639 @tindex agmean
20640 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20641 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20642 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20643 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20644 @tex
20645 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20646 @end tex
20647
20648 @cindex Root-mean-square
20649 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20650 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20651
20652 @kindex u S
20653 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20654 @tindex vsdev
20655 @cindex Standard deviation
20656 @cindex Sample statistics
20657 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20658 computes the standard
20659 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20660 @infoline deviation
20661 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20662 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20663 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20664 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20665 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20666 @tex
20667 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20668 @end tex
20669
20670 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20671 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20672 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20673 limits, divided by
20674 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20675 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20676 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20677 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20678
20679 @kindex I u S
20680 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20681 @tindex vpsdev
20682 @cindex Population statistics
20683 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20684 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20685 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20686 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20687 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20688 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20689 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20690 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20691 only an estimate of the true mean.
20692 @tex
20693 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20694 @end tex
20695
20696 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20697 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20698 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20699
20700 @kindex H u S
20701 @kindex H I u S
20702 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20703 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20704 @tindex vvar
20705 @tindex vpvar
20706 @cindex Variance of data values
20707 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20708 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20709 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20710 is the
20711 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20712 @infoline square
20713 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20714 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20715 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20716
20717 @ignore
20718 @starindex
20719 @end ignore
20720 @tindex vflat
20721 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20722 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20723 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20724 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20725
20726 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20727 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20728
20729 @noindent
20730 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20731 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20732 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20733 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20734 the stack, which must be an
20735 @texline @math{N\times2}
20736 @infoline Nx2
20737 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20738 of actual vectors and matrices.
20739
20740 @kindex u C
20741 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20742 @tindex vcov
20743 @cindex Covariance
20744 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20745 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20746 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20747 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20748 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20749 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20750 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20751 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20752 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20753 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20754 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20755 input errors.
20756 @tex
20757 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20758 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20759 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20760 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20761 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20762 $$
20763 @end tex
20764
20765 @kindex I u C
20766 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20767 @tindex vpcov
20768 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20769 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20770 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20771 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20772
20773 @kindex H u C
20774 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20775 @tindex vcorr
20776 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20777 @cindex Linear correlation
20778 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20779 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20780 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20781 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20782 between sample or population statistics here.)
20783 @tex
20784 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20785 @end tex
20786
20787 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20788 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20789
20790 @noindent
20791 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20792 elements of vectors.
20793
20794 @kindex v A
20795 @kindex V A
20796 @pindex calc-apply
20797 @tindex apply
20798 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20799 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20800 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20801 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20802 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20803 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20804 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20805
20806 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20807 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20808
20809 @menu
20810 * Specifying Operators::
20811 * Mapping::
20812 * Reducing::
20813 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20814 * Generalized Products::
20815 @end menu
20816
20817 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20818 @subsection Specifying Operators
20819
20820 @noindent
20821 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20822 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20823 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20824 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20825 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20826 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20827 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20828 element as its argument.)
20829
20830 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20831 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20832 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20833 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20834 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20835 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20836 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20837 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20838 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20839 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20840 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20841 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20842 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20843 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20844 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20845
20846 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20847 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20848 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20849 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20850 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20851 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20852 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20853 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20854 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20855 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20856
20857 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20858 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20859 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20860 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20861 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20862 entry interacts with the stack.)
20863
20864 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20865 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20866 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20867 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20868 prompted for an argument list.
20869
20870 @cindex Nameless functions
20871 @cindex Generic functions
20872 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20873 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20874 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20875 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20876 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20877 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20878 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20879 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20880 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20881 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20882 can get it back later if you wish.
20883
20884 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20885 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20886 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20887 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20888 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20889
20890 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20891 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20892 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20893 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20894 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20895 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20896 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20897
20898 @cindex Lambda expressions
20899 @ignore
20900 @starindex
20901 @end ignore
20902 @tindex lambda
20903 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20904 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20905 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20906 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20907 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20908 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20909 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20910
20911 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20912 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20913 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20914 called.)
20915
20916 @tindex add
20917 @tindex sub
20918 @ignore
20919 @mindex @idots
20920 @end ignore
20921 @tindex mul
20922 @ignore
20923 @mindex @null
20924 @end ignore
20925 @tindex div
20926 @ignore
20927 @mindex @null
20928 @end ignore
20929 @tindex pow
20930 @ignore
20931 @mindex @null
20932 @end ignore
20933 @tindex neg
20934 @ignore
20935 @mindex @null
20936 @end ignore
20937 @tindex mod
20938 @ignore
20939 @mindex @null
20940 @end ignore
20941 @tindex vconcat
20942 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20943 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20944 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20945 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20946 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20947 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20948 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20949 @code{vconcat}.
20950
20951 @ignore
20952 @starindex
20953 @end ignore
20954 @tindex call
20955 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20956 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20957 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20958 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20959 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20960 as @samp{x + 2y}).
20961
20962 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20963 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20964 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20965 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20966 about it.)
20967
20968 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20969 @subsection Mapping
20970
20971 @noindent
20972 @kindex v M
20973 @kindex V M
20974 @pindex calc-map
20975 @tindex map
20976 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20977 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20978 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20979 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20980 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20981 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20982 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20983 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20984 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20985 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20986 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20987 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20988
20989 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20990 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20991 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20992 produce another
20993 @texline @math{3\times2}
20994 @infoline 3x2
20995 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20996
20997 @tindex mapr
20998 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20999 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
21000 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
21001 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
21002 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
21003 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
21004 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
21005 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
21006 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
21007
21008 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
21009 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
21010 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
21011 their individual elements.
21012
21013 @tindex mapc
21014 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
21015 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
21016 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
21017 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
21018 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
21019 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
21020
21021 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
21022 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
21023 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
21024 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
21025
21026 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
21027 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
21028 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
21029 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
21030 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
21031 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
21032
21033 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
21034 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
21035 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
21036 column.
21037
21038 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
21039 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
21040 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
21041 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
21042 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
21043 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
21044 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
21045 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
21046 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
21047 mapped over the elements of each row.)
21048
21049 @tindex mapa
21050 @tindex mapd
21051 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
21052 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
21053 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
21054 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
21055 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
21056 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
21057 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
21058 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
21059
21060 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
21061 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
21062 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
21063 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
21064
21065 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
21066 @subsection Reducing
21067
21068 @noindent
21069 @kindex v R
21070 @kindex V R
21071 @pindex calc-reduce
21072 @tindex reduce
21073 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21074 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21075 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21076 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21077 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21078 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21079 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21080 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21081
21082 @kindex I v R
21083 @kindex I V R
21084 @tindex rreduce
21085 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21086 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21087 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21088 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21089 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21090 in power series expansions.
21091
21092 @kindex v U
21093 @kindex V U
21094 @tindex accum
21095 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21096 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21097 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21098 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21099 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21100 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21101
21102 @kindex I v U
21103 @kindex I V U
21104 @tindex raccum
21105 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21106 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21107 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21108
21109 @tindex reducea
21110 @tindex rreducea
21111 @tindex reduced
21112 @tindex rreduced
21113 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21114 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21115 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21116 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21117 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21118 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21119 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21120 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21121 b + e, c + f]}.
21122
21123 @tindex reducer
21124 @tindex rreducer
21125 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21126 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21127 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21128 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21129 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21130 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21131 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21132
21133 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21134 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21135
21136 @tindex reducec
21137 @tindex rreducec
21138 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21139 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21140
21141 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21142 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21143 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21144 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21145
21146 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21147 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21148
21149 @noindent
21150 @kindex H v R
21151 @kindex H V R
21152 @tindex nest
21153 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21154 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21155 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21156 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21157 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21158 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21159 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21160
21161 @kindex H v U
21162 @kindex H V U
21163 @tindex anest
21164 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21165 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21166 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21167 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21168 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21169
21170 @kindex H I v R
21171 @kindex H I V R
21172 @tindex fixp
21173 @cindex Fixed points
21174 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21175 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21176 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21177 no longer changes.
21178
21179 @kindex H I v U
21180 @kindex H I V U
21181 @tindex afixp
21182 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21183 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21184 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21185 by @code{fixp}.
21186
21187 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21188 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21189 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21190 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21191 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21192 to converge to 0.739085.)
21193
21194 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21195 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21196 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21197 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21198 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21199 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21200 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21201
21202 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21203 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21204 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21205 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21206 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21207 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21208 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21209 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21210
21211 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21212 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21213 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21214 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21215 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21216 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21217 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21218 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21219 exactly equal.)
21220
21221 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21222 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21223 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21224 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21225
21226 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21227 @subsection Generalized Products
21228
21229 @kindex v O
21230 @kindex V O
21231 @pindex calc-outer-product
21232 @tindex outer
21233 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21234 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21235 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21236 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21237 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21238 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21239 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21240
21241 @kindex v I
21242 @kindex V I
21243 @pindex calc-inner-product
21244 @tindex inner
21245 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21246 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21247 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21248 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21249 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21250 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21251 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21252 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21253 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21254 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21255 generalized dot product.
21256
21257 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21258 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21259 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21260 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21261 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21262
21263 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21264 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21265
21266 @noindent
21267 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21268 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21269 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21270 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21271 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21272 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21273
21274 @kindex v <
21275 @kindex V <
21276 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21277 @kindex v =
21278 @kindex V =
21279 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21280 @kindex v >
21281 @kindex V >
21282 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21283 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21284 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21285 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21286 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21287
21288 @kindex v [
21289 @kindex V [
21290 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21291 @kindex v @{
21292 @kindex V @{
21293 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21294 @kindex v (
21295 @kindex V (
21296 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21297 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21298 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21299 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21300 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21301 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21302 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21303 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21304 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21305 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21306 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21307
21308 @kindex V ]
21309 @kindex v ]
21310 @kindex V )
21311 @kindex v )
21312 @kindex V @}
21313 @kindex v @}
21314 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21315 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21316 ``big'' style display of matrices, for matrices which have more than
21317 one row. It prompts for a string of code letters; currently
21318 implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables brackets on each row
21319 of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer brackets in opposite
21320 corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which enables commas or
21321 semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last. The default format
21322 is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format was fixed at @samp{ROC}.)
21323 Here are some example matrices:
21324
21325 @example
21326 @group
21327 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21328 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21329 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21330
21331 RO ROC
21332
21333 @end group
21334 @end example
21335 @noindent
21336 @example
21337 @group
21338 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21339 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21340 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21341
21342 O OC
21343
21344 @end group
21345 @end example
21346 @noindent
21347 @example
21348 @group
21349 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21350 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21351 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21352
21353 R @r{blank}
21354 @end group
21355 @end example
21356
21357 @noindent
21358 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21359 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21360 the others are useful for display only.
21361
21362 @kindex v ,
21363 @kindex V ,
21364 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21365 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21366 off in vector and matrix display.
21367
21368 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21369 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21370 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21371 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21372 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21373 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21374 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21375 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21376 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21377
21378 @kindex v .
21379 @kindex V .
21380 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21381 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21382 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21383 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21384 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21385 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21386 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21387 improve Calc's display speed.
21388
21389 @kindex t .
21390 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21391 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21392 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21393 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21394 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21395 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21396 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21397 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21398 that involve the trail.
21399
21400 @kindex v /
21401 @kindex V /
21402 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21403 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21404 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21405 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21406 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21407 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21408 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21409
21410 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21411 @chapter Algebra
21412
21413 @noindent
21414 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21415 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21416 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21417 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21418 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21419 is discussed.
21420
21421 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21422 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21423 for anything else'') prefix.
21424
21425 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21426 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21427
21428 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21429 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21430 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21431 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21432 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21433 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21434 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21435
21436 @menu
21437 * Selecting Subformulas::
21438 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21439 * Simplifying Formulas::
21440 * Polynomials::
21441 * Calculus::
21442 * Solving Equations::
21443 * Numerical Solutions::
21444 * Curve Fitting::
21445 * Summations::
21446 * Logical Operations::
21447 * Rewrite Rules::
21448 @end menu
21449
21450 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21451 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21452
21453 @noindent
21454 @cindex Selections
21455 @cindex Sub-formulas
21456 @cindex Parts of formulas
21457 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21458 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21459 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21460 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21461 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21462 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21463
21464 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21465 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21466 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21467
21468 @menu
21469 * Making Selections::
21470 * Changing Selections::
21471 * Displaying Selections::
21472 * Operating on Selections::
21473 * Rearranging with Selections::
21474 @end menu
21475
21476 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21477 @subsection Making Selections
21478
21479 @noindent
21480 @kindex j s
21481 @pindex calc-select-here
21482 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21483 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21484 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21485 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21486 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21487 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21488 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21489
21490 @smallexample
21491 @group
21492 3 ___
21493 (a + b) + V c
21494 1: ---------------
21495 2 x + 1
21496 @end group
21497 @end smallexample
21498
21499 @noindent
21500 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21501 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21502 to
21503
21504 @smallexample
21505 @group
21506 . ...
21507 .. . b. . . .
21508 1* ...............
21509 . . . .
21510 @end group
21511 @end smallexample
21512
21513 @noindent
21514 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21515 to a dot. (If the customizable variable
21516 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the characters
21517 not part of the sub-formula are de-emphasized by using a less
21518 noticeable face instead of using dots. @pxref{Displaying Selections}.)
21519 The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21520 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21521 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21522 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21523 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21524
21525 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21526 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21527
21528 @smallexample
21529 @group
21530 . ...
21531 (a + b) . . .
21532 1* ...............
21533 . . . .
21534 @end group
21535 @end smallexample
21536
21537 @noindent
21538 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21539 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21540 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21541 would have had the same effect.
21542
21543 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21544 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21545 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21546 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21547
21548 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21549 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21550 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21551 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21552 and so on.
21553
21554 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21555 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21556
21557 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21558 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21559 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21560 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21561 cursor on any stack entry.
21562
21563 @kindex j a
21564 @pindex calc-select-additional
21565 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21566 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21567 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21568 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21569 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21570 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21571
21572 @kindex j o
21573 @pindex calc-select-once
21574 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21575 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21576 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21577 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21578 by the cursor.
21579
21580 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21581 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21582 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21583 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21584
21585 @kindex j S
21586 @kindex j O
21587 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21588 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21589 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21590 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21591 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21592 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21593 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21594 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21595 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21596 commands.
21597
21598 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21599 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21600 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21601 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21602 entire four-term sum.
21603
21604 @kindex j b
21605 @pindex calc-break-selections
21606 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21607 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21608 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21609 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21610 obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21611 right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21612 with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21613 c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21614 considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21615 although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21616 as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21617 U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21618 (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21619
21620 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21621 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21622 you get.
21623
21624 @kindex j u
21625 @pindex calc-unselect
21626 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21627 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21628 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21629 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21630 position.
21631
21632 @kindex j c
21633 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21634 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21635 stack elements.
21636
21637 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21638 @subsection Changing Selections
21639
21640 @noindent
21641 @kindex j m
21642 @pindex calc-select-more
21643 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21644 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21645 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21646
21647 @smallexample
21648 @group
21649 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21650 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21651 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21652 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21653 @end group
21654 @end smallexample
21655
21656 @noindent
21657 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21658 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21659 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21660
21661 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21662 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21663 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21664 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21665 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21666
21667 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21668 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21669 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21670 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21671
21672 @kindex j l
21673 @pindex calc-select-less
21674 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21675 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21676 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21677 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21678 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21679
21680 @kindex j 1-9
21681 @pindex calc-select-part
21682 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21683 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21684 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21685 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21686 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21687 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21688 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21689 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21690
21691 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21692 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21693 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21694 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21695 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21696
21697 @kindex j n
21698 @kindex j p
21699 @pindex calc-select-next
21700 @pindex calc-select-previous
21701 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21702 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21703 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21704 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21705 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21706 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21707 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21708 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21709 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21710 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21711
21712 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21713 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21714 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21715
21716 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21717 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21718 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21719 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21720 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21721 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21722 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21723 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21724 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21725
21726 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21727 @subsection Displaying Selections
21728
21729 @noindent
21730 @kindex j d
21731 @pindex calc-show-selections
21732 @vindex calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
21733 @vindex calc-selected-face
21734 @vindex calc-nonselected-face
21735 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21736 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21737 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21738 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21739 by @samp{#} signs:
21740
21741 @smallexample
21742 @group
21743 3 ... # ___
21744 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21745 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21746 . . . . 2 x + 1
21747 @end group
21748 @end smallexample
21749 If the customizable variable
21750 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the
21751 non-selected portion of the formula will be de-emphasized by using a
21752 less noticeable face (@code{calc-nonselected-face}) instead of dots
21753 and the selected sub-formula will be highlighted by using a more
21754 noticeable face (@code{calc-selected-face}) instead of @samp{#}
21755 signs. (@pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
21756
21757 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21758 @subsection Operating on Selections
21759
21760 @noindent
21761 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21762 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21763 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21764 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21765 given stack element.)
21766
21767 @kindex j e
21768 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21769 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21770 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21771 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21772 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21773 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21774 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21775
21776 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21777 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21778 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21779 element.
21780
21781 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21782 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21783 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21784 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21785 portion to the top of the stack.
21786
21787 @smallexample
21788 @group
21789 3 ... ... ___
21790 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21791 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21792 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21793
21794 3 3
21795 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21796 @end group
21797 @end smallexample
21798
21799 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21800 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21801 the complete, edited formula.
21802
21803 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21804 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21805
21806 @kindex j '
21807 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21808 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21809 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21810 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21811 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21812 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21813 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21814 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21815 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21816 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21817
21818 @kindex j `
21819 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21820 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21821 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21822 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21823 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21824
21825 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21826 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21827 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21828 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21829
21830 @smallexample
21831 @group
21832 ###
21833 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21834 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21835 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21836 @end group
21837 @end smallexample
21838
21839 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21840 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21841 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21842 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21843 and resimplifies.
21844
21845 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21846 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21847 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21848
21849 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21850 @pindex calc-del-selection
21851 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21852 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21853 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21854 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21855 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21856
21857 @kindex j @key{RET}
21858 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21859 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21860 command.)
21861
21862 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21863 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21864 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21865 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21866
21867 @smallexample
21868 @group
21869 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21870 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21871 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21872 V 4 - 2 x
21873 @end group
21874 @end smallexample
21875
21876 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21877 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21878 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21879 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21880 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21881 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21882 the command will abort with an error message.
21883
21884 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21885 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21886 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21887 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21888
21889 @smallexample
21890 @group
21891 .. . .. .
21892 1* .......... 1* ...........
21893 ......... ..........
21894 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21895 @end group
21896 @end smallexample
21897
21898 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21899 normally have canceled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21900 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21901 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21902 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21903 to be simplified.
21904
21905 @smallexample
21906 @group
21907 17 y 17 y
21908 1: ----------- 1: ----------
21909 __________ _________
21910 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21911 @end group
21912 @end smallexample
21913
21914 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21915 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21916
21917 @noindent
21918 @kindex j R
21919 @pindex calc-commute-right
21920 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21921 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21922 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21923 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21924
21925 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21926 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21927 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21928 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21929
21930 @smallexample
21931 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21932 @end smallexample
21933
21934 @noindent
21935 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21936 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21937 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21938 mathematical meaning of the formula.
21939
21940 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21941 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21942 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21943 course be drastically changed.
21944
21945 @smallexample
21946 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21947
21948 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21949 @end smallexample
21950
21951 @kindex j L
21952 @pindex calc-commute-left
21953 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21954 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21955
21956 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21957 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21958 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21959 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21960 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21961
21962 @kindex j D
21963 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
21964 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21965 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21966 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21967 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21968 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21969 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21970 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21971 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21972
21973 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21974 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21975 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21976 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21977 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21978 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21979
21980 @vindex DistribRules
21981 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21982 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21983 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21984 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21985 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21986 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21987 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21988
21989 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21990 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21991 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21992 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
21993
21994 @kindex j M
21995 @pindex calc-sel-merge
21996 @vindex MergeRules
21997 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21998 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21999 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
22000 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
22001 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
22002 the relevant rules.
22003
22004 @kindex j C
22005 @pindex calc-sel-commute
22006 @vindex CommuteRules
22007 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
22008 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
22009 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
22010 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
22011 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
22012 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
22013 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
22014 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
22015 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
22016
22017 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
22018 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
22019 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
22020 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
22021 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
22022 manipulations described in this section.
22023
22024 @kindex j N
22025 @pindex calc-sel-negate
22026 @vindex NegateRules
22027 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
22028 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
22029 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
22030 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
22031 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
22032 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
22033 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
22034 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
22035
22036 @kindex j &
22037 @pindex calc-sel-invert
22038 @vindex InvertRules
22039 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
22040 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
22041 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
22042 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
22043
22044 @kindex j E
22045 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
22046 @vindex JumpRules
22047 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
22048 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
22049 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
22050 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
22051 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
22052 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
22053
22054 @kindex j I
22055 @kindex H j I
22056 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
22057 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
22058 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
22059 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
22060 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
22061 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
22062 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
22063 as well as equations.
22064
22065 @kindex j *
22066 @kindex j /
22067 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
22068 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
22069 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
22070 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
22071 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It performs the
22072 default algebraic simplifications before re-forming the
22073 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
22074 providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
22075 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
22076 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
22077
22078 If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
22079 simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
22080 this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
22081 1 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
22082 distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
22083 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
22084 top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
22085 normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
22086 to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
22087 expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
22088
22089 If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
22090 of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
22091 example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
22092 wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
22093 the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
22094 a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
22095 @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
22096 you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
22097 bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
22098 generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
22099 integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
22100 expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
22101
22102 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
22103 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
22104 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
22105 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
22106 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
22107 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
22108 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
22109 message.
22110
22111 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
22112 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
22113 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
22114 back by the formula.
22115
22116 @kindex j +
22117 @kindex j -
22118 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22119 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22120 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22121 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22122 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22123 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22124 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22125 results.
22126
22127 @kindex j U
22128 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
22129 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22130 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22131 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22132 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22133 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22134 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22135
22136 @kindex j v
22137 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22138 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22139 basic simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22140 These simplifications would normally be done automatically
22141 on all results, but may have been partially inhibited by
22142 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22143 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22144 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22145
22146 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22147 the default algebraic simplifications to the selected
22148 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22149 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22150 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22151 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22152 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22153 sub-formula.
22154
22155 @kindex j "
22156 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22157 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22158 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22159
22160 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22161 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22162
22163 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22164 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22165
22166 @noindent
22167 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22168 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22169 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22170 formula).
22171
22172 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22173 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22174 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22175 from the second-to-top stack level.
22176
22177 @kindex a v
22178 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22179 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22180 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22181 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22182 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22183 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22184 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22185
22186 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22187 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22188 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22189
22190 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22191 using Calc's algebraic simplifications; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}.
22192 If you give a numeric prefix of 3 or more, it uses Extended
22193 Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22194
22195 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22196 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22197 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22198 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22199 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22200 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22201 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22202 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22203 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22204
22205 @tindex evalv
22206 @tindex evalvn
22207 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22208 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22209 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22210 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22211 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22212 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22213 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22214
22215 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22216 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22217 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22218 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22219 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22220 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22221 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22222 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22223 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22224 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22225 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22226 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22227
22228 @kindex a "
22229 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22230 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22231 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22232 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22233 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22234 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22235 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22236 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22237 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22238 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22239 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22240 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22241 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22242 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22243 top-level function call.
22244
22245 @kindex a M
22246 @pindex calc-map-equation
22247 @tindex mapeq
22248 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22249 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22250 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22251 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22252 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22253 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22254 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22255 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22256 respective sides of a new equation.
22257
22258 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22259 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22260 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22261 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22262 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22263 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22264 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22265 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22266 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the algebraic simplifications
22267 can reduce to @samp{2 < b}.
22268
22269 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22270 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22271 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22272 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22273 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22274
22275 @kindex H a M
22276 @tindex mapeqp
22277 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22278 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22279 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22280 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22281 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22282
22283 @kindex I a M
22284 @tindex mapeqr
22285 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22286 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22287 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22288 working with small positive angles.
22289
22290 @kindex a b
22291 @pindex calc-substitute
22292 @tindex subst
22293 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22294 all occurrences
22295 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22296 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22297 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22298 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22299 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22300 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22301 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22302 doing substitutions.
22303
22304 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22305 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22306 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22307 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22308 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22309 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22310 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22311
22312 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22313 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22314 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22315 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22316 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22317 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22318 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22319 these limitations.
22320
22321 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22322 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22323 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22324 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22325 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22326
22327 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22328 @section Simplifying Formulas
22329
22330 @noindent
22331 @kindex a s
22332 @kindex I a s
22333 @kindex H a s
22334 @pindex calc-simplify
22335 @tindex simplify
22336
22337 The sections below describe all the various kinds of
22338 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22339 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22340 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22341 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22342 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22343 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22344 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22345
22346 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22347 simplification occurs automatically. Normally the algebraic
22348 simplifications described below occur. If you have turned on a
22349 simplification mode which does not do these algebraic simplifications,
22350 you can still apply them to a formula with the @kbd{a s}
22351 (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command.
22352
22353 There are some simplifications that, while sometimes useful, are never
22354 done automatically. For example, the @kbd{I} prefix can be given to
22355 @kbd{a s}; the @kbd{I a s} command will change any trigonometric
22356 function to the appropriate combination of @samp{sin}s and @samp{cos}s
22357 before simplifying. This can be useful in simplifying even mildly
22358 complicated trigonometric expressions. For example, while the algebraic
22359 simplifications can reduce @samp{sin(x) csc(x)} to @samp{1}, they will not
22360 simplify @samp{sin(x)^2 csc(x)}. The command @kbd{I a s} can be used to
22361 simplify this latter expression; it will transform @samp{sin(x)^2
22362 csc(x)} into @samp{sin(x)}. However, @kbd{I a s} will also perform
22363 some ``simplifications'' which may not be desired; for example, it
22364 will transform @samp{tan(x)^2} into @samp{sin(x)^2 / cos(x)^2}. The
22365 Hyperbolic prefix @kbd{H} can be used similarly; the @kbd{H a s} will
22366 replace any hyperbolic functions in the formula with the appropriate
22367 combinations of @samp{sinh}s and @samp{cosh}s before simplifying.
22368
22369
22370 @menu
22371 * Basic Simplifications::
22372 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22373 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22374 * Simplification of Units::
22375 @end menu
22376
22377 @node Basic Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22378 @subsection Basic Simplifications
22379
22380 @noindent
22381 @cindex Basic simplifications
22382 This section describes basic simplifications which Calc performs in many
22383 situations. For example, both binary simplifications and algebraic
22384 simplifications begin by performing these basic simplifications. You
22385 can type @kbd{m I} to restrict the simplifications done on the stack to
22386 these simplifications.
22387
22388 The most basic simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22389 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22390 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22391 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22392 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22393 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22394 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22395 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22396
22397 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22398 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22399 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22400 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22401 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22402 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22403 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22404 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22405
22406 Most commands apply at least these basic simplifications to all
22407 arguments they take from the stack, perform a particular operation,
22408 then simplify the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the
22409 common special case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and
22410 @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}], the arguments are simply popped from the stack
22411 and collected into a suitable function call, which is then simplified
22412 (the arguments being simplified first as part of the process, as
22413 described above).
22414
22415 Even the basic set of simplifications are too numerous to describe
22416 completely here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22417 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22418 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22419 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22420
22421 @tex
22422 \bigskip
22423 @end tex
22424
22425 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22426 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22427 will also be applied before any of the basic simplifications.
22428 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22429
22430 @tex
22431 \bigskip
22432 @end tex
22433
22434 And now, on with the basic simplifications:
22435
22436 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22437 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22438 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22439 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22440 (by default) a right-associative form for products,
22441 @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22442 rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22443 Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22444 and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22445 associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22446 below.
22447
22448 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22449 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22450 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22451 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22452 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22453 If you are using Basic Simplification mode, Calc assumes you have put
22454 the terms into the order you want and generally leaves that order alone,
22455 with the consequence that formulas like the above will only be
22456 simplified if you explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command.
22457 @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
22458
22459 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22460 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22461 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22462 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22463 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22464 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22465 negative-looking.
22466
22467 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22468 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22469 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22470 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22471 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22472 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22473 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22474 simplifications.)
22475
22476 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22477 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22478 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22479 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22480 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22481 using the distributive law.
22482
22483 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22484 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22485 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22486 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22487 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22488 square of the number of terms; Calc omits potentially slow
22489 operations like this in basic simplification mode.
22490
22491 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22492 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22493 to @expr{-a}.
22494
22495 @tex
22496 \bigskip
22497 @end tex
22498
22499 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22500 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22501 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22502 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22503 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22504 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22505
22506 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22507 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22508 numbers.
22509
22510 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22511 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22512
22513 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22514 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22515 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22516 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22517 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22518
22519 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22520 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22521 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22522 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22523 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22524 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22525 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22526 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22527 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22528 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22529
22530 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22531 power is changed to use division:
22532 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22533 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22534 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22535 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22536 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22537
22538 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22539 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22540
22541 @tex
22542 \bigskip
22543 @end tex
22544
22545 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22546 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22547 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22548 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22549 respectively.
22550
22551 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22552 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22553 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22554
22555 The expression
22556 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22557 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22558 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22559 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22560 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22561 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22562 for any power @expr{c}.
22563
22564 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22565 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22566 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22567 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22568 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22569
22570 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22571 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22572 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22573 described for multiplication.
22574
22575 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22576 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22577 is canceled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22578 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22579 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22580
22581 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22582 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22583 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22584
22585 @tex
22586 \bigskip
22587 @end tex
22588
22589 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22590 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22591 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22592 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22593 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22594 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22595
22596 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22597 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22598 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22599 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22600 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22601 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22602 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22603 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22604 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22605 (In other words,
22606 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22607 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22608 is safe to simplify, but
22609 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22610 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22611 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22612 variables satisfy these requirements.
22613
22614 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22615 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22616 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22617 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22618
22619 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22620 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22621 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22622
22623 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22624 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22625 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22626
22627 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22628 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22629 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22630 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22631
22632 Also, note that
22633 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22634 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22635 is changed to
22636 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22637 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22638 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22639
22640 @tex
22641 \bigskip
22642 @end tex
22643
22644 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22645 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22646 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22647 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22648 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22649 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22650 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22651 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22652 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22653 @expr{n} is an integer.
22654
22655 @tex
22656 \bigskip
22657 @end tex
22658
22659 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22660 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22661 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22662 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22663 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22664 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22665
22666 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22667 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22668 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22669 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22670 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22671
22672 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22673 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22674 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22675
22676 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22677 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22678 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22679 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22680 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22681 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22682 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22683
22684 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22685 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22686 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The algebraic
22687 simplifications described in the next section do provide some
22688 simplifications for these functions, though.
22689
22690 One important simplification that does occur is that
22691 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22692 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22693 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22694 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22695
22696 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22697 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22698 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22699 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22700 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22701 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22702
22703 Most other Calc functions have few if any basic simplifications
22704 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22705 suitable numbers.
22706
22707 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Basic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22708 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22709
22710 @noindent
22711 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22712 @kindex a s
22713 @kindex m A
22714 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22715 the algebraic simplification mode, which is the default simplification
22716 mode. If you have switched to a different simplification mode, you can
22717 switch back with the @kbd{m A} command. Even in other simplification
22718 modes, the @kbd{a s} command will use these algebraic simplifications to
22719 simplify the formula.
22720
22721 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22722 to be applied. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22723 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22724 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22725 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22726 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22727 the original expression, the process repeats with the basic
22728 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22729 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22730
22731 @tex
22732 \bigskip
22733 @end tex
22734
22735 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22736 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22737 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22738 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22739 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22740
22741 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22742 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22743 adjacent terms, but Calc's algebraic simplifications compare all pairs
22744 of terms including non-adjacent ones.
22745
22746 @tex
22747 \bigskip
22748 @end tex
22749
22750 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22751 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22752 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the basic
22753 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22754 but the algebraic simplifications; it first rewrites the sum to
22755 @expr{x y + x y} which can then be recognized as a sum of identical
22756 terms.
22757
22758 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22759 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22760 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22761 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22762
22763 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22764 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22765 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22766
22767 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22768 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22769 use for adjacent terms of products.
22770
22771 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22772 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22773 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22774 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22775 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22776 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22777 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22778
22779 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22780 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22781 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22782 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22783 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22784
22785 @tex
22786 \bigskip
22787 @end tex
22788
22789 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22790 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22791 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22792 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22793 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22794 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22795 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is canceled out;
22796 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22797
22798 Non-constant common factors are not found even by algebraic
22799 simplifications. To cancel the factor @expr{a} in
22800 @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first use @kbd{j M} on the product
22801 @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be
22802 simplified successfully.
22803
22804 @tex
22805 \bigskip
22806 @end tex
22807
22808 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22809 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22810 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22811 will no longer occur. This is not done by the basic
22812 simplifications; in case someone (unwisely) wants to use the name
22813 @code{i} for a variable unrelated to complex numbers, they can use
22814 basic simplification mode.
22815
22816 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22817 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22818 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22819 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22820 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22821 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22822 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22823 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22824 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22825
22826 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22827 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22828 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22829 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22830
22831 @tex
22832 \bigskip
22833 @end tex
22834
22835 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22836 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22837 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22838 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22839 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22840
22841 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22842 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22843 canceled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22844 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22845 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22846 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22847 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22848
22849 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22850 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22851 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22852 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22853 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22854 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22855 declared to be an integer.
22856
22857 @tex
22858 \bigskip
22859 @end tex
22860
22861 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22862 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22863 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22864 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22865 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22866 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22867 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22868 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22869
22870 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22871 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22872 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22873 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22874 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22875 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22876
22877 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22878 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22879 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22880 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22881
22882 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22883 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22884 hyperbolic functions.
22885
22886 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22887 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22888 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22889 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22890 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22891 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22892 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22893 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22894 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22895
22896 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22897 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22898 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22899 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22900 and
22901 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22902 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
22903 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22904 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22905 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22906 is a suitable multiple of
22907 @texline @math{\pi i}
22908 @infoline @expr{pi i}
22909 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22910 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22911 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22912 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22913 negative imaginary.
22914
22915 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22916 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22917 function.
22918
22919 @tex
22920 \bigskip
22921 @end tex
22922
22923 Equations and inequalities are simplified by canceling factors
22924 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22925 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is canceled.
22926 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22927 canceled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22928 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22929 are canceled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22930 sign is known.
22931
22932 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
22933 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22934 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22935 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22936 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22937 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22938 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22939
22940 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22941 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22942
22943 @noindent
22944 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
22945 @cindex Extended simplification
22946 @kindex a e
22947 @kindex m E
22948 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
22949 @ignore
22950 @mindex esimpl@idots
22951 @end ignore
22952 @tindex esimplify
22953 Calc is capable of performing some simplifications which may sometimes
22954 be desired but which are not ``safe'' in all cases. The @kbd{a e}
22955 (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22956 applies the algebraic simplifications as well as these extended, or
22957 ``unsafe'', simplifications. Use this only if you know the values in
22958 your formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these
22959 simplifications are valid. You can use Extended Simplification mode
22960 (@kbd{m E}) to have these simplifications done automatically.
22961
22962 The symbolic integrator uses these extended simplifications; one effect
22963 of this is that the integrator's results must be used with caution.
22964 Where an integral table will often attach conditions like ``for positive
22965 @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic integration programs)
22966 will simply produce an unqualified result.
22967
22968 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22969 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22970 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22971 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22972 to any specific part of a formula.
22973
22974 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied when
22975 the extended simplifications are used. These are applied in addition to
22976 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22977 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22978
22979 Following is a complete list of the ``unsafe'' simplifications.
22980
22981 @tex
22982 \bigskip
22983 @end tex
22984
22985 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22986 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified.
22987 For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
22988 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
22989 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
22990 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22991 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22992 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22993 functions always produce.
22994
22995 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22996 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
22997 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22998 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22999 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
23000 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
23001 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
23002 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
23003 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
23004
23005 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
23006 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
23007 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
23008 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
23009
23010 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
23011 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
23012 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
23013
23014 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
23015 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
23016 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
23017 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
23018
23019 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
23020 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
23021 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
23022 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
23023
23024 Common factors are canceled from products on both sides of an
23025 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
23026 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never canceled from
23027 inequalities: Even the extended simplifications are not bold enough to
23028 reduce @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
23029 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
23030 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
23031 both sides of an inequality.
23032
23033 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23034 @subsection Simplification of Units
23035
23036 @noindent
23037 The simplifications described in this section (as well as the algebraic
23038 simplifications) are applied when units need to be simplified. They can
23039 be applied using the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command, or
23040 will be done automatically in Units Simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
23041 @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
23042
23043 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
23044 units simplifications. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
23045 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
23046
23047 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
23048 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
23049
23050 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
23051 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
23052 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
23053 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
23054 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
23055 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
23056
23057 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
23058 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
23059 leading unit are modified accordingly.
23060
23061 When canceling and combining units in products and quotients,
23062 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
23063 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
23064 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
23065 are not combined in this way.
23066
23067 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
23068 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
23069 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
23070
23071 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
23072 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
23073 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
23074 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
23075 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
23076
23077 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
23078 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
23079 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
23080
23081 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
23082 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
23083 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
23084 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
23085 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
23086 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
23087 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
23088 real.)
23089
23090 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
23091 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
23092 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
23093 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
23094 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
23095 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
23096 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
23097 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
23098 replaced by approximately
23099 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
23100 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
23101 which is then changed to
23102 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
23103 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
23104 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
23105
23106 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
23107 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
23108 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
23109 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
23110 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
23111 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
23112
23113 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
23114 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
23115 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
23116 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
23117
23118 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
23119 @section Polynomials
23120
23121 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
23122 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
23123 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
23124 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
23125 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
23126 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
23127 involving the base variable.
23128
23129 @kindex a f
23130 @pindex calc-factor
23131 @tindex factor
23132 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
23133 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
23134 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
23135 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
23136 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23137
23138 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23139 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23140 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23141 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23142 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23143 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23144 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23145 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23146 rewrite mechanism.
23147
23148 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23149 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23150 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23151 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23152 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23153 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23154 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23155 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23156 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23157 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23158 version of Calc.)
23159
23160 @vindex FactorRules
23161 @ignore
23162 @starindex
23163 @end ignore
23164 @tindex thecoefs
23165 @ignore
23166 @starindex
23167 @end ignore
23168 @ignore
23169 @mindex @idots
23170 @end ignore
23171 @tindex thefactors
23172 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23173 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23174 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23175 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23176 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23177 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23178 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23179 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23180 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23181 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23182 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23183 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23184 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23185 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23186 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23187 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23188 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23189 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23190
23191 @kindex H a f
23192 @tindex factors
23193 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23194 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23195 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23196 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23197 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23198 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23199 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23200 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23201 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23202 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23203 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23204
23205 @kindex a c
23206 @pindex calc-collect
23207 @tindex collect
23208 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23209 formula as a
23210 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23211 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23212 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23213 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23214 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23215 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23216 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23217 not be expanded.
23218
23219 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23220 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23221 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23222 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23223 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23224
23225 @kindex a x
23226 @pindex calc-expand
23227 @tindex expand
23228 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23229 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23230 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23231 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23232 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23233 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23234
23235 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23236 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23237 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23238 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23239 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23240 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23241 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23242 do not do.)
23243
23244 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23245 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23246 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23247 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23248 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23249 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23250 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23251 the way in one step.
23252
23253 @kindex a a
23254 @pindex calc-apart
23255 @tindex apart
23256 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23257 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23258 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23259 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23260 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23261 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23262 chooses the base variable automatically.
23263
23264 @kindex a n
23265 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23266 @tindex nrat
23267 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23268 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23269 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23270 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23271 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23272 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23273
23274 @kindex a \
23275 @pindex calc-poly-div
23276 @tindex pdiv
23277 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23278 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23279 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23280 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23281 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23282 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23283 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23284 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23285 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23286
23287 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23288 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23289 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23290 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23291 above.
23292
23293 @kindex a %
23294 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23295 @tindex prem
23296 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23297 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23298 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23299 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23300 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23301 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23302
23303 @kindex a /
23304 @kindex H a /
23305 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23306 @tindex pdivrem
23307 @tindex pdivide
23308 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23309 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23310 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23311 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23312 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23313 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23314
23315 @kindex a g
23316 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23317 @tindex pgcd
23318 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23319 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23320 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23321 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23322 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23323 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23324 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23325 leaving a remainder.)
23326
23327 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23328 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23329 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23330 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23331 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23332 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23333 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23334
23335 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23336 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23337 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23338
23339 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23340 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23341
23342 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23343 @section Calculus
23344
23345 @noindent
23346 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23347 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23348 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23349 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23350 readable way.
23351
23352 @menu
23353 * Differentiation::
23354 * Integration::
23355 * Customizing the Integrator::
23356 * Numerical Integration::
23357 * Taylor Series::
23358 @end menu
23359
23360 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23361 @subsection Differentiation
23362
23363 @noindent
23364 @kindex a d
23365 @kindex H a d
23366 @pindex calc-derivative
23367 @tindex deriv
23368 @tindex tderiv
23369 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23370 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23371 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23372 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23373 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23374 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23375 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23376 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23377 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23378 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23379 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23380
23381 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23382 @var{n}th derivative.
23383
23384 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23385 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23386 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23387 answer!
23388
23389 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23390 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23391 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23392 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23393 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23394
23395 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23396 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23397 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23398 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23399 derivative of @code{f}.
23400
23401 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23402 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23403 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23404 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23405 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23406 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23407 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23408 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23409
23410 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23411 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23412 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23413 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23414 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23415 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23416 argument once).
23417
23418 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23419 @subsection Integration
23420
23421 @noindent
23422 @kindex a i
23423 @pindex calc-integral
23424 @tindex integ
23425 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23426 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23427 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23428 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23429 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23430 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23431 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23432 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23433 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23434 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23435 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23436 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23437 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23438 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23439
23440 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23441 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23442 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23443 lower limit and an upper limit.
23444
23445 @ifnottex
23446 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23447 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23448 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23449 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23450 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23451 @end ifnottex
23452 @tex
23453 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23454 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23455 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23456 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23457 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23458 @end tex
23459
23460 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23461 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23462 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23463 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23464 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23465 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23466 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23467 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23468 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23469 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23470 Calc's solution for
23471 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23472 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23473 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23474 constant factor of
23475 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23476 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23477 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23478
23479 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23480 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23481 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23482 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23483 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23484
23485 @vindex IntegLimit
23486 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23487 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23488 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23489 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23490 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23491 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23492 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23493 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23494 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23495 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23496 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23497 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23498
23499 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23500 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23501 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23502 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23503 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23504
23505 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23506 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23507
23508 @noindent
23509 @vindex IntegRules
23510 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23511 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23512 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23513 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23514 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23515 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23516 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23517 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23518 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23519 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23520 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23521 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23522 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23523 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23524 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23525 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23526
23527 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23528 @ignore
23529 @starindex
23530 @end ignore
23531 @tindex Ei
23532 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23533 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23534 integral'' function
23535 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23536 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23537 was invented to describe it.
23538 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23539 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23540 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23541 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23542 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23543 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23544 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23545 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23546 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23547
23548 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23549 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23550 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23551 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23552 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23553 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23554 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23555 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23556 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23557 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23558 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23559 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23560 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23561
23562 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23563 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23564 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23565 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23566 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23567 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23568 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23569 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23570 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23571 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23572 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23573 it need not be.
23574
23575 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23576 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23577 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23578 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23579 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23580 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23581 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23582 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23583 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23584 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23585 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23586 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23587 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23588 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23589
23590 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23591 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23592 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23593 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23594 forever!)
23595
23596 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23597 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23598 every time the integrator uses algebraic simplifications to simplify an
23599 intermediate result. For example, putting the rule
23600 @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to
23601 convert the @code{twice} function into a form it knows whenever
23602 integration is attempted.
23603
23604 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23605 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23606 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23607 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23608 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23609 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23610 do this.)
23611
23612 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23613 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23614 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23615 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23616 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23617 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23618 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23619 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23620 (It also does algebraic simplifications, without @code{IntegSimpRules},
23621 after that to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23622 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23623 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23624 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23625 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23626 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23627 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23628 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23629 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23630
23631 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23632 @subsection Numerical Integration
23633
23634 @noindent
23635 @kindex a I
23636 @pindex calc-num-integral
23637 @tindex ninteg
23638 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23639 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23640 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23641 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23642 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23643 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23644
23645 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23646 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23647 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23648 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23649 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23650 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23651 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23652 determine the value of the integral.
23653
23654 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23655 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23656 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23657 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23658 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23659 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23660
23661 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23662 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23663 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23664 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23665 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23666 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23667 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23668
23669 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23670 @subsection Taylor Series
23671
23672 @noindent
23673 @kindex a t
23674 @pindex calc-taylor
23675 @tindex taylor
23676 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23677 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23678 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23679 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23680 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23681 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23682 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23683 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23684 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23685
23686 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23687 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23688 Taylor series.
23689
23690 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23691 @section Solving Equations
23692
23693 @noindent
23694 @kindex a S
23695 @pindex calc-solve-for
23696 @tindex solve
23697 @cindex Equations, solving
23698 @cindex Solving equations
23699 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23700 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23701 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23702 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23703 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23704 form @expr{X = 0}.
23705
23706 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23707 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23708 be; for example, solving
23709 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23710 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23711 for @expr{b} is impossible
23712 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23713 produce the result
23714 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23715 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23716 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23717 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23718 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23719 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23720 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23721 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23722
23723 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23724 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23725 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23726 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23727
23728 @menu
23729 * Multiple Solutions::
23730 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23731 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23732 @end menu
23733
23734 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23735 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23736
23737 @noindent
23738 @kindex H a S
23739 @tindex fsolve
23740 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23741 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23742 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23743 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23744 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23745 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23746 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23747 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23748 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23749 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23750 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23751 of these variables.
23752
23753 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23754 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23755 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23756 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23757 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23758 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23759 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23760 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23761
23762 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23763 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23764 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23765 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23766 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23767 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23768 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23769 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23770
23771 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23772 @vindex GenCount
23773 @ignore
23774 @starindex
23775 @end ignore
23776 @tindex an
23777 @ignore
23778 @starindex
23779 @end ignore
23780 @tindex as
23781 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23782 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23783 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23784 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23785 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23786 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23787 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23788 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23789 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23790 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23791 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23792 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23793 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23794 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23795
23796 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23797 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23798
23799 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23800 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23801 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23802
23803 @kindex I a S
23804 @kindex H I a S
23805 @tindex finv
23806 @tindex ffinv
23807 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23808 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23809 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23810 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23811 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23812 fully general inverse, as described above.
23813
23814 @kindex a P
23815 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23816 @tindex roots
23817 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23818 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23819 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23820 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23821 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23822 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23823 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23824 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23825 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23826 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23827 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23828 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23829 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23830
23831 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23832 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23833 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23834 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23835 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23836 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23837 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23838 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23839 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23840 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23841 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23842 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23843 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23844 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23845 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23846 are all numbers (real or complex).
23847
23848 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23849 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23850
23851 @noindent
23852 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23853 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23854 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23855 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23856 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23857 at the prompt.)
23858
23859 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23860 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23861 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23862 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23863 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23864 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23865 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23866 command.
23867
23868 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23869 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23870 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23871 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23872 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23873 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23874 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23875 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23876 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23877 nonlinear systems.
23878
23879 @ignore
23880 @starindex
23881 @end ignore
23882 @tindex elim
23883 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23884 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23885 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23886 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23887 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23888 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23889 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23890 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23891 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23892 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23893 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23894 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23895
23896 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23897 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23898 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23899 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23900 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23901 by one.
23902
23903 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23904 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23905 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23906 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23907 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23908 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23909 variables you requested.)
23910
23911 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23912 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23913 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23914
23915 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23916 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23917
23918 @noindent
23919 @ignore
23920 @starindex
23921 @end ignore
23922 @tindex poly
23923 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23924 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23925 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23926 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23927 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23928 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23929 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23930 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23931 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23932 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23933 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23934 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23935
23936 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23937 @cindex Degree of polynomial
23938 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23939 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23940 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23941 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23942 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23943
23944 @ignore
23945 @starindex
23946 @end ignore
23947 @tindex gpoly
23948 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23949 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23950 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23951 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23952 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23953 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23954 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23955 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23956 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23957 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23958 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23959 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23960 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23961 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23962 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23963 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23964 is considered trivial.
23965
23966 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23967 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23968
23969 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23970 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23971 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23972 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23973 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23974
23975 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23976 discover:
23977
23978 @smallexample
23979 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23980 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23981 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23982 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23983 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23984 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23985 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23986 @end smallexample
23987
23988 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23989 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23990 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23991 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23992 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23993 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23994 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23995 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23996
23997 @ignore
23998 @starindex
23999 @end ignore
24000 @tindex pdeg
24001 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
24002 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
24003 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
24004 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
24005 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
24006 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
24007 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
24008 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
24009 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
24010 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
24011 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
24012 (minus infinity).
24013
24014 @ignore
24015 @starindex
24016 @end ignore
24017 @tindex plead
24018 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
24019 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
24020 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
24021 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
24022 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
24023
24024 @ignore
24025 @starindex
24026 @end ignore
24027 @tindex pcont
24028 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
24029 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
24030 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
24031 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
24032 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
24033 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
24034 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
24035 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
24036 coefficient.
24037
24038 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
24039 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
24040 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
24041 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
24042 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
24043 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
24044 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
24045 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
24046 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
24047 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
24048
24049 @ignore
24050 @starindex
24051 @end ignore
24052 @tindex pprim
24053 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
24054 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
24055 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
24056 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
24057 terms.
24058
24059 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
24060 @section Numerical Solutions
24061
24062 @noindent
24063 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
24064 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
24065 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
24066 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
24067 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
24068
24069 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
24070 on numerical data.)
24071
24072 @menu
24073 * Root Finding::
24074 * Minimization::
24075 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
24076 @end menu
24077
24078 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
24079 @subsection Root Finding
24080
24081 @noindent
24082 @kindex a R
24083 @pindex calc-find-root
24084 @tindex root
24085 @cindex Newton's method
24086 @cindex Roots of equations
24087 @cindex Numerical root-finding
24088 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
24089 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
24090 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
24091 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
24092
24093 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
24094 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
24095 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
24096 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
24097 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
24098 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
24099 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
24100 this command.
24101
24102 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
24103 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
24104 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
24105 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
24106 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
24107 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
24108 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
24109 the equation yourself.)
24110
24111 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
24112 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
24113
24114 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
24115 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
24116 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
24117 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
24118 to real numbers inside that interval.
24119
24120 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
24121 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
24122 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
24123 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
24124 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
24125 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
24126 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
24127
24128 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
24129 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
24130 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
24131 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
24132 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
24133 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
24134
24135 @kindex H a R
24136 @tindex wroot
24137 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
24138 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
24139 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
24140 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
24141 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
24142
24143 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24144 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24145 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24146 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24147 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24148
24149 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24150 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24151 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24152 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24153
24154 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24155 @subsection Minimization
24156
24157 @noindent
24158 @kindex a N
24159 @kindex H a N
24160 @kindex a X
24161 @kindex H a X
24162 @pindex calc-find-minimum
24163 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24164 @tindex minimize
24165 @tindex maximize
24166 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24167 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24168 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24169 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24170 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24171 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24172 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24173 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24174 with the minimum value itself.
24175
24176 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24177 have more than one minimum; some, like
24178 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24179 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24180 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24181 ``global'' minimum of
24182 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24183 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24184 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24185 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24186 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24187 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24188
24189 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24190 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24191 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24192 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24193 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24194 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24195 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24196 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24197
24198 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24199 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24200 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24201 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24202 answer.
24203
24204 @ignore
24205 @mindex wmin@idots
24206 @end ignore
24207 @tindex wminimize
24208 @ignore
24209 @mindex wmax@idots
24210 @end ignore
24211 @tindex wmaximize
24212 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24213 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24214 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24215
24216 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24217 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24218 negative of the formula you supply.
24219
24220 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24221 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24222 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24223 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24224 be minimized over the reals.
24225
24226 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24227 @subsection Systems of Equations
24228
24229 @noindent
24230 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24231 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24232 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24233 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24234 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24235 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24236 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24237 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24238 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24239 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24240 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24241 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24242 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24243
24244 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24245 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24246 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24247 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24248 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24249 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24250 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24251
24252 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24253 @section Curve Fitting
24254
24255 @noindent
24256 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24257 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24258 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24259 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24260 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24261 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24262 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24263
24264 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24265 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24266 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24267 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24268
24269 @menu
24270 * Linear Fits::
24271 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24272 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24273 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24274 * Curve Fitting Details::
24275 * Interpolation::
24276 @end menu
24277
24278 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24279 @subsection Linear Fits
24280
24281 @noindent
24282 @kindex a F
24283 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24284 @tindex fit
24285 @cindex Linear regression
24286 @cindex Least-squares fits
24287 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24288 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24289 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24290 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24291 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24292 fit for the data.
24293
24294 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24295 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24296 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24297 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24298 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24299 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24300 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24301 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24302
24303 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24304 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24305 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24306 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24307
24308 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24309 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24310 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24311 @texline @math{2\times N}
24312 @infoline 2xN
24313 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24314 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24315 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24316 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24317
24318 If you happen to have an
24319 @texline @math{N\times2}
24320 @infoline Nx2
24321 matrix instead of a
24322 @texline @math{2\times N}
24323 @infoline 2xN
24324 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24325
24326 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24327 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24328
24329 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24330 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24331 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24332 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24333 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24334 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24335 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24336
24337 For example, suppose the data matrix
24338
24339 @ifnottex
24340 @example
24341 @group
24342 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24343 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24344 @end group
24345 @end example
24346 @end ifnottex
24347 @tex
24348 \beforedisplay
24349 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24350 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24351 $$
24352 \afterdisplay
24353 @end tex
24354
24355 @noindent
24356 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24357 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24358 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24359 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24360 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24361 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24362 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24363 formula.
24364
24365 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24366 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24367 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24368 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24369 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24370 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24371
24372 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24373 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24374 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24375 the equations that go into the trail.
24376
24377 @tex
24378 \bigskip
24379 @end tex
24380
24381 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24382 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24383 The result is:
24384
24385 @example
24386 2.6 + 2.2 x
24387 @end example
24388
24389 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24390 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24391
24392 @example
24393 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24394 @end example
24395
24396 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24397 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24398 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24399 error measure
24400
24401 @ifnottex
24402 @example
24403 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24404 @end example
24405 @end ifnottex
24406 @tex
24407 \beforedisplay
24408 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24409 \afterdisplay
24410 @end tex
24411
24412 @noindent
24413 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24414 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24415 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24416 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24417 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24418 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24419 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24420 for which the error
24421 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24422 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24423 is as small as possible.
24424
24425 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24426 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24427
24428 @tex
24429 \bigskip
24430 @end tex
24431
24432 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24433 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24434 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24435 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24436 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24437
24438 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24439 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24440 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24441 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24442 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24443
24444 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24445 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24446
24447 @noindent
24448 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24449 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24450 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24451 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24452 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24453
24454 @example
24455 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24456 @end example
24457
24458 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24459 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24460 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24461 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24462 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24463 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24464 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24465 won't help.)
24466
24467 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24468 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24469 line slightly to improve the fit.
24470
24471 @example
24472 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24473 @end example
24474
24475 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24476 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24477 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24478 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24479 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24480
24481 @example
24482 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24483 @end example
24484
24485 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24486 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24487 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24488 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24489 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24490 results.
24491
24492 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24493 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24494 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24495 automatically.
24496
24497 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24498 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24499 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24500 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24501 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24502 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24503
24504 @tex
24505 \bigskip
24506 @end tex
24507
24508 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24509 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24510 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24511 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24512 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24513
24514 Given the data matrix,
24515
24516 @example
24517 @group
24518 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24519 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24520 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24521 @end group
24522 @end example
24523
24524 @noindent
24525 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24526 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24527 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24528
24529 @example
24530 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24531 @end example
24532
24533 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24534 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24535
24536 @tex
24537 \bigskip
24538 @end tex
24539
24540 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24541 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24542 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24543 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24544 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24545 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24546 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24547 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24548 message.
24549
24550 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24551 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24552 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24553 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24554 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24555
24556 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24557 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24558
24559 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24560 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24561
24562 @noindent
24563 @kindex H a F
24564 @tindex efit
24565 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24566 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24567 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24568 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24569
24570 @example
24571 3. + 2. x
24572 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24573 @end example
24574
24575 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24576 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24577 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24578
24579 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24580 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24581 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24582 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24583 row contains error forms
24584 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24585 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24586 then the
24587 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24588 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24589 statistic is now,
24590
24591 @ifnottex
24592 @example
24593 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24594 @end example
24595 @end ifnottex
24596 @tex
24597 \beforedisplay
24598 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24599 \afterdisplay
24600 @end tex
24601
24602 @noindent
24603 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24604 the fitting operation.
24605
24606 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24607 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24608 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24609 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24610 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24611 used for the data point.
24612
24613 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24614 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24615 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24616 estimates.
24617
24618 If the input contains error forms but all the
24619 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24620 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24621 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24622 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24623 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24624 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24625 is simply scaled uniformly by
24626 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24627 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24628 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24629 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24630 @kbd{H a F}.
24631
24632 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24633 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24634 interpreted.
24635
24636 @tex
24637 \bigskip
24638 @end tex
24639
24640 @kindex I a F
24641 @tindex xfit
24642 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24643 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24644
24645 @enumerate
24646 @item
24647 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24648 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24649 produced.
24650
24651 @item
24652 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24653 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24654 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24655 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24656 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24657
24658 @item
24659 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24660 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24661 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24662 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24663 are the variances
24664 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24665 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24666 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24667 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24668 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24669 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24670 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24671 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24672 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24673 are defined as
24674 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24675 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24676
24677 @item
24678 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24679 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24680 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24681 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24682
24683 @item
24684 The value of
24685 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24686 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24687 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24688 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24689 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24690 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24691 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24692 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24693
24694 @item
24695 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24696 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24697 function using
24698 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24699 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24700 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24701 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24702 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24703 particular,
24704 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24705 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24706 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24707 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24708 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24709
24710 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24711 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24712 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24713 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24714 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24715 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24716 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24717 over to use for a confidence test.
24718 @end enumerate
24719
24720 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24721 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24722
24723 @noindent
24724 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24725 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24726 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24727
24728 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24729
24730 @table @kbd
24731 @item 1
24732 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24733 @item 2-9
24734 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24735 @item e
24736 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24737 @item E
24738 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24739 @item x
24740 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24741 @item X
24742 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24743 @item l
24744 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24745 @item L
24746 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24747 @item ^
24748 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24749 @item p
24750 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24751 @item q
24752 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24753 @item g
24754 Gaussian.
24755 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24756 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24757 @item s
24758 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24759 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24760 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24761 @item b
24762 Logistic bell curve.
24763 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24764 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24765 @item o
24766 Hubbert linearization.
24767 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24768 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24769 @end table
24770
24771 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24772 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24773 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24774 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24775 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24776
24777 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24778 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24779 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24780 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24781 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24782 before the model key.
24783
24784 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24785 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24786 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24787 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24788 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24789 matches the problem.
24790
24791 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24792 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24793 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24794 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24795 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24796 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24797
24798 @tex
24799 \bigskip
24800 @end tex
24801
24802 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24803 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24804 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24805 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24806
24807 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24808 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24809 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24810 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24811 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24812 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24813 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24814 model.
24815
24816 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24817 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24818 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24819 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24820 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24821 and thus does not need a name.
24822
24823 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24824 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24825 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24826 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24827 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24828 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24829 variables.
24830
24831 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24832 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24833 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24834 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24835 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24836 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24837 in the model formula will become parameters.
24838
24839 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24840 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24841 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24842 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24843 a linear model.
24844
24845 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24846 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24847 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24848 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24849 which are parameters.
24850
24851 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24852 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24853 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24854 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24855 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24856 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24857
24858 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24859 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24860
24861 @tex
24862 \bigskip
24863 @end tex
24864
24865 @vindex Model1
24866 @vindex Model2
24867 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24868 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24869 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24870 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24871 accept for a model on the stack.
24872
24873 @tex
24874 \bigskip
24875 @end tex
24876
24877 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24878 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24879 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24880 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24881 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24882 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24883 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24884 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24885 @texline @math{3\times360}
24886 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24887 degrees.
24888 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24889 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24890 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24891 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24892 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24893 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24894 even approximately.
24895
24896 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24897 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24898 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24899 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24900 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24901 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24902 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24903
24904 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24905 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
24906
24907 @noindent
24908 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24909 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24910 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24911 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24912 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24913
24914 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24915 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24916 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24917 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24918
24919 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24920 to try to put the problem into the form
24921
24922 @smallexample
24923 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24924 @end smallexample
24925
24926 @noindent
24927 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24928 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24929 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24930 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24931 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24932
24933 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24934 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24935 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24936 can be rewritten as follows:
24937
24938 @example
24939 y = a x^b
24940 y = a exp(b ln(x))
24941 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24942 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24943 @end example
24944
24945 @noindent
24946 which matches the desired form with
24947 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24948 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24949 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24950 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24951 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24952 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24953 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24954 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24955 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24956 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24957 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24958 and @expr{b = B}.
24959
24960 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24961 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24962
24963 @example
24964 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24965 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24966 @end example
24967
24968 @noindent
24969 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24970 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24971 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24972 @expr{H = x^2}.
24973
24974 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24975 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24976 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24977
24978 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
24979 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
24980 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
24981 iterative method to refine the approximations.
24982
24983 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
24984 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24985 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24986 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24987 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24988 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24989 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24990 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24991 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24992 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24993 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24994 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24995
24996 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24997 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24998 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24999
25000 @tex
25001 \bigskip
25002 @end tex
25003
25004 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
25005 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
25006 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
25007 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25008 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25009 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
25010 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
25011 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
25012 command can do the same thing by brute force.
25013
25014 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
25015 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
25016 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
25017 to be minimized would be the value of
25018 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25019 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25020 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
25021
25022 @smallexample
25023 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
25024 @end smallexample
25025
25026 @noindent
25027 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
25028 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
25029 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
25030 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
25031 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
25032 were used by itself to solve the problem).
25033
25034 @tex
25035 \bigskip
25036 @end tex
25037
25038 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
25039 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
25040 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
25041 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
25042 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
25043 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
25044 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
25045 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
25046 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
25047 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
25048 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
25049 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
25050 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
25051 and so on.
25052
25053 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
25054 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
25055 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
25056 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
25057 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
25058 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
25059 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
25060 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
25061 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
25062
25063 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
25064 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
25065 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
25066 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
25067 nontrivial filter functions.
25068
25069 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
25070 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
25071 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
25072 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
25073 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
25074 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
25075 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
25076 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
25077 form. The error part of that result is used for
25078 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
25079 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
25080 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
25081 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
25082 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
25083 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
25084 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
25085 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
25086 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
25087 arithmetic with no error forms.
25088
25089 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
25090 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
25091 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
25092 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
25093 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
25094 @texline @math{\sigma}
25095 @infoline @expr{sigma}
25096 for the data point with no further ado.)
25097
25098 @tex
25099 \bigskip
25100 @end tex
25101
25102 @vindex FitRules
25103 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
25104 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
25105 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
25106 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
25107 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
25108 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
25109 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
25110
25111 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
25112
25113 @ignore
25114 @starindex
25115 @end ignore
25116 @tindex fitvar
25117 @ignore
25118 @starindex
25119 @end ignore
25120 @ignore
25121 @mindex @idots
25122 @end ignore
25123 @tindex fitparam
25124 @ignore
25125 @starindex
25126 @end ignore
25127 @ignore
25128 @mindex @null
25129 @end ignore
25130 @tindex fitmodel
25131 @ignore
25132 @starindex
25133 @end ignore
25134 @ignore
25135 @mindex @null
25136 @end ignore
25137 @tindex fitsystem
25138 @ignore
25139 @starindex
25140 @end ignore
25141 @ignore
25142 @mindex @null
25143 @end ignore
25144 @tindex fitdummy
25145 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
25146 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
25147 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
25148 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
25149 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
25150 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
25151 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
25152 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
25153 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
25154
25155 @smallexample
25156 @group
25157 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
25158 @end group
25159 @end smallexample
25160
25161 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25162 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25163 changes are possible.)
25164
25165 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25166 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25167
25168 @example
25169 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25170 @end example
25171
25172 @noindent
25173 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25174 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25175 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25176 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25177 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25178 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25179 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25180
25181 The power law model eventually boils down to
25182
25183 @smallexample
25184 @group
25185 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25186 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25187 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25188 @end group
25189 @end smallexample
25190
25191 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25192 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25193 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25194 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25195 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25196 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25197 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25198 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25199 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25200 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25201 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25202 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25203 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25204
25205 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25206 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25207 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25208 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25209 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25210 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25211 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25212 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25213 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25214 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25215 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25216 raw parameters, for now.)
25217
25218 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25219 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25220 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25221 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25222 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25223 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25224 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25225 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25226 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25227 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25228 raw parameters needed.
25229
25230 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25231 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25232 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25233 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25234 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25235 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25236 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25237 least-squares solver wants to see.
25238
25239 @ignore
25240 @starindex
25241 @end ignore
25242 @ignore
25243 @mindex hasfit@idots
25244 @end ignore
25245 @tindex hasfitparams
25246 @ignore
25247 @starindex
25248 @end ignore
25249 @ignore
25250 @mindex @null
25251 @end ignore
25252 @tindex hasfitvars
25253 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25254 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25255 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25256 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25257 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25258 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25259 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25260 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25261 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25262
25263 @tex
25264 \bigskip
25265 @end tex
25266
25267 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25268 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25269 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25270 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25271 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25272 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25273 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25274 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25275 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25276 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25277
25278 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25279 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25280 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25281 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25282 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25283
25284 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25285 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25286 and variables, as discussed previously.
25287
25288 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25289 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25290 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25291 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25292
25293 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25294 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25295
25296 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25297 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25298
25299 @kindex a p
25300 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25301 @tindex polint
25302 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25303 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25304 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25305 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25306 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25307 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25308 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25309 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25310 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25311
25312 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25313 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25314 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25315 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25316 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25317 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25318
25319 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25320 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25321
25322 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25323 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25324 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25325 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25326 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25327 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25328
25329 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25330 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25331
25332 @kindex H a p
25333 @tindex ratint
25334 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25335 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25336 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25337 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25338 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25339 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25340
25341 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25342 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25343 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25344 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25345 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25346 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25347
25348 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25349 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25350 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25351 capabilities to fit.)
25352
25353 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25354 @section Summations
25355
25356 @noindent
25357 @cindex Summation of a series
25358 @kindex a +
25359 @pindex calc-summation
25360 @tindex sum
25361 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25362 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25363 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25364 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25365 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25366 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25367 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25368 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25369 produces the result 55.
25370 @tex
25371 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25372 @end tex
25373
25374 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25375 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25376 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25377 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25378 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25379 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25380 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25381 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25382 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25383
25384 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25385 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25386 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25387 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25388 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25389 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25390 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25391 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25392 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25393
25394 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25395 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25396 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25397 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25398 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25399 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25400 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25401 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25402 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25403 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25404
25405 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25406 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25407 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25408 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25409 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25410 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25411
25412 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25413 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25414 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25415 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25416 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25417 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25418 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25419 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25420
25421 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25422 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25423 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25424 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25425 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25426 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25427
25428 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25429 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25430 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25431 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25432 after algebraic simplification, evaluate to an integer.
25433
25434 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25435 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25436 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25437 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25438 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25439 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25440 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25441 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25442
25443 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25444 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25445 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25446 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25447 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25448 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25449 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25450
25451 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25452 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25453 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25454 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25455 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25456 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25457 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25458 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25459 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25460 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25461 closed form.
25462
25463 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25464 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25465 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25466 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25467 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25468 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25469 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25470 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25471 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25472 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25473 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25474 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25475 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25476 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25477
25478 @cindex Alternating sums
25479 @kindex a -
25480 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25481 @tindex asum
25482 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25483 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25484 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25485 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25486 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25487 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25488 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25489 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25490 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25491 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25492 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25493 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25494
25495 @cindex Product of a sequence
25496 @kindex a *
25497 @pindex calc-product
25498 @tindex prod
25499 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25500 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25501 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25502 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25503 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25504
25505 @kindex a T
25506 @pindex calc-tabulate
25507 @tindex table
25508 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25509 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25510 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25511 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25512 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25513
25514 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25515 @section Logical Operations
25516
25517 @noindent
25518 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25519 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25520 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25521 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25522 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25523 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25524 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25525 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25526 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25527 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25528 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25529 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25530 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25531 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25532
25533 @kindex a =
25534 @pindex calc-equal-to
25535 @tindex eq
25536 @tindex =
25537 @tindex ==
25538 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25539 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25540 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25541 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25542 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25543 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25544 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25545 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25546 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25547
25548 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25549 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25550 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25551 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25552 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25553 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25554 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25555 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25556 zero if not.
25557
25558 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25559 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25560 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25561 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25562 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25563 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25564 variables).
25565
25566 @kindex a #
25567 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25568 @tindex neq
25569 @tindex !=
25570 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25571 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25572 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25573 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25574 distinct numbers.
25575
25576 @kindex a <
25577 @tindex lt
25578 @ignore
25579 @mindex @idots
25580 @end ignore
25581 @kindex a >
25582 @ignore
25583 @mindex @null
25584 @end ignore
25585 @kindex a [
25586 @ignore
25587 @mindex @null
25588 @end ignore
25589 @kindex a ]
25590 @pindex calc-less-than
25591 @pindex calc-greater-than
25592 @pindex calc-less-equal
25593 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25594 @ignore
25595 @mindex @null
25596 @end ignore
25597 @tindex gt
25598 @ignore
25599 @mindex @null
25600 @end ignore
25601 @tindex leq
25602 @ignore
25603 @mindex @null
25604 @end ignore
25605 @tindex geq
25606 @ignore
25607 @mindex @null
25608 @end ignore
25609 @tindex <
25610 @ignore
25611 @mindex @null
25612 @end ignore
25613 @tindex >
25614 @ignore
25615 @mindex @null
25616 @end ignore
25617 @tindex <=
25618 @ignore
25619 @mindex @null
25620 @end ignore
25621 @tindex >=
25622 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25623 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25624 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25625 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25626 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25627
25628 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25629 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25630 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25631 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25632 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25633 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25634 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25635 involve both equations and inequalities, are not allowed.
25636
25637 @kindex a .
25638 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25639 @tindex rmeq
25640 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25641 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25642 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25643 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25644 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25645 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25646 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25647 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25648 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25649 taking the lefthand side.
25650
25651 @kindex a &
25652 @pindex calc-logical-and
25653 @tindex land
25654 @tindex &&
25655 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25656 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25657 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25658 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25659 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25660
25661 @kindex a |
25662 @pindex calc-logical-or
25663 @tindex lor
25664 @tindex ||
25665 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25666 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25667 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25668 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25669 zero.
25670
25671 @kindex a !
25672 @pindex calc-logical-not
25673 @tindex lnot
25674 @tindex !
25675 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25676 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25677 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25678 number.
25679
25680 @kindex a :
25681 @pindex calc-logical-if
25682 @tindex if
25683 @ignore
25684 @mindex ? :
25685 @end ignore
25686 @tindex ?
25687 @ignore
25688 @mindex @null
25689 @end ignore
25690 @tindex :
25691 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25692 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25693 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25694 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25695 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25696 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25697 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25698 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25699 @code{condition}.
25700
25701 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25702 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25703 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25704 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25705
25706 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25707 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25708 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25709 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25710 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25711 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25712 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25713
25714 @kindex a @{
25715 @pindex calc-in-set
25716 @tindex in
25717 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25718 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25719 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25720 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25721 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25722 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25723 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25724 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25725 of this sort.
25726
25727 @ignore
25728 @starindex
25729 @end ignore
25730 @tindex typeof
25731 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25732 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25733 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25734
25735 @example
25736 1 Integer
25737 2 Fraction
25738 3 Floating-point number
25739 4 HMS form
25740 5 Rectangular complex number
25741 6 Polar complex number
25742 7 Error form
25743 8 Interval form
25744 9 Modulo form
25745 10 Date-only form
25746 11 Date/time form
25747 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25748 100 Variable
25749 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25750 102 Matrix
25751 @end example
25752
25753 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25754 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25755
25756 @ignore
25757 @starindex
25758 @end ignore
25759 @tindex integer
25760 @ignore
25761 @starindex
25762 @end ignore
25763 @tindex real
25764 @ignore
25765 @starindex
25766 @end ignore
25767 @tindex constant
25768 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25769 The @samp{real(a)} function
25770 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25771 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25772 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25773 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25774 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25775 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25776 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25777
25778 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25779 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25780 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25781 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25782 literally an integer constant.
25783
25784 @ignore
25785 @starindex
25786 @end ignore
25787 @tindex refers
25788 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25789 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25790 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25791 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25792 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25793 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25794
25795 @ignore
25796 @starindex
25797 @end ignore
25798 @tindex negative
25799 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25800 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25801 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25802 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25803 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25804 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25805 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25806 as a rewrite rule condition).
25807
25808 @ignore
25809 @starindex
25810 @end ignore
25811 @tindex variable
25812 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25813 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25814 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25815 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25816
25817 @ignore
25818 @starindex
25819 @end ignore
25820 @tindex nonvar
25821 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25822 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25823 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25824 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25825 often good enough.
25826
25827 @ignore
25828 @starindex
25829 @end ignore
25830 @tindex lin
25831 @ignore
25832 @starindex
25833 @end ignore
25834 @tindex linnt
25835 @ignore
25836 @starindex
25837 @end ignore
25838 @tindex islin
25839 @ignore
25840 @starindex
25841 @end ignore
25842 @tindex islinnt
25843 @cindex Linearity testing
25844 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25845 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25846 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25847 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25848 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25849 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25850 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25851 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25852 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25853 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25854 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25855 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25856 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25857 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25858 returns true.
25859
25860 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25861 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25862 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25863 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25864 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25865 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25866 linear in @expr{x}).
25867
25868 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25869 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25870 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25871 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25872 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25873 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25874 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25875 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25876 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25877 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25878
25879 @ignore
25880 @starindex
25881 @end ignore
25882 @tindex istrue
25883 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25884 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25885 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25886 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25887 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25888 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25889 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25890 in symbolic form.)
25891
25892 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25893 @section Rewrite Rules
25894
25895 @noindent
25896 @cindex Rewrite rules
25897 @cindex Transformations
25898 @cindex Pattern matching
25899 @kindex a r
25900 @pindex calc-rewrite
25901 @tindex rewrite
25902 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25903 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25904 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25905 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25906 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25907 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25908 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25909 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25910 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25911
25912 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25913 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25914 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25915 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25916 Calc formulas.
25917
25918 @menu
25919 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
25920 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
25921 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25922 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25923 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25924 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25925 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25926 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25927 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25928 * Matching Commands::
25929 * Automatic Rewrites::
25930 * Debugging Rewrites::
25931 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25932 @end menu
25933
25934 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25935 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25936
25937 @noindent
25938 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25939 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25940 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25941 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25942 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25943 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25944 assignments in special ways.
25945
25946 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25947 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25948 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25949 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25950 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25951
25952 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25953 rules.
25954
25955 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25956 in several ways:
25957
25958 @enumerate
25959 @item
25960 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25961 @item
25962 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25963 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25964 @item
25965 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25966 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25967 @item
25968 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25969 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25970 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25971 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25972 @item
25973 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25974 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25975 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25976 @end enumerate
25977
25978 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25979 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25980 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25981
25982 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25983 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25984 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25985 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25986 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25987 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25988
25989 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25990 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25991 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25992 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25993 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25994 reason to store your rules in a variable.
25995
25996 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25997 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25998 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25999
26000 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26001 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
26002
26003 @noindent
26004 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
26005 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
26006 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
26007 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
26008 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
26009 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
26010 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
26011 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
26012 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
26013 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
26014 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
26015
26016 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
26017 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
26018 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
26019 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
26020 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
26021
26022 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
26023 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
26024 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
26025 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
26026 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
26027
26028 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
26029 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
26030 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
26031 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
26032
26033 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
26034 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
26035 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
26036 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
26037 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
26038
26039 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
26040 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
26041 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
26042 change at a time.
26043
26044 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26045 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
26046
26047 @noindent
26048 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
26049 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
26050 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
26051 is present in the
26052 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
26053 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
26054 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
26055 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
26056 with Calc's algebraic simplifications. If the result is a nonzero
26057 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
26058 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
26059 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
26060 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
26061 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
26062
26063 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
26064 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
26065 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
26066 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
26067 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
26068 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
26069 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
26070 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
26071 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
26072
26073 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
26074 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
26075 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
26076 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
26077 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
26078 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
26079 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
26080 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
26081 the condition.
26082
26083 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
26084 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
26085 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
26086
26087 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
26088 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
26089
26090 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
26091 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
26092 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
26093 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
26094 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
26095 matched.
26096
26097 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
26098 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
26099 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
26100 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
26101 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
26102 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
26103 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
26104 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
26105 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
26106
26107 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
26108 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
26109 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
26110 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
26111 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
26112 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
26113 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
26114 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
26115 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
26116
26117 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
26118 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
26119 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
26120 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
26121 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
26122 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
26123 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
26124 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
26125 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
26126
26127 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26128 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
26129
26130 @noindent
26131 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
26132 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
26133 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
26134 account:
26135
26136 @smallexample
26137 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
26138 @end smallexample
26139
26140 For example, the rewrite rule:
26141
26142 @example
26143 a x + b x := (a + b) x
26144 @end example
26145
26146 @noindent
26147 will match formulas of the form,
26148
26149 @example
26150 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
26151 @end example
26152
26153 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
26154 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
26155
26156 @example
26157 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
26158 @end example
26159
26160 @noindent
26161 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26162
26163 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26164 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26165 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26166
26167 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26168 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26169 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26170 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26171 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26172 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26173 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26174 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26175
26176 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26177 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26178 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26179 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26180 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26181 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26182 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26183 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26184 from occurring.
26185
26186 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26187 the rule
26188
26189 @example
26190 f(-x) := -f(x)
26191 @end example
26192
26193 @noindent
26194 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26195 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26196 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26197 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26198 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26199 condition is:
26200
26201 @example
26202 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26203 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26204 @end example
26205
26206 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26207 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26208
26209 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26210 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26211 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26212 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26213
26214 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26215 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26216 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26217 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26218 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26219 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26220 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26221 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26222 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26223 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26224
26225 Even more subtle is the rule set
26226
26227 @example
26228 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26229 @end example
26230
26231 @noindent
26232 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26233 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26234 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26235 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26236 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26237 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26238 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26239 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26240 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26241 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26242 rule will have to be added.
26243
26244 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26245 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26246 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26247 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26248 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26249
26250 @example
26251 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26252 @end example
26253
26254 @noindent
26255 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26256 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26257 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26258 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26259 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26260 conjugate of a real number.)
26261
26262 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26263
26264 @example
26265 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26266 @end example
26267
26268 @noindent
26269 will match the formula
26270
26271 @example
26272 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26273 @end example
26274
26275 @noindent
26276 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26277 formulas like
26278
26279 @example
26280 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26281 @end example
26282
26283 @noindent
26284 producing, respectively,
26285
26286 @example
26287 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26288 @end example
26289
26290 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26291 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26292
26293 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26294 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26295 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26296 with @samp{a = -1}.
26297
26298 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26299
26300 @example
26301 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26302 @end example
26303
26304 @noindent
26305 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26306
26307 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26308 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26309 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26310 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26311 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26312 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26313 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26314 for a multiplication, not a division.
26315
26316 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26317 by 1,
26318
26319 @example
26320 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26321 @end example
26322
26323 @noindent
26324 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26325 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26326
26327 @example
26328 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26329 @end example
26330
26331 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26332 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26333
26334 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26335
26336 @example
26337 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26338 @end example
26339
26340 @noindent
26341 into the form
26342
26343 @example
26344 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26345 @end example
26346
26347 @noindent
26348 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26349 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26350 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26351 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26352 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26353
26354 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26355 following rule,
26356
26357 @example
26358 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26359 @end example
26360
26361 @noindent
26362 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26363 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26364 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26365 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26366 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26367 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26368 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26369
26370 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26371 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26372 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26373
26374 @example
26375 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26376 @end example
26377
26378 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26379 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26380 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26381 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26382 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26383 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26384 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26385 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26386
26387 @smallexample
26388 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26389 max min re im conj arg
26390 @end smallexample
26391
26392 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26393 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26394 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26395 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26396 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26397 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26398 For example,
26399
26400 @example
26401 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26402 @end example
26403
26404 @noindent
26405 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26406 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26407 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26408 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26409 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26410 further and use
26411
26412 @example
26413 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26414 @end example
26415
26416 @noindent
26417 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26418
26419 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26420 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26421 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26422
26423 @example
26424 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26425 @end example
26426
26427 @noindent
26428 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26429
26430 @example
26431 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26432 @end example
26433
26434 @noindent
26435 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26436 effect!
26437
26438 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26439 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26440 in the rule
26441
26442 @example
26443 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26444 @end example
26445
26446 @noindent
26447 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26448 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26449 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26450 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26451 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26452 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26453 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26454 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26455 marker on the righthand side:
26456
26457 @example
26458 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26459 @end example
26460
26461 @noindent
26462 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26463 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26464 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26465
26466 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26467 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26468
26469 @noindent
26470 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26471 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26472 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26473 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26474
26475 @ignore
26476 @starindex
26477 @end ignore
26478 @tindex import
26479 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26480 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26481 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26482 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26483 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26484 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26485 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26486 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26487 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26488 @texline @math{v_1},
26489 @infoline @expr{v1},
26490 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26491 @texline @math{x_1}
26492 @infoline @expr{x1}
26493 and so on. (If
26494 @texline @math{v_1}
26495 @infoline @expr{v1}
26496 is used as a function name, then
26497 @texline @math{x_1}
26498 @infoline @expr{x1}
26499 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26500 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26501 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26502 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26503 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26504
26505 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26506
26507 @table @samp
26508 @item quote(x)
26509 @ignore
26510 @starindex
26511 @end ignore
26512 @tindex quote
26513 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26514 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26515 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26516 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26517 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26518 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26519 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26520 as a result in this case.)
26521
26522 @item plain(x)
26523 @ignore
26524 @starindex
26525 @end ignore
26526 @tindex plain
26527 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26528 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26529 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26530 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26531 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26532 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26533 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26534 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26535
26536 @item opt(x,def)
26537 @ignore
26538 @starindex
26539 @end ignore
26540 @tindex opt
26541 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26542 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26543 the argument or element is optional.
26544 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26545 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26546 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26547 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26548 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26549 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26550
26551 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26552 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26553 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26554 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26555 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26556 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26557 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26558 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26559 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26560
26561 @item condition(x,c)
26562 @ignore
26563 @starindex
26564 @end ignore
26565 @tindex condition
26566 @tindex ::
26567 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26568 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26569
26570 @item pand(x,y)
26571 @ignore
26572 @starindex
26573 @end ignore
26574 @tindex pand
26575 @tindex &&&
26576 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26577 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26578 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26579
26580 @item por(x,y)
26581 @ignore
26582 @starindex
26583 @end ignore
26584 @tindex por
26585 @tindex |||
26586 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26587 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26588
26589 @item pnot(x)
26590 @ignore
26591 @starindex
26592 @end ignore
26593 @tindex pnot
26594 @tindex !!!
26595 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26596 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26597
26598 @item cons(h,t)
26599 @ignore
26600 @mindex cons
26601 @end ignore
26602 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26603 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26604 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26605 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26606 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26607 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26608 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26609
26610 @item rcons(t,h)
26611 @ignore
26612 @mindex rcons
26613 @end ignore
26614 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26615 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26616 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26617 to @expr{t}.
26618
26619 @item apply(f,args)
26620 @ignore
26621 @mindex apply
26622 @end ignore
26623 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26624 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26625 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26626 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26627 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26628 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26629 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26630 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26631 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26632 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26633 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26634 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26635 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26636 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26637 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26638
26639 @example
26640 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26641 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26642 @end example
26643
26644 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26645 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26646 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26647 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26648 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26649 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26650 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26651
26652 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26653 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26654 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26655
26656 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26657 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26658 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26659 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26660 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26661 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26662 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26663 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26664 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26665 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26666
26667 @item select(x)
26668 @ignore
26669 @starindex
26670 @end ignore
26671 @tindex select
26672 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26673 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26674 @end table
26675
26676 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26677
26678 @table @samp
26679 @item quote(x)
26680 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26681 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26682 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26683 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26684 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26685 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26686 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26687 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26688 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26689 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26690
26691 @item plain(x)
26692 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26693 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26694 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26695 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26696 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26697 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26698 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26699
26700 @item cons(h,t)
26701 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26702 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26703 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26704 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26705 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26706 have been turned off.
26707
26708 @item rcons(t,h)
26709 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26710 the vector @expr{t}.
26711
26712 @item apply(f,args)
26713 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26714 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26715 is also a regular Calc function.
26716
26717 @item eval(x)
26718 @ignore
26719 @starindex
26720 @end ignore
26721 @tindex eval
26722 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26723 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26724 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26725 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26726 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26727 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26728 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26729
26730 @item evalsimp(x)
26731 @ignore
26732 @starindex
26733 @end ignore
26734 @tindex evalsimp
26735 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26736 way, then algebraically simplified.
26737
26738 @item evalextsimp(x)
26739 @ignore
26740 @starindex
26741 @end ignore
26742 @tindex evalextsimp
26743 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26744 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26745
26746 @item select(x)
26747 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26748 @end table
26749
26750 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26751
26752 @table @samp
26753 @item let(v := x)
26754 @ignore
26755 @starindex
26756 @end ignore
26757 @tindex let
26758 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26759 The algebraic simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26760 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26761 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26762 of simplification. The result of @expr{x} is then bound to the
26763 meta-variable @expr{v}. As usual, if this meta-variable has already
26764 been matched to something else the two values must be equal; if the
26765 meta-variable is new then it is bound to the result of the expression.
26766 This variable can then appear in later conditions, and on the righthand
26767 side of the rule.
26768 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26769 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26770 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26771 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26772 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26773 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26774
26775 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26776 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26777 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26778 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26779
26780 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26781 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26782 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26783 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26784 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26785 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26786 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26787 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26788 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26789 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26790 be bound to @code{ia}.
26791
26792 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26793 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26794 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26795 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26796 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26797 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26798 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26799 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26800 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26801 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26802
26803 @ignore
26804 @starindex
26805 @end ignore
26806 @tindex ierf
26807 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26808 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26809 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26810 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26811 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26812 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26813
26814 @example
26815 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26816 @end example
26817
26818 @item matches(v,p)
26819 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26820 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26821 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26822 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26823 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26824 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26825 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26826 rule.
26827
26828 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26829 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26830 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26831
26832 @item remember
26833 @vindex remember
26834 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26835 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26836 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26837 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26838 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26839 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26840 contains any variables.
26841
26842 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26843 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26844 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26845 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26846 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26847 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26848
26849 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26850 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26851 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26852 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26853 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26854 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26855 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26856
26857 @item remember(c)
26858 @ignore
26859 @starindex
26860 @end ignore
26861 @tindex remember
26862 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26863 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26864 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26865 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26866 @end table
26867
26868 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26869 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26870
26871 @noindent
26872 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26873 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26874 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26875 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26876 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26877
26878 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26879 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26880 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26881
26882 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26883 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26884 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26885 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26886
26887 @example
26888 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26889 @end example
26890
26891 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26892
26893 @example
26894 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26895 @end example
26896
26897 @ignore
26898 @starindex
26899 @end ignore
26900 @tindex ends
26901 Here's another interesting example:
26902
26903 @example
26904 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26905 @end example
26906
26907 @noindent
26908 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26909 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26910 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26911
26912 @example
26913 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26914 @end example
26915
26916 @noindent
26917 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26918 one-element vector.
26919
26920 @tex
26921 \bigskip
26922 @end tex
26923
26924 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26925 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26926 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26927
26928 @ignore
26929 @starindex
26930 @end ignore
26931 @tindex curve
26932 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26933
26934 @example
26935 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26936 @end example
26937
26938 @noindent
26939 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26940
26941 Here is a larger example:
26942
26943 @example
26944 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26945 @end example
26946
26947 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26948 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26949 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26950
26951 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26952 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26953
26954 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26955 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26956 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26957 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26958 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26959 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26960 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26961 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26962
26963 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26964 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26965 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26966 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26967
26968 @example
26969 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26970 @end example
26971
26972 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26973 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26974
26975 @tex
26976 \bigskip
26977 @end tex
26978
26979 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26980 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26981 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26982
26983 For example,
26984
26985 @example
26986 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26987 @end example
26988
26989 @noindent
26990 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26991 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26992 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26993
26994 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26995 then an equivalent rule would be:
26996
26997 @example
26998 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26999 @end example
27000
27001 @noindent
27002 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
27003 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
27004 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
27005 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
27006 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
27007 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
27008 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
27009
27010 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
27011 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
27012
27013 @example
27014 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
27015 @end example
27016
27017 @noindent
27018 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
27019 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
27020
27021 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
27022 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
27023 matched last. Thus
27024
27025 @example
27026 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
27027 @end example
27028
27029 @noindent
27030 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
27031 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
27032 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
27033 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
27034 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
27035 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
27036
27037 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27038 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
27039
27040 @noindent
27041 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
27042 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
27043 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
27044 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
27045 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
27046 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
27047 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
27048 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
27049
27050 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
27051 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
27052 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
27053 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
27054 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
27055 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
27056 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
27057 anywhere in the formula.
27058
27059 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
27060 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
27061 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
27062 side actually comes out to something different than the original
27063 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
27064 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
27065 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
27066 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
27067 forms.
27068
27069 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
27070 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
27071 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
27072 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
27073 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
27074
27075 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
27076 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
27077 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
27078 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
27079
27080 @ignore
27081 @starindex
27082 @end ignore
27083 @ignore
27084 @mindex iter@idots
27085 @end ignore
27086 @tindex iterations
27087 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
27088 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
27089 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
27090 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
27091 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
27092 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
27093 rule set.
27094
27095 @example
27096 [ iterations(1),
27097 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
27098 @end example
27099
27100 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
27101 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
27102 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
27103 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
27104 that was matched.
27105
27106 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
27107
27108 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
27109 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
27110 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
27111
27112 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
27113 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
27114 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
27115 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
27116 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
27117 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
27118 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
27119 are omitted, 100 is used.
27120
27121 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27122 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
27123
27124 @noindent
27125 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
27126 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
27127 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
27128 phases occur during the rewriting process.
27129
27130 @ignore
27131 @starindex
27132 @end ignore
27133 @tindex phase
27134 @vindex all
27135 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
27136 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
27137 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
27138 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
27139 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
27140 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
27141
27142 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
27143 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
27144 ascending order. For example, the rule set
27145
27146 @example
27147 @group
27148 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
27149 phase(1),
27150 f1(x) := g1(x),
27151 phase(2),
27152 f2(x) := g2(x),
27153 phase(3),
27154 f3(x) := g3(x),
27155 phase(1,2),
27156 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
27157 @end group
27158 @end example
27159
27160 @noindent
27161 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27162 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27163 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27164 and @code{f3}.
27165
27166 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27167 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27168 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27169 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27170 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27171 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27172 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27173 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27174 100 by default, is reached.)
27175
27176 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27177 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27178 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27179 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27180 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27181 in the formula.
27182
27183 @ignore
27184 @starindex
27185 @end ignore
27186 @tindex schedule
27187 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27188 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27189 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27190 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27191 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27192 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27193 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27194 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27195 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27196 moving on to phase 3.
27197
27198 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27199 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27200 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27201 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27202 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27203 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27204 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27205 touches.
27206
27207 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27208 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27209 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27210 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27211 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27212 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27213 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27214
27215 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27216 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27217 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27218 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27219 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27220 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27221
27222 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27223 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27224 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27225 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27226 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27227 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27228 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27229 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27230 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27231 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27232 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27233
27234 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27235 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27236 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27237 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27238 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27239 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27240 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27241
27242 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27243 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27244
27245 @noindent
27246 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27247 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27248 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27249 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27250 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27251
27252 @kindex j r
27253 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27254 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27255 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27256 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27257 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27258 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27259 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27260 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27261 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27262
27263 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27264 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27265 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27266 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27267 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27268 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27269
27270 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27271 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27272 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27273 formula will be unselected.
27274
27275 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27276 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27277 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27278 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27279 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27280 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27281 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27282 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27283
27284 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27285 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27286 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27287 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27288
27289 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27290 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27291 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27292 at stack level 1.)
27293
27294 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27295 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27296 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27297 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27298 target and the rewrite rules).
27299
27300 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27301 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27302 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27303 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27304 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27305 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27306
27307 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27308 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27309 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27310 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27311 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27312 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27313 both with and without selections.
27314
27315 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27316 @subsection Matching Commands
27317
27318 @noindent
27319 @kindex a m
27320 @pindex calc-match
27321 @tindex match
27322 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27323 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27324 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27325 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27326 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27327 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27328 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27329 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27330 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27331 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27332 of the patterns.
27333
27334 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27335 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27336
27337 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27338
27339 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27340 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27341 all the positive vector elements.
27342
27343 @kindex I a m
27344 @tindex matchnot
27345 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27346 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27347
27348 @ignore
27349 @starindex
27350 @end ignore
27351 @tindex matches
27352 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27353 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27354 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27355 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27356
27357 @ignore
27358 @starindex
27359 @end ignore
27360 @tindex vmatches
27361 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27362 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27363 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27364 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27365 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27366
27367 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27368 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27369
27370 @noindent
27371 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27372 @vindex EvalRules
27373 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27374 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27375 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27376 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27377 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27378
27379 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27380 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27381 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27382 set would be,
27383
27384 @smallexample
27385 @group
27386 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27387 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27388 @end group
27389 @end smallexample
27390
27391 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27392 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27393 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27394 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27395 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27396 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27397 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27398
27399 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27400 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27401 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27402 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27403 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27404 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27405 applies rules from the top down.
27406
27407 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27408 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27409
27410 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27411 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27412 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27413 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27414 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27415 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27416 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27417 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27418 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27419 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27420 or ran too long'' message.
27421
27422 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27423 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27424 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27425 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27426 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27427 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27428 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27429 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27430 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27431 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27432 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27433 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27434 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27435
27436 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27437 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27438 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27439 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27440 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27441 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27442 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27443 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27444 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27445 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27446 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27447 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27448 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27449
27450 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27451 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27452 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27453 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27454
27455 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27456 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27457 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27458 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27459 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27460 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27461 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27462 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27463
27464 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27465 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27466 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27467 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27468 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27469 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27470 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27471 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27472 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27473 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27474 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27475 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27476 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27477 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27478
27479 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27480 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27481 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27482 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27483 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27484 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27485 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27486 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27487 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27488 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27489 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27490 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27491 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27492
27493 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27494 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27495
27496 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27497 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27498 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27499 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27500 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27501 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27502 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27503
27504 @smallexample
27505 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27506 @end smallexample
27507
27508 @noindent
27509 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27510 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27511 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27512 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27513
27514 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27515 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27516 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27517 but only when algebraic simplifications are used to simplify the
27518 formula. The variable @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose.
27519 The @kbd{a s} command will apply @code{EvalRules} and
27520 @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as well as all of its built-in
27521 simplifications.
27522
27523 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27524 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27525 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of algebraic
27526 simplifications. It then applies its own built-in simplifications
27527 throughout the formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with
27528 applying the default simplifications) until no further changes are
27529 possible.
27530
27531 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27532 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27533 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27534 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27535 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27536 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27537 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27538 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27539 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27540
27541 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27542 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27543
27544 @noindent
27545 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27546 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27547 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27548 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27549 noted.
27550
27551 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27552 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27553
27554 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27555 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27556 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27557 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27558 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27559 be needlessly slow.
27560
27561 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27562 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27563
27564 @noindent
27565 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27566 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27567 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27568 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27569 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27570 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27571 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27572
27573 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27574 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27575 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27576 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27577 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27578 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27579 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27580
27581 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27582 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27583 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27584 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27585 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27586 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27587 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27588 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27589
27590 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27591 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27592 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27593 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27594 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27595 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27596 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27597 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27598 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27599 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27600
27601 @cindex Quaternions
27602 The following rule set, contributed by
27603 @texline Fran\c cois
27604 @infoline Francois
27605 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27606 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27607 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27608 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27609 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27610 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27611 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27612 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27613 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27614 @key{RET}}.
27615
27616 @smallexample
27617 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27618 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27619 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27620 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27621 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27622 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27623 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27624 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27625 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27626 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27627 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27628 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27629 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27630 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27631 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27632 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27633 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27634 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27635 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27636 @end smallexample
27637
27638 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27639 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27640 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27641 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27642 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27643 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27644 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27645
27646 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27647 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27648 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27649 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27650 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27651 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27652
27653 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27654 @chapter Operating on Units
27655
27656 @noindent
27657 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27658 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27659 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27660 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27661 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27662
27663 @menu
27664 * Basic Operations on Units::
27665 * The Units Table::
27666 * Predefined Units::
27667 * User-Defined Units::
27668 * Logarithmic Units::
27669 * Musical Notes::
27670 @end menu
27671
27672 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27673 @section Basic Operations on Units
27674
27675 @noindent
27676 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27677 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27678 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27679 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27680 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27681 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27682 formula.
27683
27684 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27685 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27686 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27687 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27688 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27689 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27690
27691 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27692 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27693 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27694 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27695 representation of one millimeter.
27696
27697 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27698 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27699 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27700
27701 @kindex u s
27702 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27703 @ignore
27704 @mindex usimpl@idots
27705 @end ignore
27706 @tindex usimplify
27707 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27708 simplifies a units
27709 expression. It uses Calc's algebraic simplifications to simplify the
27710 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27711 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27712 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27713 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27714 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27715 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27716 automatically at all times.
27717
27718 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27719 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27720 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27721 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27722 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27723 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27724 applied to units expressions, in which case
27725 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27726 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27727 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27728
27729 @kindex u c
27730 @pindex calc-convert-units
27731 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27732 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27733 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27734 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27735 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27736 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27737 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27738 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27739 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27740
27741 @kindex u t
27742 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27743 @cindex Temperature conversion
27744 The @kbd{u c} command treats temperature units (like @samp{degC} and
27745 @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example, @kbd{u c} converts
27746 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10 degrees Celsius
27747 corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit. To convert absolute
27748 temperatures, you can use the @kbd{u t}
27749 (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command. The value on the stack
27750 must be a simple units expression with units of temperature only.
27751 This command would convert @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the
27752 equivalent temperature on the Fahrenheit scale.
27753
27754 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27755 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27756 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27757 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27758 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27759 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27760 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27761
27762 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27763 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27764 units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27765 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27766 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27767 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27768 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27769 input units.
27770
27771 If you want to disallow using inconsistent units, you can set the customizable variable
27772 @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} to @code{t} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). In this case,
27773 if you request units which are inconsistent with the original units, you will be warned about
27774 it and no conversion will occur.
27775
27776 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27777 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27778 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27779 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27780 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27781 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27782 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27783 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27784
27785 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27786 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27787 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27788 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27789 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27790 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27791
27792 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27793 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27794 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27795 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27796 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27797 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27798 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27799
27800 @cindex Composite units
27801 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27802 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27803 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27804 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27805 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27806 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27807 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27808 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27809 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27810 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27811 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27812 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27813 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27814
27815 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27816 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27817 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27818 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27819 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27820 converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27821
27822 @kindex u b
27823 @pindex calc-base-units
27824 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27825 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27826 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27827 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27828
27829 Like the @kbd{u c} command, the @kbd{u b} command treats temperature
27830 units as relative temperatures.
27831
27832 @kindex u r
27833 @pindex calc-remove-units
27834 @kindex u x
27835 @pindex calc-extract-units
27836 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27837 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27838 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27839 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27840 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27841 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27842
27843 @kindex u a
27844 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27845 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27846 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27847 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27848 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27849 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27850 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27851 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27852 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27853 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27854
27855 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27856 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27857 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27858 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27859 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27860 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27861 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27862 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27863 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27864 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27865 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27866 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27867 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27868 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27869 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27870 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27871
27872 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27873 @section The Units Table
27874
27875 @noindent
27876 @kindex u v
27877 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27878 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27879 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27880 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27881 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27882 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27883 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27884 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27885 and steradians.
27886
27887 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27888 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27889 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27890 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27891 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27892 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27893
27894 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27895 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27896 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27897
27898 @kindex u V
27899 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27900 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27901 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27902 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27903 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
27904 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27905 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27906 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27907
27908 @kindex u g
27909 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27910 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27911 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27912 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27913 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27914 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27915 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27916 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27917 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27918 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27919
27920 @kindex u e
27921 @pindex calc-explain-units
27922 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27923 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27924 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27925 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27926 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27927 column of the Units Table.
27928
27929 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27930 @section Predefined Units
27931
27932 @noindent
27933 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
27934 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
27935 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
27936 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
27937 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
27938 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
27939 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
27940 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
27941 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
27942 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
27943 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
27944 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
27945 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
27946 International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
27947 kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
27948 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
27949 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
27950 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
27951 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
27952 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
27953 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
27954 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
27955
27956 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27957 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27958 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27959 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27960 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27961 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27962 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27963 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27964
27965 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27966 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27967 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27968 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27969 of the various temperature scales.
27970
27971 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27972 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27973
27974 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27975 @tex
27976 for \AA ngstroms.
27977 @end tex
27978 @ifnottex
27979 for Angstroms.
27980 @end ifnottex
27981
27982 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27983 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
27984 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
27985 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
27986 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
27987 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
27988 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
27989 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
27990 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
27991 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
27992 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
27993 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
27994
27995 When Calc is using the @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} language mode (@pxref{TeX
27996 and LaTeX Language Modes}), the @TeX{} specific unit names will not
27997 use the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
27998 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example. To avoid conflicts,
27999 the unit names for pint and parsec will simply be @samp{pint} and
28000 @samp{parsec} instead of @samp{pt} and @samp{pc}.
28001
28002
28003 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
28004 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
28005 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
28006 preferable to @code{e}.
28007
28008 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
28009 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
28010 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
28011
28012 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
28013 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
28014
28015 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
28016 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
28017
28018 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
28019 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
28020 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
28021 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
28022 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
28023 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
28024 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
28025 units.
28026
28027 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
28028 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
28029 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
28030 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
28031 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
28032 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
28033 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
28034 really is unitless.)
28035
28036 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
28037
28038 @node User-Defined Units, Logarithmic Units, Predefined Units, Units
28039 @section User-Defined Units
28040
28041 @noindent
28042 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
28043 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
28044
28045 @kindex u 0-9
28046 @pindex calc-quick-units
28047 @vindex Units
28048 @cindex @code{Units} variable
28049 @cindex Quick units
28050 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
28051 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
28052 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
28053 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
28054 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
28055 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
28056 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
28057 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
28058 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
28059 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
28060 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
28061 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
28062
28063 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
28064 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
28065 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
28066 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
28067 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
28068 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
28069
28070 @kindex u d
28071 @pindex calc-define-unit
28072 @cindex User-defined units
28073 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
28074 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
28075 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
28076 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
28077 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
28078 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
28079 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
28080 appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
28081 be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
28082 asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
28083 command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
28084 for a string that will be used to display the definition.
28085
28086 @kindex u u
28087 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
28088 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
28089 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
28090 however.
28091
28092 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
28093 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
28094 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
28095 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
28096 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
28097
28098 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
28099 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
28100 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
28101 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
28102 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
28103 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
28104 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
28105 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
28106 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
28107
28108 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
28109 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
28110
28111 @kindex u p
28112 @pindex calc-permanent-units
28113 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
28114 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
28115 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
28116 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so that the
28117 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
28118 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
28119 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
28120 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28121
28122 @node Logarithmic Units, Musical Notes, User-Defined Units, Units
28123 @section Logarithmic Units
28124
28125 The units @code{dB} (decibels) and @code{Np} (nepers) are logarithmic
28126 units which are manipulated differently than standard units. Calc
28127 provides commands to work with these logarithmic units.
28128
28129 Decibels and nepers are used to measure power quantities as well as
28130 field quantities (quantities whose squares are proportional to power);
28131 these two types of quantities are handled slightly different from each
28132 other. By default the Calc commands work as if power quantities are
28133 being used; with the @kbd{H} prefix the Calc commands work as if field
28134 quantities are being used.
28135
28136 The decibel level of a power
28137 @infoline @math{P1},
28138 @texline @math{P_1},
28139 relative to a reference power
28140 @infoline @math{P0},
28141 @texline @math{P_0},
28142 is defined to be
28143 @infoline @math{10 log10(P1/P0) dB}.
28144 @texline @math{10 \log_{10}(P_{1}/P_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28145 (The factor of 10 is because a decibel, as its name implies, is
28146 one-tenth of a bel. The bel, named after Alexander Graham Bell, was
28147 considered to be too large of a unit and was effectively replaced by
28148 the decibel.) If @math{F} is a field quantity with power
28149 @math{P=k F^2}, then a reference quantity of
28150 @infoline @math{F0}
28151 @texline @math{F_0}
28152 would correspond to a power of
28153 @infoline @math{P0=k F0^2}.
28154 @texline @math{P_{0}=kF_{0}^2}.
28155 If
28156 @infoline @math{P1=k F1^2},
28157 @texline @math{P_{1}=kF_{1}^2},
28158 then
28159
28160 @ifnottex
28161 @example
28162 10 log10(P1/P0) = 10 log10(F1^2/F0^2) = 20 log10(F1/F0).
28163 @end example
28164 @end ifnottex
28165 @tex
28166 $$ 10 \log_{10}(P_1/P_0) = 10 \log_{10}(F_1^2/F_0^2) = 20
28167 \log_{10}(F_1/F_0)$$
28168 @end tex
28169
28170 @noindent
28171 In order to get the same decibel level regardless of whether a field
28172 quantity or the corresponding power quantity is used, the decibel
28173 level of a field quantity
28174 @infoline @math{F1},
28175 @texline @math{F_1},
28176 relative to a reference
28177 @infoline @math{F0},
28178 @texline @math{F_0},
28179 is defined as
28180 @infoline @math{20 log10(F1/F0) dB}.
28181 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(F_{1}/F_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28182 For example, the decibel value of a sound pressure level of
28183 @infoline @math{60 uPa}
28184 @texline @math{60 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28185 relative to
28186 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28187 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28188 (the threshold of human hearing) is
28189 @infoline @math{20 log10(60 uPa/ 20 uPa) dB = 20 log10(3) dB},
28190 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(60 \mu{\rm Pa}/20 \mu{\rm Pa}) {\rm dB} = 20 \log_{10}(3) {\rm dB}},
28191 which is about
28192 @infoline @math{9.54 dB}.
28193 @texline @math{9.54 {\rm dB}}.
28194 Note that in taking the ratio, the original units cancel and so these
28195 logarithmic units are dimensionless.
28196
28197 Nepers (named after John Napier, who is credited with inventing the
28198 logarithm) are similar to bels except they use natural logarithms instead
28199 of common logarithms. The neper level of a power
28200 @infoline @math{P1},
28201 @texline @math{P_1},
28202 relative to a reference power
28203 @infoline @math{P0},
28204 @texline @math{P_0},
28205 is
28206 @infoline @math{(1/2) ln(P1/P0) Np}.
28207 @texline @math{(1/2) \ln(P_1/P_0) {\rm Np}}.
28208 The neper level of a field
28209 @infoline @math{F1},
28210 @texline @math{F_1},
28211 relative to a reference field
28212 @infoline @math{F0},
28213 @texline @math{F_0},
28214 is
28215 @infoline @math{ln(F1/F0) Np}.
28216 @texline @math{\ln(F_1/F_0) {\rm Np}}.
28217
28218 @vindex calc-lu-power-reference
28219 @vindex calc-lu-field-reference
28220 For power quantities, Calc uses
28221 @infoline @math{1 mW}
28222 @texline @math{1 {\rm mW}}
28223 as the default reference quantity; this default can be changed by changing
28224 the value of the customizable variable
28225 @code{calc-lu-power-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
28226 For field quantities, Calc uses
28227 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28228 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28229 as the default reference quantity; this is the value used in acoustics
28230 which is where decibels are commonly encountered. This default can be
28231 changed by changing the value of the customizable variable
28232 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). A
28233 non-default reference quantity will be read from the stack if the
28234 capital @kbd{O} prefix is used.
28235
28236 @kindex l q
28237 @pindex calc-lu-quant
28238 @tindex lupquant
28239 @tindex lufquant
28240 The @kbd{l q} (@code{calc-lu-quant}) [@code{lupquant}]
28241 command computes the power quantity corresponding to a given number of
28242 logarithmic units. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix, @kbd{O l q}, the
28243 reference level will be read from the top of the stack. (In an
28244 algebraic formula, @code{lupquant} can be given an optional second
28245 argument which will be used for the reference level.) For example,
28246 @code{20 dB @key{RET} l q} will return @code{100 mW};
28247 @code{20 dB @key{RET} 4 W @key{RET} O l q} will return @code{400 W}.
28248 The @kbd{H l q} [@code{lufquant}] command behaves like @kbd{l q} but
28249 computes field quantities instead of power quantities.
28250
28251 @kindex l d
28252 @pindex calc-db
28253 @tindex dbpower
28254 @tindex dbfield
28255 @kindex l n
28256 @pindex calc-np
28257 @tindex nppower
28258 @tindex npfield
28259 The @kbd{l d} (@code{calc-db}) [@code{dbpower}] command will compute
28260 the decibel level of a power quantity using the default reference
28261 level; @kbd{H l d} [@code{dbfield}] will compute the decibel level of
28262 a field quantity. The commands @kbd{l n} (@code{calc-np})
28263 [@code{nppower}] and @kbd{H l n} [@code{npfield}] will similarly
28264 compute neper levels. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix these commands
28265 will read a reference level from the stack; in an algebraic formula
28266 the reference level can be given as an optional second argument.
28267
28268 @kindex l +
28269 @pindex calc-lu-plus
28270 @tindex lupadd
28271 @tindex lufadd
28272 @kindex l -
28273 @pindex calc-lu-minus
28274 @tindex lupsub
28275 @tindex lufsub
28276 @kindex l *
28277 @pindex calc-lu-times
28278 @tindex lupmul
28279 @tindex lufmul
28280 @kindex l /
28281 @pindex calc-lu-divide
28282 @tindex lupdiv
28283 @tindex lufdiv
28284 The sum of two power or field quantities doesn't correspond to the sum
28285 of the corresponding decibel or neper levels. If the powers
28286 corresponding to decibel levels
28287 @infoline @math{D1}
28288 @texline @math{D_1}
28289 and
28290 @infoline @math{D2}
28291 @texline @math{D_2}
28292 are added, the corresponding decibel level ``sum'' will be
28293
28294 @ifnottex
28295 @example
28296 10 log10(10^(D1/10) + 10^(D2/10)) dB.
28297 @end example
28298 @end ifnottex
28299 @tex
28300 $$ 10 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/10} + 10^{D_2/10}) {\rm dB}.$$
28301 @end tex
28302
28303 @noindent
28304 When field quantities are combined, it often means the corresponding
28305 powers are added and so the above formula might be used. In
28306 acoustics, for example, the sound pressure level is a field quantity
28307 and so the decibels are often defined using the field formula, but the
28308 sound pressure levels are combined as the sound power levels, and so
28309 the above formula should be used. If two field quantities themselves
28310 are added, the new decibel level will be
28311
28312 @ifnottex
28313 @example
28314 20 log10(10^(D1/20) + 10^(D2/20)) dB.
28315 @end example
28316 @end ifnottex
28317 @tex
28318 $$ 20 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/20} + 10^{D_2/20}) {\rm dB}.$$
28319 @end tex
28320
28321 @noindent
28322 If the power corresponding to @math{D} dB is multiplied by a number @math{N},
28323 then the corresponding decibel level will be
28324
28325 @ifnottex
28326 @example
28327 D + 10 log10(N) dB,
28328 @end example
28329 @end ifnottex
28330 @tex
28331 $$ D + 10 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB},$$
28332 @end tex
28333
28334 @noindent
28335 if a field quantity is multiplied by @math{N} the corresponding decibel level
28336 will be
28337
28338 @ifnottex
28339 @example
28340 D + 20 log10(N) dB.
28341 @end example
28342 @end ifnottex
28343 @tex
28344 $$ D + 20 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB}.$$
28345 @end tex
28346
28347 @noindent
28348 There are similar formulas for combining nepers. The @kbd{l +}
28349 (@code{calc-lu-plus}) [@code{lupadd}] command will ``add'' two
28350 logarithmic unit power levels this way; with the @kbd{H} prefix,
28351 @kbd{H l +} [@code{lufadd}] will add logarithmic unit field levels.
28352 Similarly, logarithmic units can be ``subtracted'' with @kbd{l -}
28353 (@code{calc-lu-minus}) [@code{lupsub}] or @kbd{H l -} [@code{lufsub}].
28354 The @kbd{l *} (@code{calc-lu-times}) [@code{lupmul}] and @kbd{H l *}
28355 [@code{lufmul}] commands will ``multiply'' a logarithmic unit by a
28356 number; the @kbd{l /} (@code{calc-lu-divide}) [@code{lupdiv}] and
28357 @kbd{H l /} [@code{lufdiv}] commands will ``divide'' a logarithmic
28358 unit by a number. Note that the reference quantities don't play a role
28359 in this arithmetic.
28360
28361 @node Musical Notes, , Logarithmic Units, Units
28362 @section Musical Notes
28363
28364 Calc can convert between musical notes and their associated
28365 frequencies. Notes can be given using either scientific pitch
28366 notation or midi numbers. Since these note systems are basically
28367 logarithmic scales, Calc uses the @kbd{l} prefix for functions
28368 operating on notes.
28369
28370 Scientific pitch notation refers to a note by giving a letter
28371 A through G, possibly followed by a flat or sharp) with a subscript
28372 indicating an octave number. Each octave starts with C and ends with
28373 B and
28374 @c increasing each note by a semitone will result
28375 @c in the sequence @expr{C}, @expr{C} sharp, @expr{D}, @expr{E} flat, @expr{E},
28376 @c @expr{F}, @expr{F} sharp, @expr{G}, @expr{A} flat, @expr{A}, @expr{B}
28377 @c flat and @expr{B}.
28378 the octave numbered 0 was chosen to correspond to the lowest
28379 audible frequency. Using this system, middle C (about 261.625 Hz)
28380 corresponds to the note @expr{C} in octave 4 and is denoted
28381 @expr{C_4}. Any frequency can be described by giving a note plus an
28382 offset in cents (where a cent is a ratio of frequencies so that a
28383 semitone consists of 100 cents).
28384
28385 The midi note number system assigns numbers to notes so that
28386 @expr{C_(-1)} corresponds to the midi note number 0 and @expr{G_9}
28387 corresponds to the midi note number 127. A midi controller can have
28388 up to 128 keys and each midi note number from 0 to 127 corresponds to
28389 a possible key.
28390
28391 @kindex l s
28392 @pindex calc-spn
28393 @tindex spn
28394 The @kbd{l s} (@code{calc-spn}) [@code{spn}] command converts either
28395 a frequency or a midi number to scientific pitch notation. For
28396 example, @code{500 Hz} gets converted to
28397 @code{B_4 + 21.3094853649 cents} and @code{84} to @code{C_6}.
28398
28399
28400 @kindex l m
28401 @pindex calc-midi
28402 @tindex midi
28403 The @kbd{l m} (@code{calc-midi}) [@code{midi}] command converts either
28404 a frequency or a note given in scientific pitch notation to the
28405 corresponding midi number. For example, @code{C_6} gets converted to 84
28406 and @code{440 Hz} to 69.
28407
28408 @kindex l f
28409 @pindex calc-freq
28410 @tindex freq
28411 The @kbd{l f} (@code{calc-freq}) [@code{freq}] command converts either
28412 either a midi number or a note given in scientific pitch notation to
28413 the corresponding frequency. For example, @code{Asharp_2 + 30 cents}
28414 gets converted to @code{118.578040134 Hz} and @code{55} to
28415 @code{195.99771799 Hz}.
28416
28417 Since the frequencies of notes are not usually given exactly (and are
28418 typically irrational), the customizable variable
28419 @code{calc-note-threshold} determines how close (in cents) a frequency
28420 needs to be to a note to be recognized as that note
28421 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). This variable has a default value of
28422 @code{1}. For example, middle @var{C} is approximately
28423 @expr{261.625565302 Hz}; this frequency is often shortened to
28424 @expr{261.625 Hz}. Without @code{calc-note-threshold} (or a value of
28425 @expr{0}), Calc would convert @code{261.625 Hz} to scientific pitch
28426 notation @code{B_3 + 99.9962592773 cents}; with the default value of
28427 @code{1}, Calc converts @code{261.625 Hz} to @code{C_4}.
28428
28429
28430
28431 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
28432 @chapter Storing and Recalling
28433
28434 @noindent
28435 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
28436 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
28437 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
28438 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
28439
28440 @menu
28441 * Storing Variables::
28442 * Recalling Variables::
28443 * Operations on Variables::
28444 * Let Command::
28445 * Evaluates-To Operator::
28446 @end menu
28447
28448 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
28449 @section Storing Variables
28450
28451 @noindent
28452 @kindex s s
28453 @pindex calc-store
28454 @cindex Storing variables
28455 @cindex Quick variables
28456 @vindex q0
28457 @vindex q9
28458 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
28459 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
28460 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
28461 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
28462 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
28463
28464 @kindex s t
28465 @pindex calc-store-into
28466 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
28467 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
28468 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
28469
28470 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
28471 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
28472 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
28473 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
28474 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
28475 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
28476 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
28477 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
28478
28479 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
28480 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
28481 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
28482 righthand sides simultaneously.
28483
28484 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
28485 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
28486 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28487 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28488 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28489 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28490
28491 @kindex s 0-9
28492 @kindex t 0-9
28493 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28494 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28495 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28496 for trail and time/date commands.)
28497
28498 @kindex s +
28499 @kindex s -
28500 @ignore
28501 @mindex @idots
28502 @end ignore
28503 @kindex s *
28504 @ignore
28505 @mindex @null
28506 @end ignore
28507 @kindex s /
28508 @ignore
28509 @mindex @null
28510 @end ignore
28511 @kindex s ^
28512 @ignore
28513 @mindex @null
28514 @end ignore
28515 @kindex s |
28516 @ignore
28517 @mindex @null
28518 @end ignore
28519 @kindex s n
28520 @ignore
28521 @mindex @null
28522 @end ignore
28523 @kindex s &
28524 @ignore
28525 @mindex @null
28526 @end ignore
28527 @kindex s [
28528 @ignore
28529 @mindex @null
28530 @end ignore
28531 @kindex s ]
28532 @pindex calc-store-plus
28533 @pindex calc-store-minus
28534 @pindex calc-store-times
28535 @pindex calc-store-div
28536 @pindex calc-store-power
28537 @pindex calc-store-concat
28538 @pindex calc-store-neg
28539 @pindex calc-store-inv
28540 @pindex calc-store-decr
28541 @pindex calc-store-incr
28542 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28543 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28544 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28545 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28546 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28547 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28548
28549 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28550 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28551 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28552 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28553 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28554 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28555 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28556 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28557 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28558 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28559 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28560 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28561 forwards and backwards:
28562
28563 @example
28564 @group
28565 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28566 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28567 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28568 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28569 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28570 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28571 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28572 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28573 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28574 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28575 @end group
28576 @end example
28577
28578 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28579 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28580 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28581 minus-two minus the variable.
28582
28583 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28584 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28585 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28586
28587 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28588 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28589 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28590 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28591 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28592 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28593 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28594
28595 @kindex s m
28596 @pindex calc-store-map
28597 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28598 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28599 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28600 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28601 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28602 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28603 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28604 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28605 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28606 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28607 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28608
28609 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28610 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28611 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28612 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28613 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28614 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28615 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28616
28617 @kindex s x
28618 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28619 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28620 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28621 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28622
28623 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28624 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28625 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28626
28627 @kindex s u
28628 @pindex calc-unstore
28629 @cindex Void variables
28630 @cindex Un-storing variables
28631 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28632 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28633 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28634 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28635 void state.
28636
28637 @kindex s c
28638 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28639 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28640 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28641 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28642 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28643 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28644 current precision.
28645
28646 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28647 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28648 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28649 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28650 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28651 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28652 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28653 normally void).
28654
28655 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28656 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28657 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28658 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28659 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28660 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28661 @kbd{s c}.
28662
28663 @kindex s k
28664 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28665 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28666 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28667 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28668 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28669 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28670 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28671 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28672 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28673 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28674 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28675
28676 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28677 @section Recalling Variables
28678
28679 @noindent
28680 @kindex s r
28681 @pindex calc-recall
28682 @cindex Recalling variables
28683 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28684 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28685 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28686 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28687 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28688
28689 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28690 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28691 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28692 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28693 latter will produce an error message.
28694
28695 @kindex r 0-9
28696 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28697 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
28698
28699 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28700 @section Other Operations on Variables
28701
28702 @noindent
28703 @kindex s e
28704 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28705 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28706 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28707 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28708 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28709 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28710 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28711 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28712 description of editing.
28713
28714 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28715 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28716 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28717 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28718 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28719 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28720 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28721 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28722 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28723 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28724
28725 @kindex s A
28726 @kindex s D
28727 @ignore
28728 @mindex @idots
28729 @end ignore
28730 @kindex s E
28731 @ignore
28732 @mindex @null
28733 @end ignore
28734 @kindex s F
28735 @ignore
28736 @mindex @null
28737 @end ignore
28738 @kindex s G
28739 @ignore
28740 @mindex @null
28741 @end ignore
28742 @kindex s H
28743 @ignore
28744 @mindex @null
28745 @end ignore
28746 @kindex s I
28747 @ignore
28748 @mindex @null
28749 @end ignore
28750 @kindex s L
28751 @ignore
28752 @mindex @null
28753 @end ignore
28754 @kindex s P
28755 @ignore
28756 @mindex @null
28757 @end ignore
28758 @kindex s R
28759 @ignore
28760 @mindex @null
28761 @end ignore
28762 @kindex s T
28763 @ignore
28764 @mindex @null
28765 @end ignore
28766 @kindex s U
28767 @ignore
28768 @mindex @null
28769 @end ignore
28770 @kindex s X
28771 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28772 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28773 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28774 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28775 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28776 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28777 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28778 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28779 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28780 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28781 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28782 @pindex calc-store-Units
28783 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28784 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28785 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28786
28787 @table @kbd
28788 @item s A
28789 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28790 @item s D
28791 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28792 @item s E
28793 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Basic Simplifications}.
28794 @item s F
28795 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28796 @item s G
28797 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28798 @item s H
28799 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28800 @item s I
28801 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28802 @item s L
28803 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28804 @item s P
28805 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28806 @item s R
28807 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28808 @item s T
28809 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28810 @item s U
28811 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28812 @item s X
28813 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28814 @end table
28815
28816 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28817 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28818
28819 @kindex s p
28820 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28821 @cindex Storing variables
28822 @cindex Permanent variables
28823 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28824 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28825 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28826 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so
28827 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28828 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28829 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28830 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28831 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28832
28833 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28834 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28835 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28836 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28837 and @code{PlotRejects};
28838 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28839 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28840 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28841 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28842
28843 @kindex s i
28844 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28845 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28846 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28847 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28848 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28849 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28850 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28851 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28852 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28853 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28854 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28855
28856 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28857 @section The Let Command
28858
28859 @noindent
28860 @kindex s l
28861 @pindex calc-let
28862 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28863 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28864 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28865 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28866 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28867 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28868
28869 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28870 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28871 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28872 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28873 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28874 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28875 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28876 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28877 by these commands.
28878
28879 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28880 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28881 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28882
28883 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28884 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28885 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28886
28887 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28888 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28889 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28890 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28891 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28892 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28893
28894 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28895 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28896
28897 @noindent
28898 @tindex evalto
28899 @tindex =>
28900 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28901 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28902 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28903 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28904 other language modes like Pascal and @LaTeX{}.) This is a binary
28905 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28906 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28907
28908 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28909 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28910 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28911 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28912 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28913 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28914
28915 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28916 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28917 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28918
28919 @kindex s =
28920 @pindex calc-evalto
28921 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28922 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28923 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28924 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28925 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28926
28927 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28928 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28929 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28930 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28931 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28932 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28933 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28934 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28935 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28936 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28937 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28938 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28939 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28940 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28941 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28942
28943 @kindex m C
28944 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
28945 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28946 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28947 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28948 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28949 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28950 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28951 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28952
28953 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28954 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28955 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28956 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28957 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28958 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28959 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
28960
28961 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28962 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28963 formula @samp{arcsin(sin(x))} will not be handled by Calc's algebraic
28964 simplifications, but Calc's unsafe simplifications will reduce it to
28965 @samp{x}. If you enter @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) =>} normally, the result
28966 will be @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))}. If you change to
28967 Extended Simplification mode, the result will be
28968 @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a e}
28969 once will have no effect on @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))},
28970 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28971 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28972 affected by commands like @kbd{a e}.
28973
28974 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28975 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28976 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28977 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28978 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28979 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28980 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28981 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28982 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28983 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28984
28985 @smallexample
28986 @group
28987 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
28988 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28989 . . .
28990
28991 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28992 @end group
28993 @end smallexample
28994
28995 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28996 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28997 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28998 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28999 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
29000 side effects.
29001
29002 @kindex s :
29003 @pindex calc-assign
29004 @tindex assign
29005 @tindex :=
29006 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
29007 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
29008 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
29009 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
29010 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
29011 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
29012 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
29013 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
29014 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
29015
29016 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
29017 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
29018 treatment to @samp{=>}.
29019
29020 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
29021 @chapter Graphics
29022
29023 @noindent
29024 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
29025 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
29026 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
29027 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
29028 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
29029 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
29030
29031 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
29032 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
29033 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable in
29034 your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some
29035 Lisp variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
29036 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are using
29037 the X window system or MS-Windows, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
29038 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are using a
29039 Unix or GNU system without X, Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display
29040 graphs using simple character graphics that will work on any
29041 Posix-compatible terminal.
29042
29043 @menu
29044 * Basic Graphics::
29045 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
29046 * Managing Curves::
29047 * Graphics Options::
29048 * Devices::
29049 @end menu
29050
29051 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
29052 @section Basic Graphics
29053
29054 @noindent
29055 @kindex g f
29056 @pindex calc-graph-fast
29057 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
29058 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
29059 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
29060 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
29061 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
29062 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
29063 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
29064 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
29065 to indicate the points themselves.
29066
29067 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
29068 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
29069 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
29070
29071 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
29072 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
29073 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
29074
29075 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
29076 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
29077 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
29078 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
29079 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
29080 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
29081 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
29082 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
29083 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
29084
29085 @ignore
29086 @starindex
29087 @end ignore
29088 @tindex xy
29089 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
29090 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
29091 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
29092 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
29093 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
29094 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
29095 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
29096 will be a circle.
29097
29098 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
29099 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
29100 variables.
29101
29102 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
29103 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
29104 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
29105 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
29106 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
29107 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
29108 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
29109 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
29110 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
29111
29112 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
29113 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
29114
29115 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
29116 @vindex PlotRejects
29117 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
29118 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
29119 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
29120 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
29121 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
29122 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
29123 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
29124 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
29125 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
29126 @code{PlotRejects}.
29127
29128 @kindex g c
29129 @pindex calc-graph-clear
29130 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
29131 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
29132 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
29133 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
29134 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
29135 window if there is one.
29136
29137 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
29138 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
29139
29140 @kindex g F
29141 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
29142 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
29143 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
29144 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
29145
29146 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
29147 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
29148 are several options for these values.
29149
29150 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
29151 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
29152 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
29153 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
29154 result is a surface plot where
29155 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
29156 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
29157 is the height of the point
29158 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
29159 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
29160 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29161 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
29162 description of the @samp{set view} command.
29163
29164 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
29165 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
29166
29167 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
29168 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
29169 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
29170 of values from the input vectors.
29171
29172 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
29173 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
29174 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
29175 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
29176 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
29177 3D surface.
29178
29179 @ignore
29180 @starindex
29181 @end ignore
29182 @tindex xyz
29183 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
29184 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
29185 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
29186 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
29187 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
29188 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
29189 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
29190 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
29191 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
29192 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
29193 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
29194 vectors with more than 5 elements.
29195
29196 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
29197 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
29198 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
29199 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
29200 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
29201
29202 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
29203 variables containing the relevant data.
29204
29205 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
29206 @section Managing Curves
29207
29208 @noindent
29209 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
29210 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
29211 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
29212 by using these commands directly.
29213
29214 @kindex g a
29215 @pindex calc-graph-add
29216 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
29217 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
29218 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
29219 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
29220 on the same axes.
29221
29222 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
29223 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
29224 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
29225 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
29226 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
29227 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
29228 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
29229 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
29230 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
29231 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
29232 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
29233 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
29234 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29235
29236 @vindex PlotData1
29237 @vindex PlotData2
29238 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
29239 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
29240 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
29241 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
29242 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
29243 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
29244 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
29245 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
29246
29247 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
29248 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
29249 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
29250 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
29251 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
29252 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
29253
29254 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
29255 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
29256 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
29257
29258 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
29259 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
29260 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
29261 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
29262 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
29263 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
29264
29265 For example, to plot
29266 @texline @math{\sin n x}
29267 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
29268 for integers @expr{n}
29269 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
29270 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
29271 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
29272 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
29273 command.
29274
29275 @kindex g A
29276 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
29277 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
29278 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
29279 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
29280 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
29281 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
29282 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
29283 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
29284 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
29285 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
29286 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29287
29288 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
29289 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
29290 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
29291 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
29292 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
29293 check for this.)
29294
29295 @kindex g d
29296 @pindex calc-graph-delete
29297 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
29298 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
29299 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
29300 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
29301
29302 @kindex g H
29303 @pindex calc-graph-hide
29304 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
29305 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
29306 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
29307 point styles will be retained.
29308
29309 @kindex g j
29310 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
29311 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
29312 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
29313 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
29314 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
29315 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
29316 affect the last curve in the list.
29317
29318 @kindex g p
29319 @pindex calc-graph-plot
29320 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
29321 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
29322 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
29323 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
29324 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
29325 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
29326 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
29327 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
29328 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
29329
29330 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
29331 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
29332 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
29333 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
29334 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
29335 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
29336 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
29337
29338 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
29339 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
29340 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
29341 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
29342 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
29343 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
29344 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
29345
29346 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
29347 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
29348 the current graph is three-dimensional.
29349
29350 @kindex g P
29351 @pindex calc-graph-print
29352 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
29353 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
29354 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
29355 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
29356 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
29357 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
29358 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
29359 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
29360 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
29361 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
29362 always plot to the printer.
29363
29364 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
29365 @section Graphics Options
29366
29367 @noindent
29368 @kindex g g
29369 @pindex calc-graph-grid
29370 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
29371 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
29372 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
29373 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
29374 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
29375 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
29376
29377 @kindex g b
29378 @pindex calc-graph-border
29379 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
29380 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
29381 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29382
29383 @kindex g k
29384 @pindex calc-graph-key
29385 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
29386 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
29387 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
29388 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
29389 curves on the same graph.
29390
29391 @kindex g N
29392 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
29393 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
29394 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
29395 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
29396 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
29397 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
29398 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
29399 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
29400 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
29401 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
29402 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
29403 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
29404 will be computed for the surface.
29405
29406 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
29407 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
29408 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
29409 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
29410 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
29411 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
29412 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
29413 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
29414 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
29415
29416 @kindex g h
29417 @pindex calc-graph-header
29418 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
29419 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
29420 The default title is blank (no title).
29421
29422 @kindex g n
29423 @pindex calc-graph-name
29424 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
29425 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
29426 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
29427 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
29428 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
29429 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
29430 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
29431 not used.
29432
29433 @kindex g t
29434 @kindex g T
29435 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
29436 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
29437 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
29438 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
29439 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
29440 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
29441 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
29442 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
29443 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
29444
29445 @kindex g r
29446 @kindex g R
29447 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
29448 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
29449 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
29450 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
29451 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
29452 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
29453 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
29454 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
29455 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
29456 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
29457 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
29458
29459 @kindex g l
29460 @kindex g L
29461 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
29462 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
29463 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
29464 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
29465 be logarithmic instead of linear.
29466
29467 @kindex g C-l
29468 @kindex g C-r
29469 @kindex g C-t
29470 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
29471 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
29472 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
29473 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
29474 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
29475 for the ``z'' axis.
29476
29477 @kindex g z
29478 @kindex g Z
29479 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
29480 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
29481 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
29482 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
29483 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
29484 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29485 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29486 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29487 not available for 3D plots.
29488
29489 @kindex g s
29490 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
29491 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29492 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29493 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29494 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29495 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29496 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29497 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29498 available for any device.
29499
29500 @kindex g S
29501 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
29502 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29503 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29504 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29505 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29506 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29507 the error bars on or off.
29508
29509 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29510 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29511 @vindex LineStyles
29512 @vindex PointStyles
29513 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29514 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29515 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29516 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29517 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29518 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29519 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29520 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29521 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29522 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29523
29524 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29525 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29526 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29527 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29528 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29529
29530 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29531 @section Graphical Devices
29532
29533 @noindent
29534 @kindex g D
29535 @pindex calc-graph-device
29536 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29537 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29538 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29539 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29540 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29541
29542 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29543 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29544 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29545 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29546 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29547 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29548 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), @code{windows} on MS-Windows, or
29549 otherwise @code{dumb} under GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or
29550 @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0. This is the initial default
29551 value.
29552
29553 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29554 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29555 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29556 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29557 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29558 dumb terminals will be
29559 @texline @math{80\times24}
29560 @infoline 80x24
29561 characters. The graph is displayed in
29562 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29563 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29564 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29565
29566 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29567 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29568 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29569 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29570 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29571 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29572 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29573 of the four directions.
29574
29575 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29576 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29577 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29578 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29579 plot on any text-only printer.
29580
29581 @kindex g O
29582 @pindex calc-graph-output
29583 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of the
29584 output file used by GNUPLOT@. For some devices, notably @code{x11} and
29585 @code{windows}, there is no output file and this information is not
29586 used. Many other ``devices'' are really file formats like
29587 @code{postscript}; in these cases the output in the desired format
29588 goes into the file you name with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout
29589 @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write to its standard output stream,
29590 i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}. This is the default setting.
29591
29592 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29593 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29594 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29595 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29596 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29597 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29598 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29599 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29600 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29601
29602 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29603 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29604 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29605 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29606 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29607 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29608
29609 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29610 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29611 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29612 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29613 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29614 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29615
29616 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29617 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29618 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29619 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29620 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29621 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29622 You may wish to configure the default and
29623 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29624 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29625 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29626 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29627 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29628
29629 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29630 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29631 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29632 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29633 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29634 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29635 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29636 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29637
29638 @kindex g x
29639 @pindex calc-graph-display
29640 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29641 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29642 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29643 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29644
29645 @kindex g X
29646 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29647 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29648 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29649 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29650 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29651 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29652 window in the upper-left corner of the screen. This command has no
29653 effect if the current device is @code{windows}.
29654
29655 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29656 session with GNUPLOT@. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29657 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29658 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29659 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29660 something has gone wrong@footnote{
29661 On MS-Windows, due to the peculiarities of how the Windows version of
29662 GNUPLOT (called @command{wgnuplot}) works, the GNUPLOT responses are
29663 not communicated back to Calc. Instead, you need to look them up in
29664 the GNUPLOT command window that is displayed as in normal interactive
29665 usage of GNUPLOT.
29666 }.
29667
29668 @kindex g C
29669 @pindex calc-graph-command
29670 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29671 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29672 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29673 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29674 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29675
29676 @kindex g v
29677 @kindex g V
29678 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29679 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29680 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29681 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29682 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29683 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29684 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29685 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29686 buffer is hidden again. (Note that on MS-Windows, the @samp{*Gnuplot
29687 Trail*} buffer will usually show nothing of interest, because
29688 GNUPLOT's responses are not communicated back to Calc.)
29689
29690 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29691 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29692 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29693 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29694 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29695 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29696 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29697 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29698 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29699 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29700 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29701 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29702 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29703 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29704 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29705 with @kbd{g p}.
29706
29707 @kindex g q
29708 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29709 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29710 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29711 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29712 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29713 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29714 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29715
29716 @kindex g K
29717 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29718 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29719 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29720 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29721 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29722
29723 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29724 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29725
29726 @noindent
29727 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29728 other Emacs editing buffers.
29729
29730 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29731 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29732
29733 @menu
29734 * Killing From Stack::
29735 * Yanking Into Stack::
29736 * Saving Into Registers::
29737 * Inserting From Registers::
29738 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29739 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29740 * X Cut and Paste::
29741 @end menu
29742
29743 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29744 @section Killing from the Stack
29745
29746 @noindent
29747 @kindex C-k
29748 @pindex calc-kill
29749 @kindex M-k
29750 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29751 @kindex C-w
29752 @pindex calc-kill-region
29753 @kindex M-w
29754 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29755 @kindex M-C-w
29756 @cindex Kill ring
29757 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29758 ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29759 Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29760 one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29761 @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29762 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29763 although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29764 ``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29765 only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29766 the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29767 @kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29768 to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29769 deleting anything.
29770
29771 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29772 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29773 the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29774 Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29775 text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29776 including line numbers if they are enabled.
29777
29778 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29779 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29780 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29781 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29782 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29783 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29784 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29785 newline.
29786
29787 @node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29788 @section Yanking into the Stack
29789
29790 @noindent
29791 @kindex C-y
29792 @pindex calc-yank
29793 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29794 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29795 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29796 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29797 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29798 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29799 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29800 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29801 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29802 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29803 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29804 difference.)
29805
29806 @node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29807 @section Saving into Registers
29808
29809 @noindent
29810 @kindex r s
29811 @pindex calc-copy-to-register
29812 @pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29813 @pindex calc-append-to-register
29814 @cindex Registers
29815 An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29816 registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29817 saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29818 commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29819 entries.
29820
29821 Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29822 each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29823 region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29824 register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29825 You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29826 you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29827 register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29828 argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29829 register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29830
29831 It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29832 command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29833 then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29834 contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29835 similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29836 region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29837 @kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29838 added to the register.
29839
29840 @node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29841 @section Inserting from Registers
29842 @noindent
29843 @kindex r i
29844 @pindex calc-insert-register
29845 The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29846 register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29847 Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29848 within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29849 inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29850 register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29851
29852 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
29853 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29854
29855 @noindent
29856 @kindex C-x * g
29857 @pindex calc-grab-region
29858 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29859 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29860 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29861 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29862 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29863 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29864 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29865 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29866
29867 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29868 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29869 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29870 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29871 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29872 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29873 delete given that prefix argument.
29874
29875 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29876 line.
29877
29878 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29879 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29880 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29881 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29882 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29883 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29884 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29885 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29886
29887 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29888 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29889
29890 @kindex C-x * r
29891 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29892 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29893 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29894 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29895 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29896 whose contents are parsed.
29897
29898 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29899 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29900 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29901
29902 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29903 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29904 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29905 is ignored.
29906
29907 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29908 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29909 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29910 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29911 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29912 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
29913
29914 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29915 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29916 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
29917 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29918 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
29919 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29920 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
29921 as @samp{[2*a]}.
29922
29923 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29924 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29925 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29926 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29927 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29928
29929 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29930 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29931 @texline @math{1\times1}
29932 @infoline 1x1
29933 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29934
29935 @kindex C-x * :
29936 @kindex C-x * _
29937 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29938 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29939 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29940 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29941 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29942 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29943 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29944 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29945 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29946 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29947
29948 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
29949 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29950 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29951 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29952 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29953
29954 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29955 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29956 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
29957 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29958 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29959 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29960
29961 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29962 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29963 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29964 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29965 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29966 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29967 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29968
29969 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29970 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
29971
29972 @noindent
29973 @kindex y
29974 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29975 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29976 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29977 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29978 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29979 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29980 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29981 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29982 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29983
29984 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29985 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29986 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29987 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29988 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29989 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29990 latter strips off the trailing newline.
29991
29992 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29993 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29994 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29995 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29996 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29997 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29998 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29999 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
30000 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
30001 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
30002
30003 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
30004 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
30005 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
30006 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
30007 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
30008 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
30009 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
30010 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
30011 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
30012 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
30013 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
30014 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
30015 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
30016 to overwriting one complete number with another.
30017
30018 @kindex C-x * y
30019 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
30020 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
30021 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
30022
30023 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
30024 @section X Cut and Paste
30025
30026 @noindent
30027 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
30028 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
30029 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
30030
30031 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
30032 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
30033 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
30034 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
30035 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
30036 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
30037 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
30038 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
30039 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
30040 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
30041 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
30042
30043 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
30044 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
30045 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
30046 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
30047 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
30048 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
30049 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
30050 in the Calc window.
30051
30052 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
30053 @chapter Keypad Mode
30054
30055 @noindent
30056 @kindex C-x * k
30057 @pindex calc-keypad
30058 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
30059 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
30060 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
30061 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
30062 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
30063 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
30064 calculations with the mouse.
30065
30066 @pindex full-calc-keypad
30067 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
30068 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
30069 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
30070 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
30071 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
30072
30073 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
30074 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
30075 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
30076 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
30077
30078 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
30079 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
30080 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
30081
30082 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
30083 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
30084 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
30085 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
30086 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
30087 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
30088 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
30089 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
30090
30091 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
30092 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
30093 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
30094 original buffer.
30095
30096 @menu
30097 * Keypad Main Menu::
30098 * Keypad Functions Menu::
30099 * Keypad Binary Menu::
30100 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
30101 * Keypad Modes Menu::
30102 @end menu
30103
30104 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
30105 @section Main Menu
30106
30107 @smallexample
30108 @group
30109 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
30110 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
30111 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30112 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
30113 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30114 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
30115 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30116 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
30117 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
30118 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
30119 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30120 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
30121 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30122 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
30123 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30124 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
30125 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
30126 @end group
30127 @end smallexample
30128
30129 @noindent
30130 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
30131 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
30132 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
30133 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
30134
30135 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
30136 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
30137 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
30138 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
30139 or any other function key.
30140
30141 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
30142 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
30143 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
30144 stack.
30145
30146 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
30147 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
30148 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
30149 below and in the following sections.
30150
30151 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
30152 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
30153
30154 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
30155 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
30156 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
30157
30158 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
30159 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
30160 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
30161 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
30162
30163 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
30164 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
30165 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
30166 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
30167 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
30168
30169 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
30170 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
30171 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
30172 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
30173
30174 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
30175 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
30176 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
30177 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
30178
30179 @table @kbd
30180 @item INV +/-
30181 is the same as @key{1/x}.
30182 @item INV +
30183 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
30184 @item INV -
30185 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
30186 @item INV *
30187 is the same as @key{y^x}.
30188 @item INV /
30189 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
30190 @item HYP/INV 1
30191 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
30192 @item HYP/INV 2
30193 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
30194 @item HYP/INV 3
30195 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
30196 @item INV/HYP 4
30197 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
30198 @item INV/HYP 5
30199 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
30200 @item INV 6
30201 is the same as @key{ABS}.
30202 @item INV 7
30203 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
30204 @item INV 8
30205 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
30206 @item INV 9
30207 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
30208 @item INV 0
30209 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
30210 @item INV .
30211 is the same as @key{PREC}.
30212 @item INV ENTER
30213 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
30214 @item HYP ENTER
30215 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
30216 @item INV HYP ENTER
30217 is the same as @key{OVER}.
30218 @item HYP +/-
30219 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
30220 @item HYP EEX
30221 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
30222 @item INV EEX
30223 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
30224 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
30225 by the two limits of the interval.
30226 @end table
30227
30228 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
30229 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
30230 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
30231 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
30232 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
30233 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
30234
30235 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
30236 @section Functions Menu
30237
30238 @smallexample
30239 @group
30240 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
30241 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
30242 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30243 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
30244 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30245 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
30246 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30247 @end group
30248 @end smallexample
30249
30250 @noindent
30251 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
30252 prefix keys.
30253
30254 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
30255 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
30256
30257 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
30258 extracts the imaginary part.
30259
30260 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
30261 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
30262 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
30263 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
30264 same limit as last time.
30265
30266 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
30267
30268 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
30269 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30270 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30271
30272 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
30273 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
30274
30275 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
30276 finds the previous prime.
30277
30278 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
30279 @section Binary Menu
30280
30281 @smallexample
30282 @group
30283 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
30284 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
30285 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30286 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
30287 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30288 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
30289 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30290 @end group
30291 @end smallexample
30292
30293 @noindent
30294 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
30295 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
30296 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
30297
30298 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
30299 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
30300
30301 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
30302 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
30303 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
30304 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
30305
30306 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
30307 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
30308 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
30309 The initial word size is 32 bits.
30310
30311 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
30312 @section Vectors Menu
30313
30314 @smallexample
30315 @group
30316 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
30317 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
30318 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30319 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
30320 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30321 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
30322 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30323 @end group
30324 @end smallexample
30325
30326 @noindent
30327 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
30328
30329 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
30330 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
30331 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
30332 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
30333 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
30334 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
30335 rows into a matrix.
30336
30337 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
30338 components separately.
30339
30340 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
30341 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
30342 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
30343 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
30344 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
30345
30346 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
30347 identity matrix.
30348
30349 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
30350
30351 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
30352
30353 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
30354 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
30355
30356 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
30357 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
30358 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
30359 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
30360
30361 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
30362 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
30363 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
30364
30365 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
30366 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
30367 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
30368
30369 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
30370 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
30371 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
30372 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
30373 all the elements of a vector.
30374
30375 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
30376 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
30377 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
30378 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
30379 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
30380 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
30381 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
30382 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
30383 the formula @samp{x^y}.
30384
30385 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
30386 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
30387 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
30388 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
30389 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
30390 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
30391 @expr{t}, respectively.
30392
30393 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
30394 @section Modes Menu
30395
30396 @smallexample
30397 @group
30398 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
30399 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
30400 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30401 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
30402 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30403 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
30404 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30405 @end group
30406 @end smallexample
30407
30408 @noindent
30409 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
30410
30411 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
30412 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
30413 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
30414 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
30415 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
30416
30417 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
30418 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
30419 well as to the left.
30420
30421 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
30422 for trigonometric functions.
30423
30424 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
30425 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
30426 fractional or floating-point results.
30427
30428 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
30429 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
30430
30431 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
30432 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
30433 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
30434
30435 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
30436 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
30437
30438 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
30439 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
30440 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
30441 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
30442
30443 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
30444 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
30445 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
30446 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
30447 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
30448
30449 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
30450 @chapter Embedded Mode
30451
30452 @noindent
30453 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
30454 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
30455 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
30456 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
30457
30458 @menu
30459 * Basic Embedded Mode::
30460 * More About Embedded Mode::
30461 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
30462 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
30463 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
30464 @end menu
30465
30466 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30467 @section Basic Embedded Mode
30468
30469 @noindent
30470 @kindex C-x * e
30471 @pindex calc-embedded
30472 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
30473 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
30474 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
30475 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
30476 are visiting your own files.
30477
30478 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
30479 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
30480 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to @LaTeX{}.
30481 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
30482 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
30483 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
30484 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
30485 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30486 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
30487 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
30488 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
30489
30490 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
30491 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
30492 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
30493 understands are:
30494
30495 @enumerate
30496 @item
30497 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30498 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30499 @item
30500 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30501 @item
30502 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30503 @item
30504 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30505 @item
30506 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30507 @end enumerate
30508
30509 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30510 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30511 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30512
30513 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30514 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30515 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30516 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30517
30518 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30519 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30520 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30521
30522 @kindex C-x * w
30523 @pindex calc-embedded-word
30524 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30525 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30526 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30527 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30528 backward to delimit the formula.
30529
30530 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30531 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30532 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30533 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30534 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30535 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30536 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30537 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30538 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30539 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30540 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30541
30542 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30543 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30544 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30545 an algebraic entry.
30546
30547 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30548 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30549 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30550 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30551 not affected by Embedded mode.
30552
30553 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30554 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30555 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30556 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30557 find you need to see the entire stack.
30558
30559 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30560 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30561 inequality:
30562
30563 @example
30564 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30565 @end example
30566
30567 @noindent
30568 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30569 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30570 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30571 to match Calc's usual display style:
30572
30573 @example
30574 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30575 @end example
30576
30577 @noindent
30578 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30579 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30580 Embedded mode.
30581
30582 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30583 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30584 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30585 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30586 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30587 needs to be commuted.
30588
30589 @example
30590 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30591 @end example
30592
30593 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30594 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30595 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30596 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30597
30598 @example
30599 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30600 @end example
30601
30602 @noindent
30603 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30604 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30605 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30606 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30607 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30608 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30609 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30610
30611 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30612 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30613 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30614 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30615 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30616 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30617 Embedded mode is concerned.
30618
30619 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30620 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30621 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30622 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30623 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30624 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30625 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30626 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30627 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30628 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30629
30630 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30631 @section More About Embedded Mode
30632
30633 @noindent
30634 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30635 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30636 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30637 written. If the formula contains any @LaTeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30638 it is parsed (i.e., read) in @LaTeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30639 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30640 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30641
30642 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30643 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a @LaTeX{} formula when
30644 not in @LaTeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30645 whatever language mode is in effect.
30646
30647 @tex
30648 \bigskip
30649 @end tex
30650
30651 @kindex d p
30652 @pindex calc-show-plain
30653 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30654 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30655 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30656 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30657 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30658 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30659 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30660 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30661 version.
30662
30663 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30664 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30665 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}, so if your formula is
30666 embedded in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} document its plain version will be
30667 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30668 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30669 in a comment for those modes, also.
30670 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30671 formula delimiters.
30672
30673 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30674 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30675 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30676 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30677 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30678 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30679 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30680 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30681
30682 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30683 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30684 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30685 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30686 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30687 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30688
30689 @tex
30690 \bigskip
30691 @end tex
30692
30693 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30694 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30695 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30696 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30697 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30698 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30699 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30700 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30701 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30702 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30703 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30704 ``plain'' mode.
30705
30706 @tex
30707 \bigskip
30708 @end tex
30709
30710 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30711 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30712 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30713 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30714 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30715
30716 @smallexample
30717 The derivative of
30718
30719 ln(ln(x))
30720
30721 is
30722
30723 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30724
30725 whose value at x = 2 is
30726
30727 @r{(the value)}
30728
30729 and at x = 3 is
30730
30731 @r{(the value)}
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 @kindex C-x * d
30735 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30736 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30737 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30738 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30739 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30740 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30741
30742 For this example, you would start with just
30743
30744 @smallexample
30745 The derivative of
30746
30747 ln(ln(x))
30748 @end smallexample
30749
30750 @noindent
30751 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30752 is
30753
30754 @smallexample
30755 The derivative of
30756
30757 ln(ln(x))
30758
30759
30760 ln(ln(x))
30761 @end smallexample
30762
30763 @noindent
30764 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30765 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30766 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30767 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30768 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30769 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30770
30771 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30772 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30773 various formulas and numbers.
30774
30775 @tex
30776 \bigskip
30777 @end tex
30778
30779 @kindex C-x * f
30780 @kindex C-x * '
30781 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30782 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30783 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30784 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30785 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30786 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30787 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30788 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30789 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30790
30791 @kindex C-x * n
30792 @kindex C-x * p
30793 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30794 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30795 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30796 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30797 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30798 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30799 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30800 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30801 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30802 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30803 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30804 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30805 formula, they just move the cursor.
30806
30807 @kindex C-x * `
30808 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30809 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30810 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30811 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30812 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30813
30814 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30815 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30816
30817 @noindent
30818 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30819 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30820 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30821 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30822
30823 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30824
30825 @example
30826 foo := 5
30827 @end example
30828
30829 @noindent
30830 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30831 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30832 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30833 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30834 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30835
30836 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30837 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30838 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30839 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30840 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30841
30842 @example
30843 foo + 7 => 12
30844 @end example
30845
30846 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30847
30848 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30849 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30850
30851 @example
30852 foo := 17
30853
30854 foo + 7 => 24
30855 @end example
30856
30857 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30858 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30859 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30860 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30861 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30862
30863 @example
30864 17
30865
30866 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30867 @end example
30868
30869 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30870 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30871 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30872 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30873
30874 @kindex C-x * j
30875 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30876 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30877 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30878 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30879 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30880 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30881 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30882
30883 @example
30884 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30885 @end example
30886
30887 @noindent
30888 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30889
30890 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30891 mode.
30892
30893 @kindex C-x * u
30894 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30895 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30896 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30897 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30898 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30899 command is a convenient way to do this.
30900
30901 @example
30902 foo := 6
30903
30904 foo + 7 => 13
30905 @end example
30906
30907 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
30908 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30909 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
30910 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30911 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
30912 that formula will not be disturbed.
30913
30914 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
30915 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30916 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30917 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30918 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30919
30920 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
30921 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30922
30923 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30924 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30925 file.
30926
30927 @kindex C-x * a
30928 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
30929 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30930 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30931 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30932 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30933 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30934 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30935 changed.
30936
30937 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
30938 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30939 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30940 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30941 a few lines that look like this:
30942
30943 @example
30944 --- Local Variables: ---
30945 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30946 --- End: ---
30947 @end example
30948
30949 @noindent
30950 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30951 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30952 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30953 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30954 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30955 trailing strings.
30956
30957 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30958 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30959 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30960 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30961 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30962 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30963 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30964 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30965 Emacs manual}.
30966
30967 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30968 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
30969 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30970 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30971 saved.
30972
30973 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30974 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30975 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
30976 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30977 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30978 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30979
30980 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30981 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30982 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30983 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
30984 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30985 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30986 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30987 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30988 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30989 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30990 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
30991 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30992 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30993 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30994 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
30995
30996 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30997 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30998 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30999 following assignment is used.
31000
31001 @example
31002 x => 1
31003
31004 x := 1
31005
31006 x => 1
31007
31008 x := 2
31009
31010 x => 2
31011 @end example
31012
31013 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
31014 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
31015 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
31016 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
31017 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
31018 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
31019
31020 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
31021 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
31022 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
31023 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
31024 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
31025 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
31026 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
31027
31028 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
31029 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
31030 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
31031 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
31032 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
31033 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
31034 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
31035 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
31036 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
31037 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
31038 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
31039
31040 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31041 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
31042
31043 @kindex m e
31044 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
31045 @noindent
31046 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
31047 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
31048 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
31049 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
31050 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
31051 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
31052
31053 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
31054 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
31055 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
31056 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
31057 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
31058 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
31059
31060 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
31061 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
31062 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
31063 delimiter of the formula.
31064
31065 @example
31066 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
31067 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31068 @end example
31069
31070 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
31071 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
31072 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
31073 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
31074 the file, or up to a line of the form
31075
31076 @example
31077 % [calc-defaults]
31078 @end example
31079
31080 @noindent
31081 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
31082 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
31083 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
31084
31085 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
31086 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
31087 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
31088 below).
31089
31090 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
31091 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
31092 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
31093 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
31094 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
31095 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
31096 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
31097 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
31098 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
31099
31100 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
31101 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
31102 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
31103 one.
31104
31105 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
31106 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
31107 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
31108 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
31109 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
31110 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
31111 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
31112 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
31113 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
31114
31115 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
31116 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
31117 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
31118 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
31119 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
31120 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
31121
31122 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
31123 that look like this, respectively:
31124
31125 @example
31126 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31127 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
31128 @end example
31129
31130 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
31131 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
31132 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
31133 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
31134 yet, is not relevant here.)
31135
31136 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
31137 of the file:
31138
31139 @example
31140 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
31141 @end example
31142
31143 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
31144 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
31145 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
31146 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
31147 formulas in the file.
31148
31149 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
31150 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
31151 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
31152 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
31153 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
31154
31155 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
31156 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
31157 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
31158 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
31159 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
31160 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
31161
31162 @example
31163 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31164 1.23e2
31165
31166 456.
31167 @end example
31168
31169 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
31170 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
31171
31172 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
31173 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
31174 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
31175 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
31176 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el})
31177 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
31178 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
31179 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
31180 annotations at all.
31181
31182 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
31183 for @code{Save} have no effect.
31184
31185 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31186 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
31187
31188 @noindent
31189 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
31190 variables described here. These variables are customizable
31191 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
31192 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
31193 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
31194 the end of the file;
31195 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
31196 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
31197 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
31198
31199 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
31200 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
31201 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
31202 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
31203 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
31204 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
31205 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
31206 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
31207 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
31208 in detail.
31209
31210 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
31211 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
31212 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
31213 Lisp program.
31214
31215 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
31216 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
31217 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
31218 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
31219 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
31220 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
31221 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
31222 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
31223
31224 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
31225 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
31226 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
31227 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
31228 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
31229 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
31230
31231 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
31232 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
31233 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
31234 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
31235 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
31236 one or two dollar signs.
31237
31238 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
31239 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
31240 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
31241
31242 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
31243 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
31244 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
31245 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
31246 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
31247 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
31248 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
31249
31250 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
31251 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
31252 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
31253 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
31254 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
31255 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
31256 account for each of these six backslashes!)
31257
31258 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
31259 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
31260 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
31261 regular expression to match the above example would be
31262 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
31263 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
31264 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
31265 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
31266 case).
31267
31268 @vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
31269 The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
31270 used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
31271 @kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
31272
31273 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
31274 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
31275 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
31276 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
31277 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
31278 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
31279 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
31280 be different for certain major modes.
31281
31282 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
31283 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
31284 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
31285 different for different major modes. Without
31286 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
31287 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
31288
31289 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
31290 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
31291 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
31292 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
31293 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
31294 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
31295 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
31296 the file.
31297
31298 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
31299 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
31300 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
31301 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
31302 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
31303 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
31304 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
31305
31306 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
31307 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
31308 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
31309 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
31310 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
31311 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
31312 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
31313 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
31314 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
31315 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
31316 different for different major modes.
31317 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
31318 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
31319 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
31320 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
31321
31322 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
31323 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
31324 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
31325 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
31326 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
31327 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
31328 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
31329 modes.
31330
31331 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
31332 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
31333 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
31334 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
31335 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
31336 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
31337
31338 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
31339 @chapter Programming
31340
31341 @noindent
31342 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
31343 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
31344
31345 @enumerate
31346 @item
31347 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
31348 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
31349 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
31350 as loops and conditionals.
31351
31352 @item
31353 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
31354 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
31355 as an interactive command.
31356
31357 @item
31358 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
31359 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
31360 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
31361 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
31362 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
31363
31364 @item
31365 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
31366 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
31367 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
31368 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
31369 rewrite rules.
31370 @end enumerate
31371
31372 @kindex z
31373 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
31374 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
31375 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
31376 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
31377 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
31378 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
31379 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
31380
31381 @menu
31382 * Creating User Keys::
31383 * Keyboard Macros::
31384 * Invocation Macros::
31385 * Algebraic Definitions::
31386 * Lisp Definitions::
31387 @end menu
31388
31389 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
31390 @section Creating User Keys
31391
31392 @noindent
31393 @kindex Z D
31394 @pindex calc-user-define
31395 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
31396 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
31397 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
31398
31399 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
31400 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
31401 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
31402 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
31403 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
31404 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
31405 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
31406 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
31407
31408 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
31409 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
31410
31411 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
31412 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
31413 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
31414
31415 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
31416 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
31417 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
31418 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
31419 of a letter if you wish.
31420
31421 @kindex Z U
31422 @pindex calc-user-undefine
31423 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
31424 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
31425 key we defined above.
31426
31427 @kindex Z P
31428 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
31429 @cindex Storing user definitions
31430 @cindex Permanent user definitions
31431 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
31432 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
31433 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
31434 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
31435 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
31436 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}.) For example,
31437 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
31438 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
31439 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
31440 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
31441
31442 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
31443 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
31444 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
31445 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
31446 command will save all of these definitions.
31447 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
31448 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
31449 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
31450 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
31451 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
31452 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
31453 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
31454 or key bindings associated with the function.)
31455
31456 @kindex Z E
31457 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
31458 @cindex Editing user definitions
31459 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
31460 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
31461 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
31462 following sections.
31463
31464 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
31465 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
31466
31467 @noindent
31468 @kindex X
31469 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
31470 @cindex Keyboard macros
31471 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
31472 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
31473 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
31474 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
31475 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
31476 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
31477 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
31478 information.
31479
31480 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
31481 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
31482 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
31483 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
31484 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
31485 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
31486 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
31487 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
31488 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
31489 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
31490 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
31491 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
31492 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
31493
31494 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31495 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31496 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31497 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31498
31499 @menu
31500 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
31501 * Conditionals in Macros::
31502 * Loops in Macros::
31503 * Local Values in Macros::
31504 * Queries in Macros::
31505 @end menu
31506
31507 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31508 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31509
31510 @noindent
31511 @kindex Z K
31512 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31513 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31514 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31515 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31516 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31517 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31518 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31519 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31520 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31521 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31522 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31523 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31524 descriptive command name if you wish.
31525
31526 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31527 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31528 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31529 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31530
31531 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31532 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31533
31534 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31535 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31536 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31537 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31538 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31539 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31540 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31541 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31542 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31543 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31544 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31545 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31546 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31547 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31548 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31549
31550 @kindex C-x * m
31551 @pindex read-kbd-macro
31552 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31553 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31554 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31555 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31556
31557 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31558 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31559
31560 @noindent
31561 @kindex Z [
31562 @kindex Z ]
31563 @pindex calc-kbd-if
31564 @pindex calc-kbd-else
31565 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31566 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31567 @cindex Conditional structures
31568 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31569 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31570 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31571 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31572 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31573 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31574 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31575
31576 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31577 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31578 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31579 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31580 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31581 command is skipped.
31582
31583 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31584 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31585 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31586 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31587 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31588 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31589
31590 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31591 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31592
31593 @kindex Z :
31594 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31595 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31596 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31597 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31598 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31599 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31600 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31601
31602 @kindex Z |
31603 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31604 between any number of alternatives. For example,
31605 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31606 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31607 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31608 it will execute @var{part3}.
31609
31610 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31611 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31612 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31613 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31614 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31615 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31616 does not.
31617
31618 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31619 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31620 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31621 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31622 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31623 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31624 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31625 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31626 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31627
31628 @kindex Z C-g
31629 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31630 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31631 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31632
31633 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31634 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31635
31636 @noindent
31637 @kindex Z <
31638 @kindex Z >
31639 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31640 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31641 @cindex Looping structures
31642 @cindex Iterative structures
31643 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31644 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31645 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31646 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31647 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31648 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31649 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31650 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31651 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31652
31653 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31654 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31655 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31656 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31657 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31658 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31659 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31660 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31661 macro.
31662
31663 @kindex Z /
31664 @pindex calc-break
31665 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31666 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31667 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31668 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31669 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31670 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31671 in the C language.
31672
31673 @kindex Z (
31674 @kindex Z )
31675 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31676 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31677 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31678 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31679 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31680 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31681 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31682 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31683 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31684 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31685 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31686
31687 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31688 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31689 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31690 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31691 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31692 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31693 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31694
31695 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31696 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31697 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31698 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31699 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31700 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31701
31702 @kindex Z @{
31703 @kindex Z @}
31704 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31705 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31706 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31707 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31708 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31709 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31710 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31711 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31712 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31713 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31714 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31715 this feature.)
31716
31717 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31718 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31719 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31720 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31721 as easily as in a macro definition.
31722
31723 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31724 conditional and looping commands.
31725
31726 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31727 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31728
31729 @noindent
31730 @cindex Local variables
31731 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31732 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31733 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31734 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31735 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31736 modes.
31737
31738 @kindex Z `
31739 @kindex Z '
31740 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31741 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31742 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31743 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31744 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31745 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31746
31747 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31748 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31749 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31750 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31751 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31752
31753 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31754 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31755 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31756 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31757 in exceptional conditions.
31758
31759 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31760 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31761 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31762 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31763 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31764 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31765 macros were involved.
31766
31767 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31768 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31769 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31770 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31771 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31772 thereof) are also saved.
31773
31774 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31775 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31776 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31777 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31778 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31779
31780 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31781 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31782 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31783 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31784 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31785 outside the construct.
31786
31787 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31788 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31789 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31790
31791 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31792 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31793
31794 @c @noindent
31795 @c @kindex Z =
31796 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31797 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31798 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31799 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31800 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31801 @c to turn such messages off.
31802
31803 @noindent
31804 @kindex Z #
31805 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31806 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31807 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31808 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31809 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31810 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31811 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31812 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31813 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31814 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31815 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31816 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31817
31818 As an example,
31819 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31820 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31821 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31822 will not be part of the macro.)
31823
31824 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31825 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31826 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31827 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31828 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31829 return control to the keyboard macro.
31830
31831 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31832 @section Invocation Macros
31833
31834 @kindex C-x * z
31835 @kindex Z I
31836 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31837 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31838 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31839 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31840 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31841 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31842 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31843 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31844 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31845 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31846
31847 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31848 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31849 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31850 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31851 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31852 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31853
31854 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31855 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31856 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31857 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31858 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31859
31860 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31861 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31862 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31863
31864 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31865 @section Programming with Formulas
31866
31867 @noindent
31868 @kindex Z F
31869 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31870 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31871 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31872 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31873 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31874 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31875 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31876 non-numeric arguments.
31877
31878 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31879 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31880 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31881 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31882 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31883 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31884 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31885
31886 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31887 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31888 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31889 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31890
31891 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31892 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31893 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31894 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31895 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31896 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31897 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31898 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31899 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31900
31901 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31902 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31903 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31904 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31905 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31906 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31907 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31908 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31909 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31910 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31911 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31912 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
31913
31914 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31915 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31916 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31917 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31918 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31919 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31920 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31921
31922 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31923 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31924 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31925 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31926
31927 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31928 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31929 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31930 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31931 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31932 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31933 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31934 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31935 question.
31936
31937 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31938 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31939 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31940 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31941
31942 @kindex Z G
31943 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
31944 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31945 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31946 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31947 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31948 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31949 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31950 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31951
31952 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31953 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31954 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31955 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31956 @kbd{C-x k} to
31957 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31958 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31959 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31960 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31961
31962 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31963 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31964 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31965
31966 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31967 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31968 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31969 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31970 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31971 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31972 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31973 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31974 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31975
31976 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31977 @section Programming with Lisp
31978
31979 @noindent
31980 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31981 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31982 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31983 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31984 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31985 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31986 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31987 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31988 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31989
31990 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31991 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31992 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31993 to program the Calculator.
31994
31995 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31996 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31997 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31998 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31999 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
32000
32001 @menu
32002 * Defining Functions::
32003 * Defining Simple Commands::
32004 * Defining Stack Commands::
32005 * Argument Qualifiers::
32006 * Example Definitions::
32007
32008 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
32009 * Internals::
32010 @end menu
32011
32012 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32013 @subsection Defining New Functions
32014
32015 @noindent
32016 @findex defmath
32017 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
32018 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
32019 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
32020 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
32021 example,
32022
32023 @example
32024 (defmath myfact (n)
32025 (if (> n 0)
32026 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32027 1))
32028 @end example
32029
32030 @noindent
32031 This actually expands to the code,
32032
32033 @example
32034 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32035 (if (math-posp n)
32036 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32037 1))
32038 @end example
32039
32040 @noindent
32041 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
32042
32043 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
32044 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
32045 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
32046 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
32047
32048 @smallexample
32049 (defmath myfact (n)
32050 (if (> n 0)
32051 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32052 (if (= n 0)
32053 1
32054 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
32055 @end smallexample
32056
32057 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
32058 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
32059 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
32060 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
32061 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
32062 efficiently as possible.
32063
32064 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
32065 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
32066 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
32067 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
32068 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
32069 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
32070
32071 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
32072 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
32073 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
32074 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
32075 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
32076 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
32077 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
32078
32079 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
32080 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
32081 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
32082 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
32083 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
32084
32085 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
32086
32087 @itemize @bullet
32088 @item
32089 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
32090 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
32091 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
32092 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
32093 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
32094
32095 @item
32096 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
32097 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
32098 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
32099 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
32100 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
32101 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
32102 into one element of a matrix.
32103
32104 @item
32105 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
32106 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
32107 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
32108 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
32109 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
32110 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
32111 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
32112 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
32113 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
32114 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
32115 things, not just two.
32116
32117 @item
32118 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
32119 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
32120 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
32121 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
32122 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
32123
32124 @item
32125 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
32126 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
32127 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
32128 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
32129
32130 @item
32131 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
32132 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
32133 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
32134 inside the body of the function.
32135 @end itemize
32136
32137 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
32138 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
32139 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
32140 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
32141 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
32142
32143 @smallexample
32144 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
32145 (and (numberp x)
32146 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
32147 @end smallexample
32148
32149 expands to
32150
32151 @smallexample
32152 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
32153 (and (math-numberp x)
32154 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
32155 @end smallexample
32156
32157 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
32158 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
32159 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
32160 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
32161 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
32162
32163 @example
32164 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
32165 @end example
32166
32167 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
32168 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
32169 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
32170 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
32171 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
32172 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
32173 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
32174 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
32175 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
32176 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
32177 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
32178
32179 @example
32180 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
32181 (defmath ... )
32182 (defmath ... )
32183 ))
32184 @end example
32185
32186 @noindent
32187 @vindex calc-define
32188 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
32189 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
32190 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
32191 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
32192 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
32193 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
32194 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
32195 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
32196 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
32197
32198 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
32199 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
32200 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
32201 after Calc itself is loaded.
32202
32203 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
32204 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
32205 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
32206 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
32207
32208 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
32209 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
32210 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
32211 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
32212 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
32213 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
32214 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
32215 protect against this situation, you can put
32216
32217 @example
32218 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32219 @end example
32220
32221 @findex calc-check-defines
32222 @noindent
32223 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
32224 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
32225 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
32226 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
32227
32228 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
32229 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
32230 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
32231 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
32232
32233 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
32234 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
32235
32236 @noindent
32237 @findex interactive
32238 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
32239 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
32240 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
32241 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
32242 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
32243 the command work in the Calc environment.
32244
32245 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
32246 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
32247
32248 @smallexample
32249 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32250 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
32251 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
32252 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32253 @end smallexample
32254
32255 This expands to the pair of definitions,
32256
32257 @smallexample
32258 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
32259 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32260 (interactive "p")
32261 (calc-wrapper
32262 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
32263
32264 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
32265 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32266 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
32267 @end smallexample
32268
32269 @noindent
32270 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
32271 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
32272 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
32273 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
32274
32275 @findex calc-wrapper
32276 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
32277 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
32278
32279 @smallexample
32280 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
32281 (unwind-protect
32282 (save-current-buffer
32283 (calc-select-buffer)
32284 @emph{body of function}
32285 @emph{renumber stack}
32286 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
32287 @emph{realign cursor and window}
32288 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
32289 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
32290 @end smallexample
32291
32292 @findex calc-select-buffer
32293 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
32294 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
32295 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
32296
32297 @findex calc-set-command-flag
32298 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
32299 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
32300 following command flags:
32301
32302 @table @code
32303 @item renum-stack
32304 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
32305 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
32306 @code{calc-push}.
32307
32308 @item clear-message
32309 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
32310 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
32311
32312 @item no-align
32313 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
32314
32315 @item position-point
32316 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
32317 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
32318 this command finishes.
32319
32320 @item keep-flags
32321 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
32322 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
32323
32324 @item do-edit
32325 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
32326
32327 @item hold-trail
32328 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
32329 there.
32330 @end table
32331
32332 @kindex Y
32333 @kindex Y ?
32334 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
32335 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
32336 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
32337 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
32338 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
32339 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
32340 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
32341 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
32342 future versions of Calc.
32343
32344 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
32345 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
32346 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
32347 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
32348 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
32349 within your package.
32350
32351 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
32352 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
32353 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
32354 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
32355 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
32356 if necessary without having to modify the file.
32357
32358 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
32359 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
32360 decreases the precision.
32361
32362 @smallexample
32363 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
32364 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
32365
32366 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
32367 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
32368
32369 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
32370
32371 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
32372 'increase-precision)
32373 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
32374 'decrease-precision)
32375
32376 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
32377 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
32378 calc-Y-help-msgs))
32379
32380 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32381 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32382 (interactive "p")
32383 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32384
32385 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
32386 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
32387 (interactive "p")
32388 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
32389
32390 )) ; end of calc-define property
32391
32392 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32393 @end smallexample
32394
32395 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
32396 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
32397
32398 @noindent
32399 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
32400 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
32401
32402 @example
32403 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
32404 @end example
32405
32406 @noindent
32407 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
32408 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
32409 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
32410 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
32411 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
32412 parameters is valid.
32413
32414 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
32415 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
32416 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
32417 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
32418 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
32419 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
32420
32421 As an example, the definition
32422
32423 @smallexample
32424 (defmath myfact (n)
32425 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32426 (interactive 1 "fact")
32427 (if (> n 0)
32428 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32429 (and (= n 0) 1)))
32430 @end smallexample
32431
32432 @noindent
32433 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
32434 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
32435
32436 @smallexample
32437 (defun calc-myfact ()
32438 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32439 (interactive)
32440 (calc-slow-wrapper
32441 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
32442 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
32443
32444 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32445 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32446 (if (math-posp n)
32447 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32448 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
32449 @end smallexample
32450
32451 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
32452 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
32453 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
32454 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
32455 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
32456
32457 @findex calc-top-list-n
32458 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
32459 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
32460 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
32461 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
32462
32463 @findex calc-enter-result
32464 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
32465 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
32466 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
32467 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
32468 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
32469 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
32470
32471 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
32472 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
32473 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
32474 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
32475 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
32476
32477 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
32478 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
32479 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
32480
32481 @example
32482 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
32483 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
32484 @var{body})
32485 @end example
32486
32487 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
32488 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
32489 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
32490
32491 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
32492 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
32493 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
32494 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32495 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32496
32497 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32498 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
32499
32500 @noindent
32501 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32502 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32503
32504 @example
32505 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32506 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32507 &rest @var{param})
32508 @var{body})
32509 @end example
32510
32511 @noindent
32512 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32513
32514 @example
32515 (@var{qual} @var{param})
32516 @end example
32517
32518 The following qualifiers are recognized:
32519
32520 @table @samp
32521 @item complete
32522 @findex complete
32523 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32524 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32525 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32526 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32527
32528 @item integer
32529 @findex integer
32530 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32531 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32532 formulas are rejected.
32533
32534 @item natnum
32535 @findex natnum
32536 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32537
32538 @item fixnum
32539 @findex fixnum
32540 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32541 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32542 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32543
32544 @item float
32545 @findex float
32546 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32547 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32548 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32549
32550 @item @var{pred}
32551 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32552 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32553
32554 @item not-@var{pred}
32555 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32556 @end table
32557
32558 For example,
32559
32560 @example
32561 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32562 &rest (integer d))
32563 @var{body})
32564 @end example
32565
32566 @noindent
32567 expands to
32568
32569 @example
32570 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32571 (and (math-matrixp b)
32572 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32573 (or (math-constp b)
32574 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32575 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32576 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32577 @var{body})
32578 @end example
32579
32580 @noindent
32581 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32582 body of the function.
32583
32584 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32585 @subsection Example Definitions
32586
32587 @noindent
32588 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32589 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32590 @pxref{Internals}.
32591
32592 @menu
32593 * Bit Counting Example::
32594 * Sine Example::
32595 @end menu
32596
32597 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32598 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
32599
32600 @noindent
32601 @ignore
32602 @starindex
32603 @end ignore
32604 @tindex bcount
32605 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32606 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32607 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32608 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32609 create an intermediate set.
32610
32611 @smallexample
32612 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32613 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32614 (let ((count 0))
32615 (while (> n 0)
32616 (if (oddp n)
32617 (setq count (1+ count)))
32618 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32619 count))
32620 @end smallexample
32621
32622 @noindent
32623 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32624 Emacs Lisp function:
32625
32626 @smallexample
32627 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32628 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32629 (let ((count 0))
32630 (while (math-posp n)
32631 (if (math-oddp n)
32632 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32633 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32634 count))
32635 @end smallexample
32636
32637 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32638 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32639 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32640 involve actual division.
32641
32642 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32643 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32644 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32645 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32646 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32647
32648 @smallexample
32649 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32650 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32651 (let ((count 0))
32652 (while (not (fixnump n))
32653 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32654 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32655 n (car qr))))
32656 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32657
32658 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32659 (let ((count 0))
32660 (while (> n 0)
32661 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32662 n (lsh n -1)))
32663 count))
32664 @end smallexample
32665
32666 @noindent
32667 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32668 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32669 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32670 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32671 uses.
32672
32673 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32674 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32675 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32676 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32677 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32678 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32679 same thing with a single division by 512.
32680
32681 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32682 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32683
32684 @noindent
32685 @ignore
32686 @starindex
32687 @end ignore
32688 @tindex mysin
32689 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32690 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32691 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32692 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32693
32694 @smallexample
32695 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32696 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32697 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32698 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32699 newsum
32700 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32701 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32702 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32703 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32704 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32705 x (* x xnegsqr)
32706 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32707 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32708 (break)) ; then we are done.
32709 (setq sum newsum))
32710 sum))
32711 @end smallexample
32712
32713 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32714 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32715 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32716 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32717 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32718 by a separate algorithm.
32719
32720 @smallexample
32721 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32722 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32723 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32724 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32725 (cond ((complexp x)
32726 (mysin-complex x))
32727 ((< x 0)
32728 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32729 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32730
32731 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32732 (cond ((>= x 7)
32733 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32734 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32735 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32736 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32737 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32738 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32739 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32740 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32741 @end smallexample
32742
32743 @noindent
32744 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32745 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32746 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32747 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32748
32749 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32750 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32751 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32752 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32753 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32754 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32755 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32756 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32757 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32758 that this rule misses.
32759
32760 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32761 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32762 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32763 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32764
32765 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32766 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32767
32768 @noindent
32769 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32770 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32771 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32772 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32773 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32774 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32775 much simpler to use!
32776
32777 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32778 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32779
32780 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32781 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32782 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32783
32784 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32785 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32786 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32787 loaded and initialized for you.
32788
32789 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32790 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32791
32792 @ifinfo
32793 @example
32794
32795 @end example
32796 @end ifinfo
32797 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32798
32799 @noindent
32800 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32801 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32802 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32803 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32804
32805 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32806 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32807 one by one below.
32808
32809 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32810 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32811 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32812 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32813 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32814 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32815
32816 @ifinfo
32817 @example
32818
32819 @end example
32820 @end ifinfo
32821 @subsubsection Error Handling
32822
32823 @noindent
32824 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32825 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32826 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32827 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32828 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32829 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32830
32831 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32832 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32833 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32834 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32835
32836 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32837 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32838 ignored.
32839
32840 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32841 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32842 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32843
32844 @ifinfo
32845 @example
32846
32847 @end example
32848 @end ifinfo
32849 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32850
32851 @noindent
32852 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32853 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32854 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32855 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32856 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32857 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32858
32859 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32860 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32861 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32862
32863 @ifinfo
32864 @example
32865
32866 @end example
32867 @end ifinfo
32868 @subsubsection Default Modes
32869
32870 @noindent
32871 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32872 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32873 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32874 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32875 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32876 mode is used.
32877
32878 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32879 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32880 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32881
32882 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32883 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32884 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32885 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32886 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32887 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32888
32889 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32890 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32891 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32892 of the default of 12.
32893
32894 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32895 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32896 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32897 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32898 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32899
32900 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32901 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32902 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32903 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32904 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32905 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32906
32907 @ifinfo
32908 @example
32909
32910 @end example
32911 @end ifinfo
32912 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
32913
32914 @noindent
32915 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32916 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32917 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32918 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32919 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32920
32921 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32922 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32923 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32924 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32925 structure.
32926
32927 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32928 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32929 an error if that object is not a constant).
32930
32931 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32932 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32933 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32934 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32935 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32936 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32937
32938 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32939 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32940 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32941 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32942
32943 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32944 to format it as a string.
32945
32946 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32947 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32948 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32949
32950 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32951 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32952 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32953
32954 @ifinfo
32955 @example
32956
32957 @end example
32958 @end ifinfo
32959 @subsubsection Predicates
32960
32961 @noindent
32962 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32963 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32964 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32965 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32966
32967 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32968 one value is less than another.
32969
32970 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32971 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32972 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32973 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32974 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32975
32976 @ifinfo
32977 @example
32978
32979 @end example
32980 @end ifinfo
32981 @subsubsection Variable Values
32982
32983 @noindent
32984 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32985 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32986 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32987 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32988 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32989 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32990 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32991
32992 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32993 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32994 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32995 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32996 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32997 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32998
32999 @example
33000 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
33001 @end example
33002
33003 @ifinfo
33004 @example
33005
33006 @end example
33007 @end ifinfo
33008 @subsubsection Stack Access
33009
33010 @noindent
33011 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
33012 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
33013 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
33014 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
33015 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
33016 usual way).
33017
33018 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
33019 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
33020 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
33021 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
33022 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
33023 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
33024 the stack.
33025
33026 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
33027 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
33028 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
33029 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
33030 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
33031
33032 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
33033 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
33034 as a string.
33035
33036 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
33037 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
33038 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
33039 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
33040 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
33041 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
33042
33043 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
33044 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
33045 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
33046
33047 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
33048 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
33049 the stack buffer if necessary.
33050
33051 @ifinfo
33052 @example
33053
33054 @end example
33055 @end ifinfo
33056 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
33057
33058 @noindent
33059 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
33060 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
33061 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
33062 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
33063 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
33064 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
33065 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
33066
33067 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
33068 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
33069 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
33070 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
33071 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
33072
33073 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
33074 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
33075 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
33076
33077 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
33078
33079 @ifinfo
33080 @example
33081
33082 @end example
33083 @end ifinfo
33084 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
33085
33086 @noindent
33087 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
33088 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
33089 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
33090 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
33091 @code{calc-eval}.
33092
33093 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
33094 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
33095 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
33096 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
33097
33098 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
33099 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
33100 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
33101 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
33102 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
33103 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
33104 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
33105 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
33106 your original buffer when it is done.
33107
33108 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
33109 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
33110
33111 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
33112 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
33113
33114 @ifinfo
33115 @example
33116
33117 @end example
33118 @end ifinfo
33119 @subsubsection Example
33120
33121 @noindent
33122 @findex convert-temp
33123 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
33124 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
33125 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
33126 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
33127 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
33128 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
33129 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
33130
33131 @example
33132 (defun convert-temp ()
33133 (interactive)
33134 (save-excursion
33135 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
33136 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
33137 (bot1 (match-end 1))
33138 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
33139 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
33140 (bot2 (match-end 2))
33141 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
33142 (if (equal type "F")
33143 (setq type "C"
33144 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
33145 (setq type "F"
33146 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
33147 (goto-char top2)
33148 (delete-region top2 bot2)
33149 (insert-before-markers type)
33150 (goto-char top1)
33151 (delete-region top1 bot1)
33152 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
33153 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
33154 (insert number))))
33155 @end example
33156
33157 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
33158 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
33159 instead of after it.
33160
33161 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
33162 @subsection Calculator Internals
33163
33164 @noindent
33165 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
33166 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
33167 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
33168 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
33169 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
33170 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
33171 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
33172 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
33173
33174 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
33175 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
33176 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
33177 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
33178 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
33179 in the remaining component files.
33180
33181 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
33182 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
33183 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
33184 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
33185 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
33186 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
33187 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
33188 prove this file will already be loaded.
33189
33190 @menu
33191 * Data Type Formats::
33192 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
33193 * Stack Lisp Functions::
33194 * Predicates::
33195 * Computational Lisp Functions::
33196 * Vector Lisp Functions::
33197 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
33198 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
33199 * Hooks::
33200 @end menu
33201
33202 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
33203 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
33204
33205 @noindent
33206 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
33207 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
33208 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
33209 which is not a Lisp list.
33210
33211 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
33212 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
33213 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
33214 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
33215 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
33216 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
33217 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
33218
33219 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
33220 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
33221 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
33222 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
33223 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
33224 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
33225
33226 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
33227 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
33228 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
33229 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
33230 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
33231 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
33232
33233 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
33234 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
33235 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
33236 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
33237 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
33238 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
33239 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
33240 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
33241 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
33242 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
33243
33244 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
33245 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
33246 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
33247 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
33248 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
33249
33250 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
33251 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
33252 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
33253 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
33254 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
33255 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
33256 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
33257 negative real number.)
33258
33259 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
33260 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
33261 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
33262 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
33263 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
33264
33265 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
33266 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
33267 January 1, 1 AD@. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
33268 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
33269
33270 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
33271 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
33272 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
33273
33274 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
33275 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
33276 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
33277 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
33278 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
33279 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
33280
33281 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
33282 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
33283 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
33284 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
33285 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
33286 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
33287 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
33288 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
33289 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
33290 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
33291
33292 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
33293 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
33294 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
33295 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
33296 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
33297 generally unused by Calc data structures.
33298
33299 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
33300 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
33301 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
33302 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
33303 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
33304 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
33305 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
33306 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
33307 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
33308 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
33309 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
33310 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
33311 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
33312 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
33313 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
33314 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
33315 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
33316 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
33317 the variable is used.
33318
33319 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
33320 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
33321 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
33322 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
33323 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
33324 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
33325 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
33326 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
33327 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
33328 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
33329 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
33330 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
33331 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
33332 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
33333 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
33334 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
33335 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
33336 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
33337 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
33338
33339 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
33340 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
33341
33342 @noindent
33343 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
33344 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
33345 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
33346 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
33347
33348 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
33349 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
33350 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
33351 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
33352 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
33353 @end defun
33354
33355 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
33356 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
33357 remove it from that list.
33358 @end defun
33359
33360 @defun calc-record-undo rec
33361 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
33362 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
33363 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
33364 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
33365 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
33366 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
33367 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
33368 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
33369 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
33370 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
33371 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
33372 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
33373 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
33374 @end defun
33375
33376 @defun calc-record-why msg args
33377 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
33378 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
33379 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
33380 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
33381 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
33382 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
33383 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
33384 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
33385 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
33386 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
33387 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
33388 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
33389 @end defun
33390
33391 @defun calc-is-inverse
33392 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
33393 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
33394 @end defun
33395
33396 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
33397 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
33398 @end defun
33399
33400 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
33401 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
33402
33403 @noindent
33404 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
33405 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
33406
33407 @defun calc-push-list vals n
33408 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
33409 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
33410 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
33411 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
33412 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
33413 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
33414 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
33415 is an empty list, nothing happens.
33416
33417 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
33418 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
33419 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
33420 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
33421 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
33422 @end defun
33423
33424 @defun calc-top-list n m
33425 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
33426 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
33427 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
33428 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
33429 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
33430 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
33431 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
33432 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
33433 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
33434 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
33435
33436 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
33437 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
33438 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
33439 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
33440 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
33441 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
33442 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
33443 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
33444 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
33445 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
33446 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
33447 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
33448 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
33449 @end defun
33450
33451 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
33452 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
33453 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
33454 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
33455
33456 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
33457 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
33458 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
33459 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
33460 contain selections.
33461 @end defun
33462
33463 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
33464 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
33465 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
33466 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
33467 will be used.
33468 @end defun
33469
33470 @defun calc-normalize n
33471 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
33472 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
33473 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
33474 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
33475 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
33476 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
33477 @end defun
33478
33479 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
33480 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
33481 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
33482 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
33483 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
33484 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
33485 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
33486 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
33487 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
33488 @code{calc-top-list}.
33489 @end defun
33490
33491 @defun calc-top-n m
33492 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
33493 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
33494 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33495 @end defun
33496
33497 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33498 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33499 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33500 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33501 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33502 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33503 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33504
33505 @smallexample
33506 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33507 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33508 @end smallexample
33509
33510 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33511 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33512 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33513 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33514 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33515 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33516 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33517 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33518 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33519 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33520 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33521 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33522 are present.
33523 @end defun
33524
33525 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33526 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33527 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33528 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33529 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33530 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33531
33532 @smallexample
33533 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
33534 (interactive "P")
33535 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33536 @end smallexample
33537 @end defun
33538
33539 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33540 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33541 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33542 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33543 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33544 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33545 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33546 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33547 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33548 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33549 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33550 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33551 top element.
33552 @end defun
33553
33554 @defun calc-stack-size
33555 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33556 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33557 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33558 @end defun
33559
33560 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33561 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33562 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33563 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33564 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33565 line number, not the stack entry itself.
33566 @end defun
33567
33568 @defun calc-substack-height n
33569 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33570 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33571 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33572 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33573 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33574 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33575 entries.)
33576 @end defun
33577
33578 @defun calc-refresh
33579 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33580 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33581 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33582 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33583 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33584 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33585 @end defun
33586
33587 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33588 @subsubsection Predicates
33589
33590 @noindent
33591 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33592 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33593 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33594 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33595 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33596 the full range of Calc data types.
33597
33598 @defun zerop x
33599 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33600 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33601 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33602 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33603 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33604 @end defun
33605
33606 @defun negp x
33607 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33608 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33609 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33610 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33611 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33612 @end defun
33613
33614 @defun posp x
33615 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33616 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33617 @end defun
33618
33619 @defun looks-negp x
33620 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33621 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33622 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33623 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33624 @end defun
33625
33626 @defun integerp x
33627 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33628 @end defun
33629
33630 @defun fixnump x
33631 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33632 @end defun
33633
33634 @defun natnump x
33635 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33636 @end defun
33637
33638 @defun fixnatnump x
33639 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33640 @end defun
33641
33642 @defun num-integerp x
33643 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33644 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33645 the decimal point.
33646 @end defun
33647
33648 @defun messy-integerp x
33649 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33650 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33651 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33652 @end defun
33653
33654 @defun num-natnump x
33655 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33656 @end defun
33657
33658 @defun evenp x
33659 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33660 @end defun
33661
33662 @defun looks-evenp x
33663 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33664 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33665 @end defun
33666
33667 @defun oddp x
33668 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33669 @end defun
33670
33671 @defun ratp x
33672 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33673 fraction.
33674 @end defun
33675
33676 @defun realp x
33677 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33678 or floating-point number.
33679 @end defun
33680
33681 @defun anglep x
33682 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33683 @end defun
33684
33685 @defun floatp x
33686 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33687 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33688 is a float.
33689 @end defun
33690
33691 @defun complexp x
33692 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33693 (but not a real number).
33694 @end defun
33695
33696 @defun rect-complexp x
33697 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33698 @end defun
33699
33700 @defun polar-complexp x
33701 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33702 @end defun
33703
33704 @defun numberp x
33705 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33706 @end defun
33707
33708 @defun scalarp x
33709 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33710 @end defun
33711
33712 @defun vectorp x
33713 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33714 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33715 @end defun
33716
33717 @defun numvecp x
33718 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33719 @end defun
33720
33721 @defun matrixp x
33722 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33723 all of the same size.
33724 @end defun
33725
33726 @defun square-matrixp x
33727 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33728 @end defun
33729
33730 @defun objectp x
33731 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33732 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33733 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33734 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33735 @end defun
33736
33737 @defun objvecp x
33738 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33739 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33740 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33741 @end defun
33742
33743 @defun primp x
33744 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33745 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33746 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33747 and intervals.
33748 @end defun
33749
33750 @defun constp x
33751 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33752 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33753 components are @code{constp}.
33754 @end defun
33755
33756 @defun lessp x y
33757 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33758 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33759 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33760 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33761 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33762 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33763 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33764 @end defun
33765
33766 @defun beforep x y
33767 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33768 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33769 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33770 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33771 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33772 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33773 by Calc's algebraic simplifications to put the terms of a product into
33774 canonical order: This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to
33775 @samp{2 x y}.
33776 @end defun
33777
33778 @defun equal x y
33779 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33780 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33781 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33782 0 and 0.0 as different.
33783 @end defun
33784
33785 @defun math-equal x y
33786 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33787 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33788 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33789 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33790 @end defun
33791
33792 @defun equal-int x n
33793 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33794 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33795 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33796 whenever possible.
33797 @end defun
33798
33799 @defun nearly-equal x y
33800 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33801 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33802 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33803 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33804 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33805 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33806 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33807 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33808 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33809 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33810 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33811 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33812 @end defun
33813
33814 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33815 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33816 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33817 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33818 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33819 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33820 @var{y} must be real.
33821 @end defun
33822
33823 @defun is-true x
33824 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33825 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33826 or a provably non-zero formula.
33827 @end defun
33828
33829 @defun reject-arg val pred
33830 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33831 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33832 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33833 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33834 @end defun
33835
33836 @defun inexact-value
33837 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33838 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33839 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33840 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33841 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33842 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33843 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33844 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33845 @end defun
33846
33847 @defun overflow
33848 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33849 @end defun
33850
33851 @defun underflow
33852 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33853 @end defun
33854
33855 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33856 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33857
33858 @noindent
33859 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33860 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33861 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33862 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33863 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33864 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33865 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33866
33867 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33868 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33869 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33870 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33871 respectively, instead.
33872
33873 @defun normalize val
33874 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33875 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33876 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33877 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33878 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33879 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33880 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33881 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33882 return 6.
33883
33884 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33885 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33886 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33887 the formula still in symbolic form.
33888
33889 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33890 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33891 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33892 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33893 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33894 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33895 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33896 on the stack.
33897 @end defun
33898
33899 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33900 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33901 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33902 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33903 @end defun
33904
33905 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
33906 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33907 digits. This is a macro which expands to
33908
33909 @smallexample
33910 (math-normalize
33911 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33912 @var{body}))
33913 @end smallexample
33914
33915 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33916 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33917 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33918 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33919 @end defmac
33920
33921 @defun make-frac n d
33922 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33923 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33924 @end defun
33925
33926 @defun make-float mant exp
33927 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33928 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33929 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33930 if @var{exp} is out of range.
33931 @end defun
33932
33933 @defun make-sdev x sigma
33934 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33935 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33936 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33937 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33938 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33939 @end defun
33940
33941 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
33942 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33943 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33944 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33945 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33946 @end defun
33947
33948 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33949 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33950 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33951 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33952 @end defun
33953
33954 @defun make-mod n m
33955 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33956 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33957 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33958 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33959 @end defun
33960
33961 @defun float x
33962 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33963 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33964 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33965 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33966 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33967 @end defun
33968
33969 @defun compare x y
33970 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33971 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
33972 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33973 undefined or cannot be determined.
33974 @end defun
33975
33976 @defun numdigs n
33977 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33978 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33979 considered to have zero digits.
33980 @end defun
33981
33982 @defun scale-int x n
33983 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33984 digits with truncation toward zero.
33985 @end defun
33986
33987 @defun scale-rounding x n
33988 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33989 integer rather than truncating.
33990 @end defun
33991
33992 @defun fixnum n
33993 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33994 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
33995 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33996 @end defun
33997
33998 @defun sqr x
33999 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
34000 @end defun
34001
34002 @defun quotient x y
34003 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
34004 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
34005 direction of rounding is undefined.
34006 @end defun
34007
34008 @defun idiv x y
34009 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
34010 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
34011 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
34012 slower than for @code{quotient}.
34013 @end defun
34014
34015 @defun imod x y
34016 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
34017 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
34018 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
34019 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
34020 @end defun
34021
34022 @defun idivmod x y
34023 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
34024 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
34025 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
34026 @end defun
34027
34028 @defun pow x y
34029 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
34030 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
34031 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
34032 @end defun
34033
34034 @defun abs-approx x
34035 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
34036 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
34037 the absolute values of the components.
34038 @end defun
34039
34040 @findex e
34041 @findex gamma-const
34042 @findex ln-2
34043 @findex ln-10
34044 @findex phi
34045 @findex pi-over-2
34046 @findex pi-over-4
34047 @findex pi-over-180
34048 @findex sqrt-two-pi
34049 @findex sqrt-e
34050 @findex two-pi
34051 @defun pi
34052 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
34053 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
34054 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
34055 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
34056 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
34057 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
34058 first are essentially free.
34059 @end defun
34060
34061 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
34062 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
34063 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
34064 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
34065 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
34066 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
34067 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
34068 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
34069 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
34070 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
34071 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
34072 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
34073 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
34074 @end defmac
34075
34076 @findex half-circle
34077 @findex quarter-circle
34078 @defun full-circle symb
34079 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
34080 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
34081 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
34082 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
34083 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
34084 @end defun
34085
34086 @defun power-of-2 n
34087 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
34088 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
34089 particular @var{n} is expensive.
34090 @end defun
34091
34092 @defun integer-log2 n
34093 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
34094 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
34095 return @code{nil}.
34096 @end defun
34097
34098 @defun div-mod a b m
34099 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
34100 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
34101 @end defun
34102
34103 @defun pow-mod a b m
34104 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
34105 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
34106 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
34107 @end defun
34108
34109 @defun isqrt n
34110 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
34111 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
34112 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
34113 @end defun
34114
34115 @defun to-hms a ang
34116 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
34117 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
34118 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
34119 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
34120 @end defun
34121
34122 @defun from-hms a ang
34123 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
34124 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
34125 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
34126 is returned as-is.
34127 @end defun
34128
34129 @defun to-radians a
34130 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
34131 angular mode.
34132 @end defun
34133
34134 @defun from-radians a
34135 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
34136 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
34137 @end defun
34138
34139 @defun to-radians-2 a
34140 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
34141 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
34142 @end defun
34143
34144 @defun from-radians-2 a
34145 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
34146 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
34147 @end defun
34148
34149 @defun random-digit
34150 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
34151 @end defun
34152
34153 @defun random-digits n
34154 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
34155 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
34156 @end defun
34157
34158 @defun random-float
34159 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
34160 @end defun
34161
34162 @defun prime-test n iters
34163 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
34164 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
34165 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
34166 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
34167 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
34168 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
34169 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
34170 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
34171 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
34172 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
34173 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
34174 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
34175 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
34176 @end defun
34177
34178 @defun to-simple-fraction f
34179 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
34180 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
34181 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
34182 fast.
34183 @end defun
34184
34185 @defun to-fraction f tol
34186 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
34187 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
34188 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
34189 @end defun
34190
34191 @defun quarter-integer n
34192 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
34193 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
34194 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
34195 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
34196 returns @code{nil}.
34197 @end defun
34198
34199 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
34200 @subsubsection Vector Functions
34201
34202 @noindent
34203 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
34204 matrices.
34205
34206 @defun math-concat x y
34207 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
34208 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
34209 @end defun
34210
34211 @defun vec-length v
34212 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
34213 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
34214 rows in the matrix.
34215 @end defun
34216
34217 @defun mat-dimens m
34218 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
34219 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
34220 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
34221 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
34222 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
34223 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
34224 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
34225 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
34226 elements.
34227 @end defun
34228
34229 @defun dimension-error
34230 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
34231 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
34232 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
34233 @end defun
34234
34235 @defun build-vector args
34236 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
34237 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
34238 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
34239 @end defun
34240
34241 @defun make-vec obj dims
34242 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
34243 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
34244 filled with 27's.
34245 @end defun
34246
34247 @defun row-matrix v
34248 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
34249 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
34250 leave it alone.
34251 @end defun
34252
34253 @defun col-matrix v
34254 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
34255 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
34256 already a matrix, leave it alone.
34257 @end defun
34258
34259 @defun map-vec f v
34260 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
34261 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
34262 of vector @var{v}.
34263 @end defun
34264
34265 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
34266 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
34267 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
34268 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
34269 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
34270 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
34271 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
34272 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
34273 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
34274 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
34275 @end defun
34276
34277 @defun reduce-vec f v
34278 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
34279 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
34280 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
34281 @end defun
34282
34283 @defun reduce-cols f m
34284 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
34285 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
34286 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
34287 @end defun
34288
34289 @defun mat-row m n
34290 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
34291 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
34292 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
34293 @end defun
34294
34295 @defun mat-col m n
34296 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
34297 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
34298 @end defun
34299
34300 @defun mat-less-row m n
34301 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
34302 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
34303 @end defun
34304
34305 @defun mat-less-col m n
34306 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
34307 @end defun
34308
34309 @defun transpose m
34310 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
34311 @end defun
34312
34313 @defun flatten-vector v
34314 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
34315 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
34316 @end defun
34317
34318 @defun copy-matrix m
34319 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
34320 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
34321 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
34322 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
34323 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
34324 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
34325 @end defun
34326
34327 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
34328 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
34329 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
34330 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
34331 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
34332 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
34333 @var{m}.
34334 @end defun
34335
34336 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
34337 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
34338
34339 @noindent
34340 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
34341 Calculator.
34342
34343 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
34344 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
34345 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
34346 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
34347 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
34348 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
34349 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
34350 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
34351 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
34352 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
34353 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
34354 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
34355 their corresponding sub-formulas.
34356
34357 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
34358 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
34359 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
34360 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
34361 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
34362 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
34363 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
34364 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
34365 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
34366 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
34367 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
34368 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
34369 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
34370 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
34371 @end defun
34372
34373 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
34374 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
34375 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
34376 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
34377 the formula in-place.
34378 @end defun
34379
34380 @defun calc-find-selected-part
34381 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
34382 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
34383 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
34384 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
34385 @end defun
34386
34387 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
34388 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
34389 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
34390 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
34391 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
34392 to reflect the new selection.
34393 @end defun
34394
34395 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
34396 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
34397 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
34398 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
34399 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
34400 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
34401 @end defun
34402
34403 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
34404 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
34405 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
34406 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
34407 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
34408 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
34409 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
34410 This function does not take associativity into account.
34411 @end defun
34412
34413 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
34414 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
34415 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
34416 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
34417 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
34418 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
34419 return the whole expression.
34420 @end defun
34421
34422 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
34423 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
34424 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
34425 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
34426 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
34427 @end defun
34428
34429 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
34430 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
34431 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
34432 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
34433 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
34434 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
34435 function does not take associativity into account.
34436 @end defun
34437
34438 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
34439 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
34440 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
34441 @end defun
34442
34443 @defun simplify expr
34444 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying Calc's algebraic
34445 simplifications. This always returns a copy of the expression; the
34446 structure @var{expr} points to remains unchanged in memory.
34447
34448 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
34449 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
34450 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
34451 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
34452 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
34453 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
34454 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
34455 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
34456 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
34457 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
34458 needed: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
34459 further simplifications were possible.
34460 @end defun
34461
34462 @defun simplify-extended expr
34463 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
34464 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
34465 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
34466 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
34467 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
34468 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
34469 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
34470 before taking any action.
34471 @end defun
34472
34473 @defun simplify-units expr
34474 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
34475 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
34476 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
34477 @end defun
34478
34479 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
34480 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
34481 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
34482 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
34483 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
34484 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
34485 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
34486 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
34487 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
34488 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
34489 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
34490 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
34491 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
34492 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
34493
34494 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34495 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34496 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34497 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34498 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34499
34500 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34501 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34502 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34503 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34504
34505 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34506 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34507 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34508 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34509 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34510
34511 @smallexample
34512 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34513 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34514 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34515 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34516 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34517 (or math-living-dangerously
34518 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34519 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34520 @end smallexample
34521
34522 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34523 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34524 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34525 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34526 @end defmac
34527
34528 @defun common-constant-factor expr
34529 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34530 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34531 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
34532 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
34533 @end defun
34534
34535 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34536 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34537 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34538 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34539 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34540 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34541 square roots:
34542
34543 @smallexample
34544 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34545 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34546 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34547 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34548 (math-normalize
34549 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34550 (math-cancel-common-factor
34551 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34552 @end smallexample
34553 @end defun
34554
34555 @defun frac-gcd a b
34556 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34557 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34558 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34559 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34560 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34561 @end defun
34562
34563 @defun map-tree func expr many
34564 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34565 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34566 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34567 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34568 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34569 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34570 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34571 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34572 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34573 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34574 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34575 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34576 @end defun
34577
34578 @defun compile-rewrites rules
34579 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34580 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34581 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34582 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34583 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34584 message.
34585 @end defun
34586
34587 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34588 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34589 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34590 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34591 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34592 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34593 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34594 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34595 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34596 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34597 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34598 @end defun
34599
34600 @defun rewrite-heads expr
34601 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34602 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34603 @end defun
34604
34605 @defun rewrite expr rules many
34606 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34607 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34608 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34609 times.
34610 @end defun
34611
34612 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34613 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34614 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34615 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34616 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34617 @end defun
34618
34619 @defun deriv expr var value symb
34620 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34621 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34622 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34623 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34624 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34625 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34626 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of nondifferentiable
34627 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34628 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34629
34630 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34631 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34632 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34633 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34634 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34635 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34636 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34637 is defined by
34638
34639 @smallexample
34640 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34641 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34642 @end smallexample
34643
34644 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34645 @smallexample
34646 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34647 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34648 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34649 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34650 @end smallexample
34651 @end defun
34652
34653 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34654 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34655 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34656 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34657 @end defun
34658
34659 @defun integ expr var low high
34660 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34661 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34662 @end defun
34663
34664 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34665 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34666 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34667 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34668 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34669 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34670 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34671 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34672 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34673 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34674 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34675
34676 @smallexample
34677 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34678 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34679 (and int
34680 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34681
34682 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34683 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34684 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34685 @end smallexample
34686
34687 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34688 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34689 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34690 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34691 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34692 result.
34693 @end defmac
34694
34695 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34696 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34697 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34698 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34699 @var{v}.
34700 @end defmac
34701
34702 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34703 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34704 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34705 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34706 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34707 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34708 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34709 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34710 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34711 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34712 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34713
34714 @smallexample
34715 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34716 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34717 @end smallexample
34718
34719 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34720 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34721 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34722 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34723 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34724 @end defun
34725
34726 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34727 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34728 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34729 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34730 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34731 @end defun
34732
34733 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34734 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34735 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34736 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34737 @end defun
34738
34739 @defun expr-contains expr var
34740 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34741 of @var{expr}.
34742
34743 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34744 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34745 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34746 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34747 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34748 @code{eq} to each other.
34749 @end defun
34750
34751 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34752 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34753 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34754 @end defun
34755
34756 @defun expr-depends expr var
34757 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34758 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34759 in common.
34760 @end defun
34761
34762 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34763 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34764 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34765 @end defun
34766
34767 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34768 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34769 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34770 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34771 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34772 @end defun
34773
34774 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34775 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34776 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34777 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34778 are ignored.
34779 @end defun
34780
34781 @defun expr-weight expr
34782 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34783 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34784 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34785 @end defun
34786
34787 @defun expr-height expr
34788 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34789 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34790 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34791 @end defun
34792
34793 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34794 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34795 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34796 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34797 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34798 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34799 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34800 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34801 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34802 a polynomial of degree 0.
34803 @end defun
34804
34805 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34806 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34807 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34808 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34809 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34810 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34811 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34812 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34813 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34814 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34815 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34816 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34817 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34818 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34819 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34820 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34821 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34822 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34823 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34824 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34825 @end defun
34826
34827 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34828 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34829 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34830 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34831 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34832 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34833 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34834 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34835 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34836 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34837 is found.
34838 @end defun
34839
34840 @defun poly-simplify poly
34841 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34842 clipping off trailing zeros.
34843 @end defun
34844
34845 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34846 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34847 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34848 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34849 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34850 @end defun
34851
34852 @defun poly-mul a b
34853 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34854 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34855 @end defun
34856
34857 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34858 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34859 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34860 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34861 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34862 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34863 @end defun
34864
34865 @defun check-unit-name var
34866 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34867 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34868 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34869 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34870 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34871 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34872 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34873 @end defun
34874
34875 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34876 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34877 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34878 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34879 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34880 @end defun
34881
34882 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34883 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34884 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34885 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34886 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34887 @end defun
34888
34889 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34890 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34891 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34892 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34893 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34894 is an expression to substitute for it.
34895 @end defun
34896
34897 @defun remove-units expr
34898 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34899 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34900 @end defun
34901
34902 @defun extract-units expr
34903 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34904 by ones.
34905 @end defun
34906
34907 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34908 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34909
34910 @noindent
34911 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34912 Calc numbers and formulas.
34913
34914 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34915 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34916 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34917 @end defun
34918
34919 @defun read-number str
34920 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34921 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34922 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34923 @end defun
34924
34925 @defun read-expr str
34926 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34927 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34928 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34929 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34930 a string describing the problem.
34931 @end defun
34932
34933 @defun read-exprs str
34934 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34935 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34936 shown above is returned instead.
34937 @end defun
34938
34939 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34940 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34941 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34942 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34943 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34944 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34945 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34946 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34947 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34948 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34949 @code{calc-normalize} first.
34950
34951 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34952 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34953 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34954 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34955 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34956 that actually appeared in the input.
34957 @end defun
34958
34959 @defun format-number a
34960 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34961 @end defun
34962
34963 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
34964 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34965 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34966 This is a simple format designed
34967 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34968 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34969 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34970 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34971 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34972 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34973 @end defun
34974
34975 @defun format-nice-expr a width
34976 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34977 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34978 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34979 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34980 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34981 @end defun
34982
34983 @defun format-value a width
34984 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34985 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34986 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34987 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34988 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34989 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34990 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34991 window is used.
34992 @end defun
34993
34994 @defun compose-expr a prec
34995 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34996 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34997 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34998 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34999 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
35000 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
35001 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
35002 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
35003 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
35004 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
35005 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
35006 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
35007 normal function-call notation for that language.
35008 @end defun
35009
35010 @defun composition-to-string c w
35011 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
35012 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
35013 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
35014 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
35015 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
35016 @end defun
35017
35018 @defun comp-width c
35019 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
35020 @end defun
35021
35022 @defun comp-height c
35023 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
35024 @end defun
35025
35026 @defun comp-ascent c
35027 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
35028 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
35029 @end defun
35030
35031 @defun comp-descent c
35032 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
35033 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
35034 @end defun
35035
35036 @defun comp-first-char c
35037 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
35038 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
35039 return @code{nil}.
35040 @end defun
35041
35042 @defun comp-last-char c
35043 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
35044 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
35045 @end defun
35046
35047 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35048 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
35049 @comment
35050 @comment @noindent
35051 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
35052
35053 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35054 @subsubsection Hooks
35055
35056 @noindent
35057 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
35058 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
35059 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
35060 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
35061 other customization-related variables are also described here.
35062
35063 @defvar calc-load-hook
35064 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
35065 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
35066 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
35067 @end defvar
35068
35069 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
35070 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
35071 @end defvar
35072
35073 @defvar calc-start-hook
35074 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
35075 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
35076 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
35077 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
35078 @end defvar
35079
35080 @defvar calc-mode-hook
35081 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
35082 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
35083 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
35084 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
35085 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
35086 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
35087 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
35088 been evaluated yet.
35089 @end defvar
35090
35091 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
35092 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
35093 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
35094 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
35095 per Emacs session.
35096 @end defvar
35097
35098 @defvar calc-end-hook
35099 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
35100 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
35101 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
35102 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
35103 @end defvar
35104
35105 @defvar calc-window-hook
35106 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
35107 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
35108 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
35109 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
35110 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
35111 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
35112 @end defvar
35113
35114 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
35115 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
35116 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
35117 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
35118 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
35119 @end defvar
35120
35121 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
35122 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
35123 @end defvar
35124
35125 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
35126 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
35127 new buffer.
35128 @end defvar
35129
35130 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
35131 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
35132 new formula.
35133 @end defvar
35134
35135 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
35136 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
35137 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
35138 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
35139 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
35140 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
35141 @code{calc-edit} command.)
35142 @end defvar
35143
35144 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
35145 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
35146 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
35147 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
35148 message is inserted.
35149 @end defvar
35150
35151 @defvar calc-reset-hook
35152 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
35153 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
35154 @end defvar
35155
35156 @defvar calc-other-modes
35157 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
35158 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
35159 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
35160 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
35161 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
35162 @end defvar
35163
35164 @defvar calc-mode-map
35165 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
35166 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
35167 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
35168 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
35169 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
35170 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
35171 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
35172 extensions are loaded.
35173 @end defvar
35174
35175 @defvar calc-digit-map
35176 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
35177 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
35178 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
35179 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
35180 @end defvar
35181
35182 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
35183 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
35184 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
35185 @end defvar
35186
35187 @defvar calc-store-var-map
35188 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
35189 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
35190 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
35191 @end defvar
35192
35193 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
35194 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
35195 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
35196 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
35197 @end defvar
35198
35199 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
35200 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
35201 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
35202 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
35203 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
35204 non-default variables are written out.
35205 @end defvar
35206
35207 @defvar calc-local-var-list
35208 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
35209 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
35210 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
35211 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
35212 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
35213 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
35214 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
35215 @end defvar
35216
35217 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
35218 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
35219 @include gpl.texi
35220
35221 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
35222 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
35223 @include doclicense.texi
35224
35225 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
35226 @appendix Customizing Calc
35227
35228 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
35229 to use a different prefix, you can put
35230
35231 @example
35232 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
35233 @end example
35234
35235 @noindent
35236 in your .emacs file.
35237 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
35238 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
35239 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
35240 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
35241 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
35242 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
35243 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
35244
35245 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
35246 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
35247 calculation and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
35248 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
35249 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
35250 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
35251 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
35252 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
35253 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
35254 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
35255
35256 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
35257 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
35258 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
35259 to see how regular expressions work.
35260
35261 @defvar calc-settings-file
35262 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
35263 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
35264 definitions.
35265 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
35266 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
35267 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
35268 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
35269
35270 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.emacs.d/calc.el"}
35271 unless the file @file{~/.calc.el} exists, in which case the default
35272 value will be @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
35273 @end defvar
35274
35275 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
35276 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
35277 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
35278 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
35279 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
35280 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
35281 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
35282 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
35283 @end defvar
35284
35285 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
35286 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
35287 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
35288 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
35289 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
35290 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
35291 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
35292 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
35293 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
35294 to display or print the output.
35295
35296 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
35297 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
35298 @code{"lp %s"}.
35299 @end defvar
35300
35301 @defvar calc-language-alist
35302 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
35303 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
35304 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
35305 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
35306 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
35307 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
35308 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
35309 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
35310 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
35311 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
35312 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
35313
35314 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
35315 @example
35316 ((latex-mode . latex)
35317 (tex-mode . tex)
35318 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
35319 (context-mode . tex)
35320 (nroff-mode . eqn)
35321 (pascal-mode . pascal)
35322 (c-mode . c)
35323 (c++-mode . c)
35324 (fortran-mode . fortran)
35325 (f90-mode . fortran))
35326 @end example
35327 @end defvar
35328
35329 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
35330 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
35331 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35332 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
35333 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
35334 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
35335 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
35336 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
35337 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
35338
35339 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
35340 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
35341 @samp{%} and a space.
35342
35343 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
35344 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
35345 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35346 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
35347 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35348 @example
35349 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
35350 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
35351 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
35352 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
35353 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35354 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35355 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
35356 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
35357 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35358 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35359 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
35360 @end example
35361 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35362 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35363 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35364 @end defvar
35365
35366 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
35367 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
35368 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
35369 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35370 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35371 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
35372 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
35373 They are regular expressions;
35374 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
35375 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
35376 delimiters''.
35377
35378 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
35379 Embedded mode understands by default are:
35380 @enumerate
35381 @item
35382 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
35383 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
35384 @item
35385 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
35386 @item
35387 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
35388 @item
35389 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
35390 @item
35391 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
35392 @end enumerate
35393
35394 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
35395 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35396 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
35397 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35398 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35399 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
35400 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35401 @code{nil}.
35402 @end defvar
35403
35404 @defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
35405 @defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
35406 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35407 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
35408 that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
35409 w}. It is a regular expressions.
35410
35411 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
35412 @code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
35413
35414 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
35415 set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
35416 expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35417 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35418 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35419 @code{nil}.
35420 @end defvar
35421
35422 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
35423 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
35424 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
35425 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35426 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35427 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
35428 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
35429 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
35430 buffer as well as to recognize them.
35431
35432 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
35433 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
35434 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
35435 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
35436 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
35437
35438 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
35439 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35440 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
35441 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35442 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35443 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
35444 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
35445 @example
35446 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
35447 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
35448 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
35449 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
35450 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35451 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35452 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
35453 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
35454 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35455 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35456 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
35457 @end example
35458 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35459 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35460 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35461 @end defvar
35462
35463 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
35464 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
35465 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
35466 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35467 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35468 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
35469 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
35470
35471 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
35472 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
35473 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
35474 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
35475 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
35476 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
35477 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
35478 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
35479 closing newline are omitted.)
35480
35481 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
35482 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35483 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
35484 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35485 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35486 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
35487 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
35488 @code{nil}.
35489 @end defvar
35490
35491 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
35492 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
35493 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
35494 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35495 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35496 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35497 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35498 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35499 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35500
35501 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35502 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35503 @code{"\n"}.
35504 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35505 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35506 lines by themselves.
35507
35508 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35509 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35510 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35511 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35512 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35513 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35514 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35515 @example
35516 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35517 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35518 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35519 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35520 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35521 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35522 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35523 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35524 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35525 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35526 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35527 @end example
35528 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35529 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35530 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35531 @end defvar
35532
35533 @defvar calc-lu-power-reference
35534 @defvarx calc-lu-field-reference
35535 See @ref{Logarithmic Units}.@*
35536 The variables @code{calc-lu-power-reference} and
35537 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} are unit expressions (written as
35538 strings) which Calc will use as reference quantities for logarithmic
35539 units.
35540
35541 The default value of @code{calc-lu-power-reference} is @code{"mW"}
35542 and the default value of @code{calc-lu-field-reference} is
35543 @code{"20 uPa"}.
35544 @end defvar
35545
35546 @defvar calc-note-threshold
35547 See @ref{Musical Notes}.@*
35548 The variable @code{calc-note-threshold} is a number (written as a
35549 string) which determines how close (in cents) a frequency needs to be
35550 to a note to be recognized as that note.
35551
35552 The default value of @code{calc-note-threshold} is 1.
35553 @end defvar
35554
35555 @defvar calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
35556 @defvarx calc-selected-face
35557 @defvarx calc-nonselected-face
35558 See @ref{Displaying Selections}.@*
35559 The variable @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces}
35560 determines how selected sub-formulas are distinguished.
35561 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is nil, then
35562 a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by changing every
35563 character not part of the sub-formula with a dot or by changing every
35564 character in the sub-formula with a @samp{#} sign.
35565 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is t,
35566 then a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by displaying the
35567 non-selected portion of the formula with @code{calc-nonselected-face}
35568 or by displaying the selected sub-formula with
35569 @code{calc-nonselected-face}.
35570 @end defvar
35571
35572 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35573 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
35574 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35575 formulas in normal language modes. If
35576 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35577 multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35578 right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35579 as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35580 @code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35581 (and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
35582 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35583 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35584 @end defvar
35585
35586 @defvar calc-ensure-consistent-units
35587 When converting units, the variable @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35588 determines whether or not the target units need to be consistent with the
35589 original units. If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is @code{nil}, then
35590 the target units don't need to have the same dimensions as the original units;
35591 for example, converting @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will produce @samp{30.48 m/s}.
35592 If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is non-@code{nil}, then the target units
35593 need to have the same dimensions as the original units; for example, converting
35594 @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will result in an error, since @samp{ft/s} and @samp{m}
35595 have different dimensions. The default value of @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35596 is @code{nil}.
35597 @end defvar
35598
35599 @defvar calc-undo-length
35600 The variable @code{calc-undo-length} determines the number of undo
35601 steps that Calc will keep track of when @code{calc-quit} is called.
35602 If @code{calc-undo-length} is a non-negative integer, then this is the
35603 number of undo steps that will be preserved; if
35604 @code{calc-undo-length} has any other value, then all undo steps will
35605 be preserved. The default value of @code{calc-undo-length} is @expr{100}.
35606 @end defvar
35607
35608 @defvar calc-gregorian-switch
35609 See @ref{Date Forms}.@*
35610 The variable @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is either a list of integers
35611 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} or @code{nil}.
35612 If it is @code{nil}, then Calc's date forms always represent Gregorian dates.
35613 Otherwise, @code{calc-gregorian-switch} represents the date that the
35614 calendar switches from Julian dates to Gregorian dates;
35615 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} will be the first Gregorian
35616 date. The customization buffer will offer several standard dates to
35617 choose from, or the user can enter their own date.
35618
35619 The default value of @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is @code{nil}.
35620 @end defvar
35621
35622 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35623 @appendix Reporting Bugs
35624
35625 @noindent
35626 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35627
35628 @example
35629 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35630 @end example
35631
35632 @noindent
35633 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35634 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35635 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35636 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35637 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35638 regular mailbox.
35639
35640 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35641 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35642 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35643 them right in.
35644
35645 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35646 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35647 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35648 so any efforts can be coordinated.
35649
35650 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35651 repository. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35652
35653 @c [summary]
35654 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35655 @appendix Calc Summary
35656
35657 @noindent
35658 This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
35659 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35660 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35661 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35662 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35663 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35664 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35665 command name refer to notes at the end.
35666
35667 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35668 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35669 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35670
35671 @iftex
35672 @begingroup
35673 @tex
35674 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35675 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35676 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35677 \leavevmode%
35678 {\smallfonts
35679 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35680 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35681 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35682 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35683 \thinspace%
35684 {\tt#5}%
35685 {\sl#6}%
35686 }}%
35687 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35688 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35689 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35690 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35691 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35692 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35693 @end tex
35694 @let@:=@sumsep
35695 @let@r=@sumrow
35696 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35697 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35698 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35699 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35700 @end iftex
35701 @format
35702 @iftex
35703 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35704 @let@c@sumbreak
35705 @end iftex
35706 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35707 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35708 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35709 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35710 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35711 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35712 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35713 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35714 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35715 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35716 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35717 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35718 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35719 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35720 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35721 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35722 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35723 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35724 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35725 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35726 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35727 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35728 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35729 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35730 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35731 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35732 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35733 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35734
35735 @c
35736 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35737 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35738 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35739 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35740 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35741 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35742 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35743 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35744 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35745
35746 @c
35747 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35748 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35749 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35750
35751 @c
35752 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35753 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35754 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35755 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35756 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35757 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35758 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35759 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35760 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35761 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35762 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35763 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35764 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35765 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35766 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35767 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35768 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35769
35770 @c
35771 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35772 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35773 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35774 @r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35775 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35776 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35777 @r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35778 @r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35779 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35780
35781 @c
35782 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35783 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35784 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35785 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35786 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35787 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35788 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35789
35790 @c
35791 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35792 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35793 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35794 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35795 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35796 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35797 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35798
35799 @c
35800 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35801 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35802 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35803 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35804 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35805 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35806
35807 @c
35808 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35809 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35810 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35811 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35812 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35813 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35814 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35815
35816 @c
35817 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35818 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35819 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35820 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35821 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35822 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35823 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35824 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35825 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35826 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35827 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35828 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35829 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35830 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35831 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35832 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35833 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35834 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35835 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35836 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35837 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35838 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35839 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35840 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35841 @r{ @: O @:command @: 32 @:@:Option}
35842 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35843 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35844 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35845 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35846 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35847 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35848 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35849 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35850 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35851 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35852 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35853 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35854 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35855 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35856 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35857 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35858 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35859 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35860 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35861 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35862
35863 @c
35864 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35865 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35866 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35867 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35868 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35869 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35870 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35871 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35872 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35873 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35874 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35875 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35876 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35877
35878 @c
35879 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35880 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35881 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35882 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35883
35884 @c
35885 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35886 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35887 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35888 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35889
35890 @c
35891 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35892 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35893 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35894 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35895 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35896 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35897 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35898 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35899 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35900 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35901 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35902 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
35903 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
35904 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
35905 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
35906 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
35907 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
35908 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
35909 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
35910 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
35911
35912 @c
35913 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35914 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35915 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35916 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
35917 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
35918 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
35919 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
35920 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
35921 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
35922 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
35923 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
35924 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
35925 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
35926 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
35927 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
35928 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
35929 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
35930 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
35931 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
35932
35933 @c
35934 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
35935 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
35936 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
35937 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35938 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35939 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
35940 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
35941 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
35942 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35943 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35944 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35945 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35946 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
35947 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
35948 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
35949
35950 @c
35951 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
35952 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
35953 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
35954 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35955 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35956 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35957 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35958 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35959 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35960 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35961 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35962 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35963 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35964 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35965 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35966 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35967 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35968 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35969 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35970 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35971 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35972 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35973 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35974
35975 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35976 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35977 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35978 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35979
35980 @c
35981 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35982 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35983 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35984 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35985 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35986 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35987 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35988 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35989 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35990 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35991 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35992
35993 @c
35994 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35995 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35996
35997 @c
35998 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35999
36000 @c
36001 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
36002 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
36003 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
36004 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
36005 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
36006 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
36007 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
36008 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
36009 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
36010 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
36011 @r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
36012 @r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
36013
36014 @c
36015 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
36016 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
36017 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
36018 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
36019
36020 @c
36021 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
36022 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
36023 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
36024 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
36025 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
36026 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
36027 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
36028 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
36029 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
36030 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
36031 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
36032 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
36033 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
36034 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
36035 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
36036 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
36037 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
36038 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
36039
36040 @c
36041 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
36042 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
36043 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
36044 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
36045 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
36046 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
36047 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
36048 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
36049 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
36050 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
36051 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
36052 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
36053
36054 @c
36055 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
36056 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
36057
36058 @c
36059 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
36060 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
36061 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
36062 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
36063 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
36064 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
36065 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
36066 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
36067 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
36068 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
36069 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
36070 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
36071
36072 @c
36073 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
36074 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
36075 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
36076 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
36077 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
36078 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
36079 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
36080 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
36081 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
36082 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
36083 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
36084 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
36085 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
36086 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
36087 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
36088 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
36089 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
36090
36091 @c
36092 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
36093 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
36094 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
36095 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
36096 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
36097 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
36098 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
36099 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
36100 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
36101 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
36102 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
36103 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
36104 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
36105 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
36106 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
36107 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
36108 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
36109 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
36110 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
36111
36112 @c
36113 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
36114 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
36115 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
36116 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
36117 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
36118 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
36119 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
36120 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
36121 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
36122 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
36123 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
36124 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
36125 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
36126 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
36127 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
36128 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
36129
36130 @c
36131 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
36132 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
36133 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
36134
36135 @c
36136 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
36137 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
36138 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
36139 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
36140 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
36141 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
36142 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
36143 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
36144 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
36145 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
36146
36147 @c
36148 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
36149 @r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
36150 @r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
36151 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
36152 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
36153 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
36154
36155 @c
36156 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
36157 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
36158 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
36159 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
36160 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
36161
36162 @c
36163 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
36164 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
36165 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
36166 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
36167 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
36168 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
36169 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
36170 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
36171 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
36172 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
36173 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
36174 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
36175 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
36176 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
36177
36178 @c
36179 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
36180 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
36181 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
36182 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
36183 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
36184 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
36185 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
36186 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
36187 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
36188 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
36189 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
36190 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
36191
36192 @c
36193 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
36194 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
36195 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
36196 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
36197 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
36198 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
36199 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
36200 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
36201 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
36202 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
36203 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
36204 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
36205 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
36206 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
36207 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
36208 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
36209 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
36210 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
36211 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
36212 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
36213
36214 @c
36215 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
36216 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
36217 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
36218 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
36219 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
36220 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36221 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36222 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
36223 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
36224 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
36225 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
36226 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
36227 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
36228
36229 @c
36230 @r{ a b@: l + @: @: @:lupadd@:(a,b)}
36231 @r{ a b@: H l + @: @: @:lufadd@:(a,b)}
36232 @r{ a b@: l - @: @: @:lupsub@:(a,b)}
36233 @r{ a b@: H l - @: @: @:lufsub@:(a,b)}
36234 @r{ a b@: l * @: @: @:lupmul@:(a,b)}
36235 @r{ a b@: H l * @: @: @:lufmul@:(a,b)}
36236 @r{ a b@: l / @: @: @:lupdiv@:(a,b)}
36237 @r{ a b@: H l / @: @: @:lufdiv@:(a,b)}
36238 @r{ a@: l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a)}
36239 @r{ a b@: O l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a,b)}
36240 @r{ a@: H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a)}
36241 @r{ a b@: O H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a,b)}
36242 @r{ a@: l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a)}
36243 @r{ a b@: O l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a,b)}
36244 @r{ a@: H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a)}
36245 @r{ a b@: O H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a,b)}
36246 @r{ a@: l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a)}
36247 @r{ a b@: O l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a,b)}
36248 @r{ a@: H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a)}
36249 @r{ a b@: O H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a,b)}
36250 @r{ a@: l s @: @: @:spn@:(a)}
36251 @r{ a@: l m @: @: @:midi@:(a)}
36252 @r{ a@: l f @: @: @:freq@:(a)}
36253
36254 @c
36255 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
36256 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
36257 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
36258 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
36259 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
36260 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
36261 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
36262 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
36263 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
36264 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
36265 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
36266 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
36267 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
36268 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
36269 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
36270
36271 @c
36272 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
36273 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
36274 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
36275 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
36276 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
36277 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
36278 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
36279 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
36280 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
36281 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
36282 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
36283
36284 @c
36285 @r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
36286 @r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
36287
36288 @c
36289 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
36290 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
36291 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
36292 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
36293 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
36294 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
36295 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
36296 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
36297 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
36298 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
36299 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
36300 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
36301 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
36302 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
36303 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
36304 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
36305 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
36306
36307 @c
36308 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
36309 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
36310 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
36311 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
36312 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
36313 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
36314 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
36315 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
36316 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
36317 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
36318 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
36319 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
36320 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
36321
36322 @c
36323 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
36324 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
36325 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
36326 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
36327 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
36328 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
36329 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
36330 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
36331 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
36332 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
36333 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
36334
36335 @c
36336 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
36337 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
36338 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
36339 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
36340 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
36341
36342 @c
36343 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
36344 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
36345 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
36346 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
36347 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
36348 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
36349 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
36350 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
36351 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
36352 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
36353 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
36354 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
36355 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
36356
36357 @c
36358 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36359 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36360 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
36361 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
36362 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
36363 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
36364 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
36365 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
36366 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
36367 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
36368 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
36369 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
36370 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
36371 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
36372 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
36373 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
36374 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
36375 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
36376 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
36377
36378 @c
36379 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
36380 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
36381
36382 @c
36383 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
36384 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
36385 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
36386 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
36387 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
36388 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
36389 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
36390 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
36391 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
36392 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
36393 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
36394 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
36395 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
36396 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
36397
36398 @c
36399 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
36400 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
36401 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
36402 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
36403 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
36404 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
36405 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
36406 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
36407 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
36408 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
36409 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
36410 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
36411 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
36412 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
36413 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
36414 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
36415
36416 @c
36417 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
36418 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
36419 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
36420
36421 @c
36422 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
36423 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
36424 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
36425 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
36426 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
36427 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
36428 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
36429 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
36430 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
36431 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
36432
36433 @c
36434 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
36435 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
36436 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
36437 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
36438 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
36439 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
36440
36441 @c
36442 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
36443
36444 @c
36445 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
36446 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
36447 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
36448 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
36449 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36450 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
36451 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
36452 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
36453 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
36454 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
36455 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
36456 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
36457 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
36458 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
36459 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
36460 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
36461 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
36462 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
36463 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
36464 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
36465 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
36466 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
36467 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
36468 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
36469 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36470 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
36471 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
36472 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
36473 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
36474 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
36475 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
36476 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
36477
36478 @c
36479 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
36480 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
36481 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
36482 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
36483 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
36484 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
36485 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
36486 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
36487 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
36488 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
36489 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
36490 @r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
36491 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
36492 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
36493 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
36494 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
36495 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
36496 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
36497 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
36498 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
36499 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
36500 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
36501 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
36502 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
36503 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
36504 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
36505 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
36506 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
36507 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
36508
36509 @c
36510 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
36511
36512 @c
36513 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
36514
36515 @c
36516 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
36517 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
36518 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
36519 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
36520
36521 @c
36522 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
36523 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
36524 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
36525 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
36526 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
36527 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
36528 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
36529
36530 @c
36531 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
36532
36533 @c
36534 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
36535 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
36536 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
36537
36538 @c
36539 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
36540 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
36541 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
36542 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
36543 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
36544 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
36545 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
36546 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
36547 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
36548 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
36549 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
36550
36551 @end format
36552
36553 @noindent
36554 NOTES
36555
36556 @enumerate
36557 @c 1
36558 @item
36559 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36560 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
36561 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
36562 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
36563
36564 @c 2
36565 @item
36566 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36567 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
36568 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
36569
36570 @c 3
36571 @item
36572 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
36573 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
36574 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
36575
36576 @c 4
36577 @item
36578 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
36579
36580 @c 5
36581 @item
36582 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
36583 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
36584
36585 @c 6
36586 @item
36587 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
36588 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
36589
36590 @c 7
36591 @item
36592 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
36593 1=Basic simplifications, 2=Algebraic simplifications, 3=Extended simplifications
36594
36595 @c 8
36596 @item
36597 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36598
36599 @c 9
36600 @item
36601 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36602 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36603
36604 @c 10
36605 @item
36606 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36607 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36608
36609 @c 11
36610 @item
36611 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36612
36613 @c 12
36614 @item
36615 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36616 prefix always clears the mode.
36617
36618 @c 13
36619 @item
36620 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36621
36622 @c 14
36623 @item
36624 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36625 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36626 @iftex
36627 {@advance@tableindent10pt
36628 @end iftex
36629 @table @asis
36630 @item Integer
36631 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36632 @item Float
36633 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36634 @item 0.0
36635 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36636 @item Error form
36637 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36638 @item Interval
36639 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36640 @item Vector
36641 Random element from the vector.
36642 @end table
36643 @iftex
36644 }
36645 @end iftex
36646
36647 @c 15
36648 @item
36649 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36650 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36651
36652 @c 16
36653 @item
36654 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36655 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36656
36657 @c 17
36658 @item
36659 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
36660
36661 @c 18
36662 @item
36663 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36664 the new units.
36665
36666 @c 19
36667 @item
36668 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36669 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36670
36671 @c 20
36672 @item
36673 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36674 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36675 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36676 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36677
36678 @c 21
36679 @item
36680 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36681 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36682 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36683 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36684
36685 @c 22
36686 @item
36687 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36688 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36689 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36690 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36691 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36692 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36693 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36694 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36695 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36696
36697 @c 23
36698 @item
36699 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36700 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36701 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36702 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36703 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36704 or @code{d} for ``down.''
36705
36706 @c 24
36707 @item
36708 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36709 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36710 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36711 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36712 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36713 @iftex
36714 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
36715 @end iftex
36716 @table @cite
36717 @item -1
36718 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36719 @item -2
36720 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36721 @item -3
36722 (@var{3}) HMS form.
36723 @item -4
36724 (@var{2}) Error form.
36725 @item -5
36726 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
36727 @item -6
36728 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
36729 @item -7
36730 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36731 @item -8
36732 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36733 @item -9
36734 (@var{2}) Open interval.
36735 @item -10
36736 (@var{2}) Fraction.
36737 @item -11
36738 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36739 @item -12
36740 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36741 @item -13
36742 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36743 @item -14
36744 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36745 @item -15
36746 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36747 @end table
36748 @iftex
36749 }
36750 @end iftex
36751
36752 @c 25
36753 @item
36754 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36755 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36756 the input vector.
36757
36758 @c 26
36759 @item
36760 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36761
36762 @c 27
36763 @item
36764 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36765
36766 @c 28
36767 @item
36768 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36769
36770 @c 29
36771 @item
36772 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36773
36774 @c 30
36775 @item
36776 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36777 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36778 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36779 of the result of the edit.
36780
36781 @c 31
36782 @item
36783 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36784
36785 @c 32
36786 @item
36787 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36788
36789 @c 33
36790 @item
36791 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36792 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36793
36794 @c 34
36795 @item
36796 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36797 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36798 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36799 backward by that many lines.
36800
36801 @c 35
36802 @item
36803 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36804 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36805 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36806 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36807
36808 @c 36
36809 @item
36810 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36811 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36812 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36813 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36814
36815 @c 37
36816 @item
36817 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36818
36819 @c 38
36820 @item
36821 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36822 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36823
36824 @c 39
36825 @item
36826 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36827 @expr{v - v_0}.
36828
36829 @c 40
36830 @item
36831 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36832 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36833 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36834 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36835 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36836
36837 @c 41
36838 @item
36839 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36840
36841 @c 42
36842 @item
36843 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36844 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36845
36846 @c 43
36847 @item
36848 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36849 value for this graph.
36850
36851 @c 44
36852 @item
36853 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36854
36855 @c 45
36856 @item
36857 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36858 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36859 otherwise.
36860
36861 @c 46
36862 @item
36863 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36864 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36865 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36866 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36867 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36868 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36869 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36870 to evaluate variables.
36871
36872 @c 47
36873 @item
36874 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36875 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36876 assigns
36877 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36878 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36879
36880 @c 48
36881 @item
36882 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36883 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36884 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36885 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36886 and a vector from the stack.
36887
36888 @c 49
36889 @item
36890 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36891 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36892
36893 @c 50
36894 @item
36895 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36896 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36897 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36898
36899 @c 51
36900 @item
36901 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36902 default 2D resolution.
36903
36904 @c 52
36905 @item
36906 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
36907 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
36908 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
36909 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
36910 @end enumerate
36911
36912 @iftex
36913 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
36914 @page
36915 @endgroup
36916 @end iftex
36917
36918
36919 @c [end-summary]
36920
36921 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
36922 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
36923
36924 @printindex ky
36925
36926 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
36927 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
36928
36929 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
36930 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
36931 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
36932 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
36933
36934 @printindex pg
36935
36936 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
36937 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
36938
36939 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
36940 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
36941 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
36942 @iftex
36943 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
36944 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
36945 @end iftex
36946
36947 @printindex tp
36948
36949 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
36950 @unnumbered Concept Index
36951
36952 @printindex cp
36953
36954 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
36955 @unnumbered Index of Variables
36956
36957 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
36958 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
36959 corresponding Lisp variable.
36960
36961 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
36962 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
36963
36964 @printindex vr
36965
36966 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
36967 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
36968
36969 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
36970 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
36971 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
36972 @samp{math-}.
36973
36974 @printindex fn
36975
36976 @bye